mirror of
				https://git.haproxy.org/git/haproxy.git/
				synced 2025-10-31 00:21:00 +01:00 
			
		
		
		
	Released version 2.5-dev0 with the following main changes :
    - MINOR: version: it's development again
		
	
			
		
			
				
	
	
		
			22081 lines
		
	
	
		
			1.1 MiB
		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
			
		
		
	
	
			22081 lines
		
	
	
		
			1.1 MiB
		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
|                          ----------------------
 | |
|                                 HAProxy
 | |
|                           Configuration Manual
 | |
|                          ----------------------
 | |
|                               version 2.5
 | |
|                              willy tarreau
 | |
|                               2021/05/14
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
 | |
| specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
 | |
| documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
 | |
| The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
 | |
| through the document.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Note to documentation contributors :
 | |
|     This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
 | |
|     spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
 | |
|     so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
 | |
|     printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
 | |
|     ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
 | |
|     sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
 | |
|     closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
 | |
|     inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
 | |
|     please update the summary below for easier searching.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| Summary
 | |
| -------
 | |
| 
 | |
| 1.    Quick reminder about HTTP
 | |
| 1.1.      The HTTP transaction model
 | |
| 1.2.      HTTP request
 | |
| 1.2.1.        The request line
 | |
| 1.2.2.        The request headers
 | |
| 1.3.      HTTP response
 | |
| 1.3.1.        The response line
 | |
| 1.3.2.        The response headers
 | |
| 
 | |
| 2.    Configuring HAProxy
 | |
| 2.1.      Configuration file format
 | |
| 2.2.      Quoting and escaping
 | |
| 2.3.      Environment variables
 | |
| 2.4.      Conditional blocks
 | |
| 2.5.      Time format
 | |
| 2.6.      Examples
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.    Global parameters
 | |
| 3.1.      Process management and security
 | |
| 3.2.      Performance tuning
 | |
| 3.3.      Debugging
 | |
| 3.4.      Userlists
 | |
| 3.5.      Peers
 | |
| 3.6.      Mailers
 | |
| 3.7.      Programs
 | |
| 3.8.      HTTP-errors
 | |
| 3.9.      Rings
 | |
| 3.10.     Log forwarding
 | |
| 
 | |
| 4.    Proxies
 | |
| 4.1.      Proxy keywords matrix
 | |
| 4.2.      Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
 | |
| 
 | |
| 5.    Bind and server options
 | |
| 5.1.      Bind options
 | |
| 5.2.      Server and default-server options
 | |
| 5.3.      Server DNS resolution
 | |
| 5.3.1.      Global overview
 | |
| 5.3.2.      The resolvers section
 | |
| 
 | |
| 6.    Cache
 | |
| 6.1.      Limitation
 | |
| 6.2.      Setup
 | |
| 6.2.1.        Cache section
 | |
| 6.2.2.        Proxy section
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.    Using ACLs and fetching samples
 | |
| 7.1.      ACL basics
 | |
| 7.1.1.      Matching booleans
 | |
| 7.1.2.      Matching integers
 | |
| 7.1.3.      Matching strings
 | |
| 7.1.4.      Matching regular expressions (regexes)
 | |
| 7.1.5.      Matching arbitrary data blocks
 | |
| 7.1.6.      Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
 | |
| 7.2.      Using ACLs to form conditions
 | |
| 7.3.      Fetching samples
 | |
| 7.3.1.        Converters
 | |
| 7.3.2.        Fetching samples from internal states
 | |
| 7.3.3.        Fetching samples at Layer 4
 | |
| 7.3.4.        Fetching samples at Layer 5
 | |
| 7.3.5.        Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
 | |
| 7.3.6.        Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
 | |
| 7.3.7.        Fetching samples for developers
 | |
| 7.4.      Pre-defined ACLs
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.    Logging
 | |
| 8.1.      Log levels
 | |
| 8.2.      Log formats
 | |
| 8.2.1.        Default log format
 | |
| 8.2.2.        TCP log format
 | |
| 8.2.3.        HTTP log format
 | |
| 8.2.4.        Custom log format
 | |
| 8.2.5.        Error log format
 | |
| 8.3.      Advanced logging options
 | |
| 8.3.1.        Disabling logging of external tests
 | |
| 8.3.2.        Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
 | |
| 8.3.3.        Raising log level upon errors
 | |
| 8.3.4.        Disabling logging of successful connections
 | |
| 8.4.      Timing events
 | |
| 8.5.      Session state at disconnection
 | |
| 8.6.      Non-printable characters
 | |
| 8.7.      Capturing HTTP cookies
 | |
| 8.8.      Capturing HTTP headers
 | |
| 8.9.      Examples of logs
 | |
| 
 | |
| 9.    Supported filters
 | |
| 9.1.      Trace
 | |
| 9.2.      HTTP compression
 | |
| 9.3.      Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
 | |
| 9.4.      Cache
 | |
| 9.5.      fcgi-app
 | |
| 9.6.      OpenTracing
 | |
| 
 | |
| 10.   FastCGI applications
 | |
| 10.1.     Setup
 | |
| 10.1.1.       Fcgi-app section
 | |
| 10.1.2.       Proxy section
 | |
| 10.1.3.       Example
 | |
| 10.2.     Default parameters
 | |
| 10.3.     Limitations
 | |
| 
 | |
| 11.   Address formats
 | |
| 11.1.     Address family prefixes
 | |
| 11.2.     Socket type prefixes
 | |
| 11.3.     Protocol prefixes
 | |
| 
 | |
| 1. Quick reminder about HTTP
 | |
| ----------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
 | |
| fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
 | |
| on almost anything found in the contents.
 | |
| 
 | |
| However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
 | |
| formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
 | |
| correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 1.1. The HTTP transaction model
 | |
| -------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
 | |
| to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
 | |
| from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
 | |
| connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
 | |
| will involve a new connection :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
 | |
| 
 | |
| In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
 | |
| establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
 | |
| by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
 | |
| length.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
 | |
| to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
 | |
| however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
 | |
| response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
 | |
| header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
 | |
| 
 | |
| Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
 | |
| power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
 | |
| but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
 | |
| a smaller value.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
 | |
| keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
 | |
| second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
 | |
| page :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
 | |
| 
 | |
| This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
 | |
| latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
 | |
| correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
 | |
| the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
 | |
| server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
 | |
| time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
 | |
| are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
 | |
| parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
 | |
| carry the stream identifier.
 | |
| 
 | |
| By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
 | |
| connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
 | |
| leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
 | |
| start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
 | |
| processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
 | |
| waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
 | |
|   - keep alive    : all requests and responses are processed (default)
 | |
|   - tunnel        : only the first request and response are processed,
 | |
|                     everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
 | |
|   - server close  : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
 | |
|   - close         : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 1.2. HTTP request
 | |
| -----------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| First, let's consider this HTTP request :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Line     Contents
 | |
|   number
 | |
|      1     GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
 | |
|      2     Host: www.mydomain.com
 | |
|      3     User-agent: my small browser
 | |
|      4     Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
 | |
|      5     Accept: image/png
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 1.2.1. The Request line
 | |
| -----------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - a METHOD      : GET
 | |
|   - a URI         : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
 | |
|   - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
 | |
| 
 | |
| All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
 | |
| which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
 | |
| followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
 | |
| is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
 | |
| desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
 | |
| the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The URI itself can have several forms :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - A "relative URI" :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
 | |
| 
 | |
|     It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
 | |
|     received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
 | |
| 
 | |
|     It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
 | |
|     name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
 | |
|     a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
 | |
|     This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
 | |
|     must accept this form too.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
 | |
|     method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
 | |
|     capabilities.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
 | |
|     This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
 | |
|     tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
 | |
|     other protocols too.
 | |
| 
 | |
| In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
 | |
| mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
 | |
| on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
 | |
| It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
 | |
| specific to the language, framework or application in use.
 | |
| 
 | |
| HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
 | |
| assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 1.2.2. The request headers
 | |
| --------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
 | |
| beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
 | |
| an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
 | |
| Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
 | |
| values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
 | |
| encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
 | |
| the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
 | |
| define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
 | |
| their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
 | |
| "Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
 | |
| as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
 | |
| normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
 | |
| representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
 | |
| HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
 | |
| that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
 | |
| is one valid form of empty line.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
 | |
| headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
 | |
| about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
 | |
| application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Important note:
 | |
|    As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
 | |
|    in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
 | |
|    is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
 | |
|    correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 1.3. HTTP response
 | |
| ------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
 | |
| messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Line     Contents
 | |
|   number
 | |
|      1     HTTP/1.1 200 OK
 | |
|      2     Content-length: 350
 | |
|      3     Content-Type: text/html
 | |
| 
 | |
| As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
 | |
| codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
 | |
| response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
 | |
| continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
 | |
| the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
 | |
| following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
 | |
| sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
 | |
| (1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
 | |
| correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
 | |
| such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
 | |
| state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
 | |
| over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
 | |
| if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
 | |
| information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 1.3.1. The response line
 | |
| ------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
 | |
|   - a status code : 200
 | |
|   - a reason      : OK
 | |
| 
 | |
| The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
 | |
|  - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
 | |
|  - 2xx = OK, content is following   (e.g. 200, 206)
 | |
|  - 3xx = OK, no content following   (e.g. 302, 304)
 | |
|  - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
 | |
|  - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
 | |
| 
 | |
| Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
 | |
| "reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
 | |
| found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
 | |
| messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
 | |
| or "Authentication Required".
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Code  When / reason
 | |
|    200  access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
 | |
|    301  when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
 | |
|    302  when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
 | |
|    303  when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
 | |
|    307  when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
 | |
|    308  when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
 | |
|    400  for an invalid or too large request
 | |
|    401  when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
 | |
|         accessing the stats page)
 | |
|    403  when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
 | |
|    404  when the requested resource could not be found
 | |
|    408  when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
 | |
|    410  when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
 | |
|         be available again
 | |
|    500  when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
 | |
|         memory allocation failure, which should never happen
 | |
|    501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
 | |
|        unsupported feature
 | |
|    502  when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
 | |
|         when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
 | |
|    503  when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
 | |
|         monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
 | |
|    504  when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
 | |
| 
 | |
| The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
 | |
| 4.2).
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 1.3.2. The response headers
 | |
| ---------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
 | |
| the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
 | |
| details.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 2. Configuring HAProxy
 | |
| ----------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| 2.1. Configuration file format
 | |
| ------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
 | |
|   - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
 | |
|   - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
 | |
|     explicitly referenced
 | |
| 
 | |
| The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
 | |
| a few basic rules:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
 | |
| 
 | |
|   2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
 | |
|      tab characters
 | |
| 
 | |
|   4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
 | |
|      keyword sequences listed in this document
 | |
| 
 | |
|   5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
 | |
|      keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
 | |
|      parts of the configuration, or expressions
 | |
| 
 | |
|   6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
 | |
|      are supported
 | |
| 
 | |
|   7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
 | |
|      section
 | |
| 
 | |
| This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
 | |
| generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
 | |
| figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
 | |
| 
 | |
| First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
 | |
| the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
 | |
| a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
 | |
| word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
 | |
| follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
 | |
| the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
 | |
| the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
 | |
| the parts that need to be addressed.
 | |
| 
 | |
| A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
 | |
| requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
 | |
| extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
 | |
| the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
 | |
| section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
 | |
| section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
 | |
| not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
 | |
| 
 | |
| A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
 | |
| each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
 | |
| a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
 | |
| start a new one.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
 | |
| that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
 | |
| applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
 | |
| "accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
 | |
| processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
 | |
| ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
 | |
| which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
 | |
| In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
 | |
| of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
 | |
| identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
 | |
| such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
 | |
| 2, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
 | |
| 
 | |
|      listen foo
 | |
|          bind :80
 | |
| 
 | |
|      listen bar
 | |
|          bind :81
 | |
| 
 | |
| Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
 | |
| spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
 | |
| of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
 | |
| following configurations are strictly equivalent:
 | |
| 
 | |
|          global#this is the global section
 | |
|      daemon#daemonize
 | |
|          frontend         foo
 | |
|      mode             http   # or tcp
 | |
| 
 | |
| and:
 | |
| 
 | |
|      global
 | |
|          daemon
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # this is the public web frontend
 | |
|      frontend foo
 | |
|          mode http
 | |
| 
 | |
| The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
 | |
| new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
 | |
| other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
 | |
| section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
 | |
| section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
 | |
| at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
 | |
| are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
 | |
| editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
 | |
| support automatic indent.
 | |
| 
 | |
| In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
 | |
| positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
 | |
| modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
 | |
| anymore, and is not recommended.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 2.2. Quoting and escaping
 | |
| -------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
 | |
| that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
 | |
| possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
 | |
| in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
 | |
| ('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
 | |
| 
 | |
| This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
 | |
| very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
 | |
| the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
 | |
| also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
 | |
| delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
 | |
| word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
 | |
| remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
 | |
| 
 | |
| If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
 | |
| (i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
 | |
| backslash ('\'):
 | |
| 
 | |
|   \    to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
 | |
|   \#   to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
 | |
|   \\   to use a backslash
 | |
|   \'   to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
 | |
|   \"   to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
 | |
| 
 | |
| In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
 | |
| C-language representation:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   \n   to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
 | |
|   \r   to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
 | |
|   \t   to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
 | |
|   \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
 | |
| 
 | |
| Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
 | |
| or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
 | |
| of:
 | |
| 
 | |
|        space or tab as a word separator
 | |
|   '    single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
 | |
|   #    hash as a comment start
 | |
| 
 | |
| Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
 | |
| evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
 | |
| dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
 | |
| backslash.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
 | |
| character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
 | |
| is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
 | |
| 
 | |
| As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
 | |
| entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
 | |
| name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
 | |
| represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
 | |
| hence the '-' there:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Character  |  Unquoted     |  Weakly quoted              |  Strongly quoted
 | |
|   -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
 | |
|     <TAB>    |  \<TAB>, \x09 |  "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09"  |  '<TAB>'
 | |
|     <LF>     |  \n, \x0a     |  "\n", "\x0a"               |   -
 | |
|     <CR>     |  \r, \x0d     |  "\r", "\x0d"               |   -
 | |
|     <SPC>    |  \<SPC>, \x20 |  "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20"  |  '<SPC>'
 | |
|     "        |  \", \x22     |  "\"", "\x22"               |  '"'
 | |
|     #        |  \#, \x23     |  "#", "\#", "\x23"          |  '#'
 | |
|     $        |  $, \$, \x24  |  "\$", "\x24"               |  '$'
 | |
|     '        |  \', \x27     |  "'", "\'", "\x27"          |   -
 | |
|     \        |  \\, \x5c     |  "\\", "\x5c"               |  '\'
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|       # those are all strictly equivalent:
 | |
|       log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
 | |
|       log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
 | |
|       log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
 | |
|       log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
 | |
|       log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
 | |
| 
 | |
| There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
 | |
| necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
 | |
| by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
 | |
| they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
 | |
| escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
 | |
| characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
 | |
| case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
 | |
| if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
 | |
| own quotes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
 | |
| quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
 | |
| not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
 | |
| quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
 | |
| arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
 | |
|     http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
 | |
| "foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
 | |
| cannot write:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| because we would like the string to cut like this:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
 | |
|                                        |---------|----|-|
 | |
|                                  arg1 _/         /    /
 | |
|                                  arg2 __________/    /
 | |
|                                  arg3 ______________/
 | |
| 
 | |
| but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
 | |
| parenthesis then garbage:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
 | |
|                                        |--------|--------|
 | |
|                         arg1=(foo|bar _/        /
 | |
|                     trailing garbage  _________/
 | |
| 
 | |
| The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
 | |
| quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
 | |
| processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
 | |
| this word:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
 | |
|     ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
 | |
|        word1       word2    word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
 | |
| still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
 | |
| the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
 | |
| the second level:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
 | |
|     ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
 | |
|        word1       word2    word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
 | |
|                                                 |---------||----|-|
 | |
|                                 arg1=(foo|bar) _/          /    /
 | |
|                                     arg2=blah  ___________/    /
 | |
|                                         arg3=g _______________/
 | |
| 
 | |
| Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
 | |
| double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
 | |
|     ------------ --------  ----------------------------------
 | |
|        word1       word2    word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
 | |
|                                                 |---------||----|-|
 | |
|                                 arg1=(foo|bar) _/          /    /
 | |
|                                           arg2 ___________/    /
 | |
|                                           arg3 _______________/
 | |
| 
 | |
| When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
 | |
| appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
 | |
| string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
 | |
| thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
 | |
|     ------------ --------  -----------------------------------------
 | |
|        word1       word2    word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
 | |
|                                                 |-------------| |-----||-|
 | |
|                               arg1=(here)(/|$) _/               /      /
 | |
|                                     arg2=my/\1 ________________/      /
 | |
|                                           arg3 ______________________/
 | |
| 
 | |
| Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
 | |
| that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
 | |
| quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
 | |
| single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
 | |
| level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
 | |
| 
 | |
| When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
 | |
| double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
 | |
| and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
 | |
| a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
 | |
| a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
 | |
| the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
 | |
| regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
 | |
| around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
 | |
| more readable configurations.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 2.3. Environment variables
 | |
| --------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
 | |
| interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
 | |
| configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
 | |
| optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
 | |
| shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
 | |
| underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
 | |
| list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
 | |
| arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
 | |
| before the closing brace.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|       bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
 | |
| 
 | |
|       log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice   # send to local server
 | |
| 
 | |
|       user "$HAPROXY_USER"
 | |
| 
 | |
| Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
 | |
| file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
 | |
| 
 | |
| * HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
 | |
|   name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
 | |
| 
 | |
| * HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
 | |
|   separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
 | |
|   directory.
 | |
| 
 | |
| * HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| * HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
 | |
|   processes, separated by semicolons.
 | |
| 
 | |
| * HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
 | |
|   CLI, separated by semicolons.
 | |
| 
 | |
| In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
 | |
| regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
 | |
| only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
 | |
| 
 | |
| * .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
 | |
| 
 | |
| * .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
 | |
|   starting at one.
 | |
| 
 | |
| * .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
 | |
|   section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
 | |
|   first section.
 | |
| 
 | |
| These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
 | |
| if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
 | |
| section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
 | |
| "log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
 | |
| proxies.
 | |
| 
 | |
| This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
 | |
| logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
 | |
| to name some config objects like servers for example.
 | |
| 
 | |
| See also "external-check command" for other variables.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 2.4. Conditional blocks
 | |
| -----------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
 | |
| some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
 | |
| ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
 | |
| configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
 | |
| versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
 | |
| preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
 | |
| text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
 | |
| lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
 | |
| switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
 | |
| are defined to form conditional blocks:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - .if <condition>
 | |
|   - .elif <condition>
 | |
|   - .else
 | |
|   - .endif
 | |
| 
 | |
| The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
 | |
| as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
 | |
| matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
 | |
| there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
 | |
| only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
 | |
| ".elif" of a block.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
 | |
| ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
 | |
| as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The conditions are currently limited to:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - an empty string, always returns "false"
 | |
|   - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
 | |
|   - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
 | |
|   - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - defined(<name>)       : returns true if an environment variable <name>
 | |
|                             exists, regardless of its contents
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - feature(<name>)       : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
 | |
|                             in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
 | |
|                             (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - streq(<str1>,<str2>)  : returns true only if the two strings are equal
 | |
|   - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
 | |
|                             at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
 | |
|                             version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
 | |
|                             and missing components are assumed as being zero.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
 | |
|                             strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
 | |
|                             version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
 | |
|                             and missing components are assumed as being zero.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|    .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
 | |
|        listen mwcli_px
 | |
|           bind :1111
 | |
|           ...
 | |
|    .endif
 | |
| 
 | |
|    .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
 | |
|           bind :80
 | |
|    .endif
 | |
| 
 | |
|    .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
 | |
|      .if feature(OPENSSL)
 | |
|           bind :443 ssl crt ...
 | |
|      .endif
 | |
|    .endif
 | |
| 
 | |
|    .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
 | |
|        profiling.memory on
 | |
|    .endif
 | |
| 
 | |
| Four other directives are provided to report some status:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - .diag "message"    : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
 | |
|   - .notice "message"  : emit this message at level NOTICE
 | |
|   - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
 | |
|   - .alert "message"   : emit this message at level ALERT
 | |
| 
 | |
| Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
 | |
| "strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
 | |
| fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
 | |
| provide advice to the user.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   .if "${A}"
 | |
|     .if "${B}"
 | |
|        .notice "A=1, B=1"
 | |
|     .elif "${C}"
 | |
|        .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
 | |
|     .elif "${D}"
 | |
|        .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
 | |
|     .else
 | |
|        .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
 | |
|     .endif
 | |
|   .else
 | |
|        .notice "A=0"
 | |
|   .endif
 | |
| 
 | |
|   .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
 | |
|         http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 2.5. Time format
 | |
| ----------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
 | |
| values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
 | |
| otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
 | |
| numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
 | |
| for every keyword. Supported units are :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
 | |
|   - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
 | |
|   - s  : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
 | |
|   - m  : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
 | |
|   - h  : hours.   1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
 | |
|   - d  : days.    1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 2.6. Examples
 | |
| -------------
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
 | |
|     # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
 | |
|     # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
 | |
|     global
 | |
|         daemon
 | |
|         maxconn 256
 | |
| 
 | |
|     defaults
 | |
|         mode http
 | |
|         timeout connect 5000ms
 | |
|         timeout client 50000ms
 | |
|         timeout server 50000ms
 | |
| 
 | |
|     frontend http-in
 | |
|         bind *:80
 | |
|         default_backend servers
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend servers
 | |
|         server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
 | |
|     # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
 | |
|     global
 | |
|         daemon
 | |
|         maxconn 256
 | |
| 
 | |
|     defaults
 | |
|         mode http
 | |
|         timeout connect 5000ms
 | |
|         timeout client 50000ms
 | |
|         timeout server 50000ms
 | |
| 
 | |
|     listen http-in
 | |
|         bind *:80
 | |
|         server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3. Global parameters
 | |
| --------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
 | |
| are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
 | |
| of them have command-line equivalents.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
 | |
| 
 | |
|  * Process management and security
 | |
|    - ca-base
 | |
|    - chroot
 | |
|    - crt-base
 | |
|    - cpu-map
 | |
|    - daemon
 | |
|    - default-path
 | |
|    - description
 | |
|    - deviceatlas-json-file
 | |
|    - deviceatlas-log-level
 | |
|    - deviceatlas-separator
 | |
|    - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
 | |
|    - expose-experimental-directives
 | |
|    - external-check
 | |
|    - gid
 | |
|    - group
 | |
|    - hard-stop-after
 | |
|    - h1-case-adjust
 | |
|    - h1-case-adjust-file
 | |
|    - insecure-fork-wanted
 | |
|    - insecure-setuid-wanted
 | |
|    - issuers-chain-path
 | |
|    - localpeer
 | |
|    - log
 | |
|    - log-tag
 | |
|    - log-send-hostname
 | |
|    - lua-load
 | |
|    - lua-load-per-thread
 | |
|    - lua-prepend-path
 | |
|    - mworker-max-reloads
 | |
|    - nbproc
 | |
|    - nbthread
 | |
|    - node
 | |
|    - numa-cpu-mapping
 | |
|    - pidfile
 | |
|    - pp2-never-send-local
 | |
|    - presetenv
 | |
|    - resetenv
 | |
|    - uid
 | |
|    - ulimit-n
 | |
|    - user
 | |
|    - set-dumpable
 | |
|    - set-var
 | |
|    - setenv
 | |
|    - stats
 | |
|    - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
 | |
|    - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
 | |
|    - ssl-default-bind-curves
 | |
|    - ssl-default-bind-options
 | |
|    - ssl-default-server-ciphers
 | |
|    - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
 | |
|    - ssl-default-server-options
 | |
|    - ssl-dh-param-file
 | |
|    - ssl-server-verify
 | |
|    - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
 | |
|    - unix-bind
 | |
|    - unsetenv
 | |
|    - 51degrees-data-file
 | |
|    - 51degrees-property-name-list
 | |
|    - 51degrees-property-separator
 | |
|    - 51degrees-cache-size
 | |
|    - wurfl-data-file
 | |
|    - wurfl-information-list
 | |
|    - wurfl-information-list-separator
 | |
|    - wurfl-cache-size
 | |
|    - strict-limits
 | |
| 
 | |
|  * Performance tuning
 | |
|    - busy-polling
 | |
|    - max-spread-checks
 | |
|    - maxconn
 | |
|    - maxconnrate
 | |
|    - maxcomprate
 | |
|    - maxcompcpuusage
 | |
|    - maxpipes
 | |
|    - maxsessrate
 | |
|    - maxsslconn
 | |
|    - maxsslrate
 | |
|    - maxzlibmem
 | |
|    - noepoll
 | |
|    - nokqueue
 | |
|    - noevports
 | |
|    - nopoll
 | |
|    - nosplice
 | |
|    - nogetaddrinfo
 | |
|    - noreuseport
 | |
|    - profiling.tasks
 | |
|    - spread-checks
 | |
|    - server-state-base
 | |
|    - server-state-file
 | |
|    - ssl-engine
 | |
|    - ssl-mode-async
 | |
|    - tune.buffers.limit
 | |
|    - tune.buffers.reserve
 | |
|    - tune.bufsize
 | |
|    - tune.chksize
 | |
|    - tune.comp.maxlevel
 | |
|    - tune.fd.edge-triggered
 | |
|    - tune.h2.header-table-size
 | |
|    - tune.h2.initial-window-size
 | |
|    - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
 | |
|    - tune.http.cookielen
 | |
|    - tune.http.logurilen
 | |
|    - tune.http.maxhdr
 | |
|    - tune.idle-pool.shared
 | |
|    - tune.idletimer
 | |
|    - tune.lua.forced-yield
 | |
|    - tune.lua.maxmem
 | |
|    - tune.lua.session-timeout
 | |
|    - tune.lua.task-timeout
 | |
|    - tune.lua.service-timeout
 | |
|    - tune.maxaccept
 | |
|    - tune.maxpollevents
 | |
|    - tune.maxrewrite
 | |
|    - tune.pattern.cache-size
 | |
|    - tune.pipesize
 | |
|    - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
 | |
|    - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
 | |
|    - tune.rcvbuf.client
 | |
|    - tune.rcvbuf.server
 | |
|    - tune.recv_enough
 | |
|    - tune.runqueue-depth
 | |
|    - tune.sched.low-latency
 | |
|    - tune.sndbuf.client
 | |
|    - tune.sndbuf.server
 | |
|    - tune.ssl.cachesize
 | |
|    - tune.ssl.keylog
 | |
|    - tune.ssl.lifetime
 | |
|    - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
 | |
|    - tune.ssl.maxrecord
 | |
|    - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
 | |
|    - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
 | |
|    - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
 | |
|    - tune.vars.global-max-size
 | |
|    - tune.vars.proc-max-size
 | |
|    - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
 | |
|    - tune.vars.sess-max-size
 | |
|    - tune.vars.txn-max-size
 | |
|    - tune.zlib.memlevel
 | |
|    - tune.zlib.windowsize
 | |
| 
 | |
|  * Debugging
 | |
|    - quiet
 | |
|    - zero-warning
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.1. Process management and security
 | |
| ------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| ca-base <dir>
 | |
|   Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
 | |
|   relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
 | |
|   directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
 | |
|   "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
 | |
| 
 | |
| chroot <jail dir>
 | |
|   Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
 | |
|   dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
 | |
|   vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
 | |
|   attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
 | |
|   with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
 | |
|   empty and non-writable to anyone.
 | |
| 
 | |
| cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
 | |
|   On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
 | |
|   specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
 | |
|   other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
 | |
|   sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
 | |
|   set. These sets have the format
 | |
| 
 | |
|       all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
 | |
|   word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
 | |
|   ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
 | |
|   a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
 | |
|   "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
 | |
|   with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
 | |
|   CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
 | |
|   CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
 | |
|   Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
 | |
|   31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
 | |
|   or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
 | |
|   "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
 | |
|   the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
 | |
|   intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
 | |
|   attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
 | |
|   the thread.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
 | |
|   case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
 | |
|   on the machine's word size.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
 | |
|   automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
 | |
|   process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
 | |
|   size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
 | |
|   the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
 | |
|   "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
 | |
|   must be a fixed number.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples:
 | |
|       cpu-map 1-4 0-3   # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
 | |
| 
 | |
|       cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
 | |
|                         # first 4 CPUs
 | |
| 
 | |
|       cpu-map 1- 0-     # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
 | |
|                         # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
 | |
|                         # word size.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
 | |
|       # and so on.
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:1-4   0-3
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:1-4   0-1 2-3
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:1-4   3 2 1 0
 | |
| 
 | |
|       # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
 | |
|       # and so on.
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:1/1-4   0-3
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:1/1-4   0-1 2-3
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:1/1-4   3 2 1 0
 | |
| 
 | |
|       # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:all   0-63
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:even  0-31
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:odd   32-63
 | |
| 
 | |
|       # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:1-4   0    # invalid
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:1     0-3  # invalid
 | |
| 
 | |
|       # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
 | |
|       # and a thread range.
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:all/all   0 # invalid
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:all/1-4   0 # invalid
 | |
|       cpu-map auto:1-4/all   0 # invalid
 | |
| 
 | |
| crt-base <dir>
 | |
|   Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
 | |
|   path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
 | |
|   prevail and ignore "crt-base".
 | |
| 
 | |
| daemon
 | |
|   Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
 | |
|   operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
 | |
|   disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
 | |
|   systemd mode.
 | |
| 
 | |
| default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
 | |
|   By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
 | |
|   location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
 | |
|   desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
 | |
|   just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
 | |
|   directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
 | |
|   the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
 | |
|   return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
 | |
|   argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
 | |
|   not start with a slash ('/'):
 | |
|     - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
 | |
|       directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
 | |
|       directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
 | |
|       configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
 | |
|       last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
 | |
|       directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
 | |
|       certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
 | |
|       multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
 | |
|       each of them.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
 | |
|       parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
 | |
|       specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
 | |
|       is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
 | |
|       directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
 | |
|       convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,  certificates and Lua scripts
 | |
|       together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
 | |
|       different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
 | |
|       designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
 | |
|       different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
 | |
|       instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
 | |
|       made easily relocatable.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
 | |
|   possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
 | |
|   always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
 | |
|   use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
 | |
|   consistent across all configuration files.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
 | |
|   uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
 | |
|   it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
 | |
|   making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
 | |
|   configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
 | |
|   observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
 | |
|   paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
 | |
|   their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
 | |
| 
 | |
| deviceatlas-json-file <path>
 | |
|   Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
 | |
|   The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
 | |
| 
 | |
| deviceatlas-log-level <value>
 | |
|   Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
 | |
|   optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
 | |
| 
 | |
| deviceatlas-separator <char>
 | |
|   Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
 | |
|   is optional and set to | by default if not set.
 | |
| 
 | |
| deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
 | |
|   Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
 | |
|   Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
 | |
|   and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
 | |
| 
 | |
| expose-experimental-directives
 | |
|   This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
 | |
|   the config file will be rejected.
 | |
| 
 | |
| external-check
 | |
|   Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
 | |
|   disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
 | |
|   may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
 | |
|   program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
 | |
|   you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
 | |
|   See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
 | |
|   "insecure-setuid-wanted".
 | |
| 
 | |
| gid <number>
 | |
|   Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
 | |
|   ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
 | |
|   be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
 | |
|   Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
 | |
|   will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
 | |
|   See also "group" and "uid".
 | |
| 
 | |
| group <group name>
 | |
|   Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
 | |
|   See also "gid" and "user".
 | |
| 
 | |
| hard-stop-after <time>
 | |
|   Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <time>  is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
 | |
|             instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
 | |
|             SIGUSR1 signal.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
 | |
|   remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
 | |
|   in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     global
 | |
|       hard-stop-after 30s
 | |
| 
 | |
| h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
 | |
|   Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
 | |
|   <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
 | |
|   servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
 | |
|   except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
 | |
|   adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
 | |
|   be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
 | |
|   Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
 | |
|   h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
 | |
|   specified in a proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
 | |
|   they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
 | |
|   insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
 | |
|   erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
 | |
|   becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
 | |
|   lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
 | |
|   sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
 | |
|   to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
 | |
|   the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
 | |
|   application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
 | |
|   smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     global
 | |
|       h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
 | |
|   "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
 | |
| 
 | |
| h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
 | |
|   Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
 | |
|   of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
 | |
|   file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
 | |
|   in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
 | |
|   start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
 | |
|   and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
 | |
|   no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
 | |
|   or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed.  It is an
 | |
|   alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
 | |
|   to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
 | |
|   "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
 | |
| 
 | |
| insecure-fork-wanted
 | |
|   By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
 | |
|   after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
 | |
|   uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
 | |
|   still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
 | |
|   it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
 | |
|   triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
 | |
|   break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
 | |
|   fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
 | |
|   idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
 | |
|   will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
 | |
|   anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
 | |
|   set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
 | |
|   highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
 | |
|   requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
 | |
|   agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
 | |
|   disable it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| insecure-setuid-wanted
 | |
|   HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
 | |
|   external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
 | |
|   to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
 | |
|   reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
 | |
|   aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
 | |
|   checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
 | |
|   HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
 | |
|   it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
 | |
|   executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
 | |
|   escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
 | |
|   this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
 | |
|   the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
 | |
|   explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
 | |
|   possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| issuers-chain-path <dir>
 | |
|   Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
 | |
|   files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
 | |
|   if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
 | |
|   intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
 | |
|   certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
 | |
|   "issuers-chain-path".
 | |
|   A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
 | |
|   could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
 | |
|   chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
 | |
|   "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
 | |
|   will share the chain in memory.
 | |
| 
 | |
| localpeer <name>
 | |
|   Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
 | |
|   command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
 | |
|   definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
 | |
|   the configuration parsing.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
 | |
|   See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
 | |
| 
 | |
| log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
 | |
|     <facility> [max level [min level]]
 | |
|   Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
 | |
|   will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
 | |
|   configured with "log global".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <address> can be one of:
 | |
| 
 | |
|         - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
 | |
|           no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
 | |
|           port).
 | |
| 
 | |
|         - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
 | |
|           no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
 | |
|           port).
 | |
| 
 | |
|         - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
 | |
|           considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
 | |
|           the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
 | |
|           writable).
 | |
| 
 | |
|         - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
 | |
|           to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
 | |
|           and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
 | |
|           but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
 | |
|           truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
 | |
|           will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
 | |
|           messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
 | |
|           512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
 | |
|           larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
 | |
|           Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
 | |
|           directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
 | |
|           as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
 | |
|           purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
 | |
|           the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
 | |
|           for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
 | |
|           format below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
 | |
|           "fd@2", see above.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
 | |
|           in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
 | |
|           command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
 | |
|           buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
 | |
|           this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
 | |
|         parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
 | |
|            will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
 | |
|            servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
 | |
|            default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
 | |
|            while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
 | |
|            make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
 | |
|            lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
 | |
|            truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
 | |
|            inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
 | |
|            standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
 | |
|            JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
 | |
|            increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
 | |
|            one of the following :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     local     Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
 | |
|               field is stripped. This is the default.
 | |
|               Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
 | |
|               rfc3164.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     rfc3164   The RFC3164 syslog message format.
 | |
|               (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
 | |
| 
 | |
|     rfc5424   The RFC5424 syslog message format.
 | |
|               (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
 | |
| 
 | |
|     priority  A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
 | |
|               angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
 | |
|               date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
 | |
|               designed to be used with a local log server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     short     A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
 | |
|               '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
 | |
|               and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
 | |
|               local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
 | |
|               logger consumes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     timed     A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
 | |
|              '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
 | |
|               name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
 | |
|               used with a local log server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     iso       A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
 | |
|               The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
 | |
|               designed to be used with a local log server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     raw       A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
 | |
|               process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
 | |
|               used in containers or during development, where the severity only
 | |
|               depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <ranges>   A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
 | |
|              This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
 | |
|              server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
 | |
|              from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
 | |
|              set with <sample_size> parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <sample_size>
 | |
|              The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
 | |
|              their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
 | |
|              send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
 | |
|              maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
 | |
|              (see also <ranges> parameter).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
 | |
| 
 | |
|                  kern   user   mail   daemon auth   syslog lpr    news
 | |
|                  uucp   cron   auth2  ftp    ntp    audit  alert  cron2
 | |
|                  local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
 | |
| 
 | |
|              Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
 | |
|              formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
 | |
|              recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
 | |
|              it's only supposed to be used locally.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
 | |
|   all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
 | |
|   severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
 | |
|   level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
 | |
|   than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
 | |
|   "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
 | |
|   Eight levels are known :
 | |
| 
 | |
|           emerg  alert  crit   err    warning notice info  debug
 | |
| 
 | |
| log-send-hostname [<string>]
 | |
|   Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
 | |
|   is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
 | |
|   of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
 | |
|   intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
 | |
|   the logs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| log-tag <string>
 | |
|   Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
 | |
|   program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
 | |
|   Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
 | |
|   running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
| lua-load <file>
 | |
|   This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
 | |
|   that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
 | |
|   from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
 | |
|   but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
 | |
|   thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
 | |
|   way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
 | |
|   used multiple times.
 | |
| 
 | |
| lua-load-per-thread <file>
 | |
|   This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
 | |
|   Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
 | |
|   see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
 | |
|   variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
 | |
|   initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
 | |
|   thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
 | |
|   performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
 | |
|   figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
 | |
|   concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
 | |
|   recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
 | |
|   converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
 | |
|   on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
 | |
|   even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
 | |
|   case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
 | |
|   times.
 | |
| 
 | |
| lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
 | |
|   Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
 | |
|   variable.
 | |
|   <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
 | |
|   to "path".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
 | |
|   `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
 | |
|   marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
 | |
|   evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
 | |
|   will be checked earlier.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   As an example by specifying the following path:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
 | |
|     lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
 | |
|   /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
 | |
|   /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
 | |
|   paths if that does not exist either.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
 | |
|   documentation.
 | |
| 
 | |
| master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
 | |
|   Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
 | |
|   This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
 | |
|   this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
 | |
|   the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
 | |
|   or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
 | |
|   systemd.
 | |
|   By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
 | |
|   segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
 | |
|   It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
 | |
|   systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
 | |
|   this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also "-W" in the management guide.
 | |
| 
 | |
| mworker-max-reloads <number>
 | |
|   In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
 | |
|   survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
 | |
|   number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
 | |
|   SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
 | |
|   See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
 | |
| 
 | |
| nbproc <number>  (deprecated)
 | |
|   Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
 | |
|   mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
 | |
|   of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
 | |
|   process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
 | |
|   larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
 | |
|   IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
 | |
|   and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
 | |
|   "daemon" and "nbthread".
 | |
| 
 | |
| nbthread <number>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
 | |
|   makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
 | |
|   "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
 | |
|   also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
 | |
|   between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
 | |
|   not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
 | |
|   to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
 | |
|   HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
 | |
|   when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
 | |
|   the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
 | |
|   thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
 | |
|   like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
 | |
|   value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
 | |
| 
 | |
| numa-cpu-mapping
 | |
|   By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
 | |
|   of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
 | |
|   automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
 | |
|   order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
 | |
|   bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
 | |
|   architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
 | |
|   This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
 | |
|   in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
 | |
|   for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
 | |
| 
 | |
| pidfile <pidfile>
 | |
|   Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
 | |
|   of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
 | |
|   equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
 | |
|   the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
 | |
| 
 | |
| pp2-never-send-local
 | |
|   A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
 | |
|   version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
 | |
|   for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
 | |
|   logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
 | |
|   which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
 | |
|   HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
 | |
|   the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
 | |
|   to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
 | |
|   time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
 | |
|   This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
 | |
|   "send-proxy-v2" statement.
 | |
| 
 | |
| presetenv <name> <value>
 | |
|   Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
 | |
|   is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
 | |
|   in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
 | |
|   and "unsetenv".
 | |
| 
 | |
| resetenv [<name> ...]
 | |
|   Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
 | |
|   allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
 | |
|   setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
 | |
|   some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
 | |
|   OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
 | |
|   after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
 | |
|   next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
 | |
|   "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
 | |
|   Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
 | |
|   stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
 | |
|   nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
 | |
|   when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
 | |
|   the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
 | |
|   warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
 | |
|   the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
 | |
|   word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
 | |
|   be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
 | |
|   value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
 | |
|   socket" line to force the process on each line.
 | |
| 
 | |
| server-state-base <directory>
 | |
|   Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
 | |
|   file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
 | |
|   "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
 | |
| 
 | |
| server-state-file <file>
 | |
|   Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
 | |
|   with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
 | |
|   relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
 | |
|   the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
 | |
|   servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
 | |
|   output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
 | |
|   starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
 | |
|   for each server found in the file and available in its current running
 | |
|   configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
 | |
|   "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
 | |
| 
 | |
| set-var <var-name> <expr>
 | |
|   Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
 | |
|   of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
 | |
|   process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
 | |
|   'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
 | |
|   at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
 | |
|   sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
 | |
|   those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
 | |
|   possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
 | |
|   will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|       global
 | |
|           set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
 | |
|           set-var proc.prio int(100)
 | |
|           set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
 | |
| 
 | |
| setenv <name> <value>
 | |
|   Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
 | |
|   is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
 | |
|   the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
 | |
|   and "unsetenv".
 | |
| 
 | |
| set-dumpable
 | |
|   This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
 | |
|   developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
 | |
|   disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
 | |
|   performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
 | |
|   possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
 | |
|   (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
 | |
|   as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
 | |
|   the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
 | |
|   from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
 | |
|   disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
 | |
|   or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
 | |
|   notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
 | |
|   not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
 | |
|   simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
 | |
|   issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
 | |
|   re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
 | |
|   issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
 | |
|   leaves a core where expected when dying.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
 | |
|   the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
 | |
|   that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
 | |
|   "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
 | |
|   is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
 | |
|   information and recommendations see e.g.
 | |
|   (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
 | |
|   (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
 | |
|   cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
 | |
|   Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
 | |
|   OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
 | |
|   describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
 | |
|   during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
 | |
|   theirs. The format of the string is defined in
 | |
|   "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
 | |
|   cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
 | |
|   "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
 | |
|   information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
 | |
|   the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
 | |
|   suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
 | |
|   of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
 | |
|   Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
 | |
|   default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
 | |
|   keyword to see available options.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         global
 | |
|            ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
 | |
|   negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
 | |
|   for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
 | |
|   the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
 | |
|   information and recommendations see e.g.
 | |
|   (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
 | |
|   (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
 | |
|   For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
 | |
|   "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
 | |
|   for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
 | |
|   OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
 | |
|   string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
 | |
|   the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
 | |
|   explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
 | |
|   "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
 | |
|   cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
 | |
|   "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
 | |
|   more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
 | |
|   default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
 | |
|   keyword to see available options.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-dh-param-file <file>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
 | |
|   the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
 | |
|   ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
 | |
|   which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
 | |
|   parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
 | |
|   are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
 | |
|   directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
 | |
|   specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
 | |
|   known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
 | |
|   Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
 | |
|   "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
 | |
|   parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-load-extra-del-ext
 | |
|   This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
 | |
|   extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
 | |
|   (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
 | |
|   HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
 | |
|   "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
 | |
|   and won't try to remove them.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
 | |
|   This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
 | |
|   the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
 | |
|   associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
 | |
|   files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
 | |
|   the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
 | |
|   optimize the startup time.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
 | |
|   a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
 | |
|   it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
 | |
|   bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
 | |
|   will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
 | |
|   frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
 | |
|   certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
 | |
|   store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
 | |
|   required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
 | |
|   backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
 | |
|   bind configuration.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
 | |
|   HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
 | |
|   be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
 | |
|   type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
 | |
|   example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
 | |
|   file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
 | |
|   first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
 | |
|   this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :  bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
 | |
|   a cert bundle.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
 | |
|   separately in several "crt".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
 | |
|   since files are loading separately.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
 | |
|   required to commit them.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
 | |
|   as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
 | |
|   a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
 | |
|   impact.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
 | |
|   a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
 | |
|   impact.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
 | |
|   not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
 | |
|   be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
 | |
|   file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The default behavior is "all".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
 | |
|     ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
 | |
|     ssl-load-extra-files none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
 | |
|   options.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-server-verify [none|required]
 | |
|   The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
 | |
|   servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
 | |
|   forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
 | |
|   Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
 | |
|   server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
 | |
|   need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
 | |
|   CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
 | |
|   issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
 | |
|   with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
 | |
|   certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
 | |
|   bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
 | |
|   Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
 | |
|   Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
 | |
|   allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
 | |
|   consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
 | |
|   details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
 | |
|   restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
 | |
|   section 5.1 for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
 | |
|   The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
 | |
|   to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
 | |
|   milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats maxconn <connections>
 | |
|   By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
 | |
|   possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
 | |
| 
 | |
| uid <number>
 | |
|   Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
 | |
|   is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
 | |
|   be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
 | |
|   one. See also "gid" and "user".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ulimit-n <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
 | |
|   default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
 | |
|   option.
 | |
| 
 | |
| unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
 | |
|           [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
 | |
|   This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
 | |
|   the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
 | |
|   also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
 | |
|   path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
 | |
|   component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
 | |
|   itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
 | |
|   all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
 | |
|   both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
 | |
|   "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsetenv [<name> ...]
 | |
|   Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
 | |
|   hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
 | |
|   user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
 | |
|   silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
 | |
|   these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
 | |
|   line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
 | |
|   "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
 | |
| 
 | |
| user <user name>
 | |
|   Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
 | |
|   See also "uid" and "group".
 | |
| 
 | |
| node <name>
 | |
|   Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
 | |
|   servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
 | |
|   nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
 | |
|   traffic.
 | |
| 
 | |
| description <text>
 | |
|   Add a text that describes the instance.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
 | |
|   and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
 | |
|   "<" and ">" characters.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 51degrees-data-file <file path>
 | |
|   The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
 | |
|   file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
 | |
|   compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 51degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
 | |
|   A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
 | |
|   of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
 | |
|   https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
 | |
|   compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 51degrees-property-separator <char>
 | |
|   A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
 | |
|   containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
 | |
|   compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 51degrees-cache-size <number>
 | |
|   Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
 | |
|   is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
 | |
|   By default, this cache is disabled.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
 | |
|   compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
 | |
| 
 | |
| wurfl-data-file <file path>
 | |
|   The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
 | |
|   file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
 | |
|   with USE_WURFL=1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
 | |
|   A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
 | |
|   names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
 | |
|   virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Valid WURFL properties are:
 | |
|   - wurfl_id                    Contains the device ID of the matched device.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - wurfl_root_id               Contains the device root ID of the matched
 | |
|                                 device.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - wurfl_isdevroot             Tells if the matched device is a root device.
 | |
|                                 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - wurfl_useragent             The original useragent coming with this
 | |
|                                 particular web request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - wurfl_api_version           Contains a string representing the currently
 | |
|                                 used Libwurfl API version.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - wurfl_info                  A string containing information on the parsed
 | |
|                                 wurfl.xml and its full path.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - wurfl_last_load_time        Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
 | |
|                                 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - wurfl_normalized_useragent  The normalized useragent.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
 | |
|   with USE_WURFL=1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
 | |
|   A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
 | |
|   WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
 | |
|   with USE_WURFL=1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
 | |
|   A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
 | |
|   thus before the chroot.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
 | |
|   with USE_WURFL=1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| wurfl-cache-size <size>
 | |
|   Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
 | |
|   agents are kept in a LRU cache :
 | |
|   - "0"     : no cache is used.
 | |
|   - <size>  : size of lru cache in elements.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
 | |
|   with USE_WURFL=1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| strict-limits
 | |
|   Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
 | |
|   best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
 | |
|   emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
 | |
|   HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
 | |
|   forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.2. Performance tuning
 | |
| -----------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| busy-polling
 | |
|   In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
 | |
|   supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
 | |
|   time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
 | |
|   to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
 | |
|   excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
 | |
|   processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
 | |
|   results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
 | |
|   at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
 | |
|   threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
 | |
|   resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
 | |
|   in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
 | |
|   important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
 | |
|   interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
 | |
|   multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
 | |
|   default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
 | |
|   prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
 | |
|   "poll" pollers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
 | |
|   seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
 | |
|   stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
 | |
| 
 | |
| max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
 | |
|   By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
 | |
|   smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
 | |
|   to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
 | |
|   check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
 | |
|   time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
 | |
|   used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
 | |
|   even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
 | |
|   shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxconn <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
 | |
|   is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
 | |
|   connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
 | |
|   automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
 | |
|   the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
 | |
|   some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
 | |
|   FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
 | |
|   below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
 | |
|   calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
 | |
|   "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
 | |
|   is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
 | |
|   cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
 | |
|   also be automatic).
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxconnrate <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
 | |
|   Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
 | |
|   used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
 | |
|   important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
 | |
|   as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
 | |
|   limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
 | |
|   value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
 | |
|   fairness.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxcomprate <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
 | |
|   per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
 | |
|   level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
 | |
|   beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
 | |
|   is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
 | |
|   tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxcompcpuusage <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
 | |
|   for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
 | |
|   It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
 | |
|   bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. In
 | |
|   case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
 | |
|   usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
 | |
|   a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
 | |
|   process down and from introducing high latencies.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxpipes <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
 | |
|   are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
 | |
|   descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
 | |
|   value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
 | |
|   The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
 | |
|   to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxsessrate <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
 | |
|   Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
 | |
|   used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
 | |
|   important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
 | |
|   as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
 | |
|   limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
 | |
|   value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
 | |
|   fairness.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxsslconn <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
 | |
|   <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
 | |
|   global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
 | |
|   avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
 | |
|   (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
 | |
|   that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
 | |
|   connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
 | |
|   If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
 | |
|   automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn,  the buffer size,
 | |
|   memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
 | |
|   frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
 | |
|   when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
 | |
|   so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
 | |
|   consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxsslrate <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
 | |
|   SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
 | |
|   can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
 | |
|   capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
 | |
|   protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
 | |
|   frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
 | |
|   frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
 | |
|   note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
 | |
|   after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
 | |
|   tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxzlibmem <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
 | |
|   When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
 | |
|   as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
 | |
|   The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
 | |
|   with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
 | |
|   "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| noepoll
 | |
|   Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
 | |
|   equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
 | |
|   used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
 | |
| 
 | |
| nokqueue
 | |
|   Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
 | |
|   equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
 | |
|   used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
 | |
| 
 | |
| noevports
 | |
|   Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
 | |
|   derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
 | |
|   argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
 | |
|   also "nopoll".
 | |
| 
 | |
| nopoll
 | |
|   Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
 | |
|   command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
 | |
|   It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
 | |
|   platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
 | |
|   "noevports".
 | |
| 
 | |
| nosplice
 | |
|   Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
 | |
|   equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
 | |
|   using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
 | |
|   limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
 | |
|   2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
 | |
|   be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
 | |
|   case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
 | |
|   "option splice-response".
 | |
| 
 | |
| nogetaddrinfo
 | |
|   Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
 | |
|   the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
| noreuseport
 | |
|   Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
 | |
|   command line argument "-dR".
 | |
| 
 | |
| profiling.memory { on | off }
 | |
|   Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
 | |
|   keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
 | |
|   process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
 | |
|   "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
 | |
|   abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
 | |
|   other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
 | |
|   maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
 | |
|   use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
 | |
|   "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
 | |
| 
 | |
| profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
 | |
|   Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
 | |
|   the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
 | |
|   an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
 | |
|   "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
 | |
|   returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
 | |
|   loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
 | |
|   spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
 | |
|   systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
 | |
|   must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
 | |
|   spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
 | |
|   it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
 | |
|   is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
 | |
|   operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
 | |
|   supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
 | |
|   CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
 | |
|   be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
 | |
|   CLI.
 | |
| 
 | |
| spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
 | |
|   Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
 | |
|   servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
 | |
|   located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
 | |
|   becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
 | |
|   and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
 | |
|   default value remains at 0.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
 | |
|   Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
 | |
|   obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
 | |
|   multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
 | |
|   unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
 | |
|   will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
 | |
|   processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
 | |
|   will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
 | |
|   of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
 | |
|   algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
 | |
|   of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
 | |
|   CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
 | |
|   openssl configuration file uses:
 | |
|   https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-mode-async
 | |
|   Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
 | |
|   I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
 | |
|   implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
 | |
|   doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
 | |
|   HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
 | |
|   read/write  operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
 | |
|   handshakes).
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.buffers.limit <number>
 | |
|   Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
 | |
|   The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
 | |
|   will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
 | |
|   be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
 | |
|   limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
 | |
|   behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
 | |
|   another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
 | |
|   allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
 | |
|   provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
 | |
|   may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
 | |
|   have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
 | |
|   expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
 | |
|   usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
 | |
|   will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
 | |
|   advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.buffers.reserve <number>
 | |
|   Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
 | |
|   during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
 | |
|   minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
 | |
|   want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.bufsize <number>
 | |
|   Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
 | |
|   sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
 | |
|   applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
 | |
|   can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
 | |
|   from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
 | |
|   statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
 | |
|   possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
 | |
|   parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
 | |
|   addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
 | |
|   HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
 | |
|   return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
 | |
|   than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
 | |
|   value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
 | |
|   multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
 | |
|   This option is deprecated and ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
 | |
|   usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
 | |
|   Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
 | |
|   this value. The default value is 1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.fail-alloc
 | |
|   If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
 | |
|   allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
 | |
|   success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
 | |
|   gracefully.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off }  [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
 | |
|   Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
 | |
|   that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
 | |
|   reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
 | |
|   certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
 | |
|   connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
 | |
|   Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
 | |
|   cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
 | |
|   send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
 | |
|   memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
 | |
|   change it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
 | |
|   Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
 | |
|   can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
 | |
|   only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
 | |
|   The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
 | |
|   bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
 | |
|   over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
 | |
|   faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
 | |
|   clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
 | |
|   Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
 | |
|   number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
 | |
|   100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
 | |
|   visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
 | |
|   single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
 | |
|   client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
 | |
|   recommended not to change this value.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
 | |
|   Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
 | |
|   receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
 | |
|   buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
 | |
|   for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
 | |
|   allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
 | |
|   large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
 | |
|   misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.http.cookielen <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
 | |
|   the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
 | |
|   will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
 | |
|   high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
 | |
|   their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
 | |
|   per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
 | |
|   When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
 | |
|   to change this value.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.http.logurilen <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
 | |
|   request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
 | |
|   to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
 | |
|   'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
 | |
|   configuration directives too.
 | |
|   The default value is 1024.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.http.maxhdr <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
 | |
|   number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
 | |
|   rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
 | |
|   are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
 | |
|   for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
 | |
|   same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
 | |
|   a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
 | |
|   1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
 | |
|   each session, so don't push this limit too high.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
 | |
|   Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
 | |
|   threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
 | |
|   order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
 | |
|   optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
 | |
|   suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
 | |
|   forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
 | |
|   this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
 | |
|   disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
 | |
|   for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
 | |
|   level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
 | |
|   increases.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.idletimer <timeout>
 | |
|   Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
 | |
|   probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
 | |
|   some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
 | |
|   decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
 | |
|   parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
 | |
|   means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
 | |
|   which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
 | |
|   clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
 | |
|   tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
 | |
|   Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
 | |
|   spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
 | |
|   on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
 | |
|   distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
 | |
|   may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
 | |
|   with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
 | |
|   be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
 | |
|   estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
 | |
|   distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
 | |
|   This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
 | |
|   instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
 | |
|   HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
 | |
|   forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
 | |
|   executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
 | |
|   lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
 | |
|   to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.lua.maxmem
 | |
|   Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
 | |
|   default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
 | |
|   ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
 | |
|   memory.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
 | |
|   This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
 | |
|   preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
 | |
|   counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
 | |
|   not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
 | |
|   Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
 | |
|   dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
 | |
|   remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
 | |
|   check servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
 | |
|   This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
 | |
|   preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
 | |
|   counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
 | |
|   not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.maxaccept <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
 | |
|   row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
 | |
|   used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
 | |
|   the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
 | |
|   each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
 | |
|   taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
 | |
|   significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
 | |
|   worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
 | |
|   time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
 | |
|   the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
 | |
|   limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.maxpollevents <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
 | |
|   the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
 | |
|   has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
 | |
|   latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
 | |
|   tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.maxrewrite <number>
 | |
|   Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
 | |
|   used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
 | |
|   fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
 | |
|   bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
 | |
|   numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
 | |
|   requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
 | |
|   to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
 | |
|   to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
 | |
|   larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
 | |
|   bufsize.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
 | |
|   Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
 | |
|   cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
 | |
|   and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
 | |
|   "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
 | |
|   strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
 | |
|   to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
 | |
|   configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
 | |
|   invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
 | |
|   default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
 | |
|   about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
 | |
|   on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
 | |
|   risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
 | |
|   cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
 | |
|   default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
 | |
|   attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
 | |
|   This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
 | |
|   aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
 | |
|   setting this parameter to 0.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.pipesize <number>
 | |
|   Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
 | |
|   are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
 | |
|   it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
 | |
|   suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
 | |
|   performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
 | |
|   not be changed if impacts are not understood.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
 | |
|   This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
 | |
|   HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
 | |
|   use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
 | |
|   and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
 | |
|   descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
 | |
|   keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
 | |
|   much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
 | |
|   This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
 | |
|   HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
 | |
|   use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
 | |
|   default is 20.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
 | |
| tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
 | |
|   Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
 | |
|   to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
 | |
|   and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
 | |
|   the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
 | |
|   However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
 | |
|   order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
 | |
|   of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.recv_enough <number>
 | |
|   HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
 | |
|   socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
 | |
|   bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
 | |
|   may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
 | |
|   of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.runqueue-depth <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
 | |
|   tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
 | |
|   and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
 | |
|   Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
 | |
|   can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
 | |
|   When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
 | |
|   tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
 | |
|   maximum latency to the lowest possible.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
 | |
|   Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
 | |
|   HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
 | |
|   the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
 | |
|   this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
 | |
|   low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
 | |
|   be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
 | |
|   maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
 | |
|   massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
 | |
|   For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.sndbuf.client <number>
 | |
| tune.sndbuf.server <number>
 | |
|   Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
 | |
|   the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
 | |
|   and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
 | |
|   the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
 | |
|   However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
 | |
|   order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
 | |
|   of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
 | |
|   Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
 | |
|   to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
 | |
|   notifying HAProxy again.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
 | |
|   Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
 | |
|   is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.  An
 | |
|   encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
 | |
|   on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
 | |
|   memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
 | |
|   calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
 | |
|   at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
 | |
|   idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
 | |
|   of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
 | |
|   that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
 | |
|   pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
 | |
|   is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.ssl.force-private-cache
 | |
|   This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
 | |
|   should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
 | |
|   clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
 | |
|   systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
 | |
|   this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
 | |
|   layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
 | |
|   This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
 | |
|   care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
 | |
|   performances. This is disabled by default.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
 | |
|   required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
 | |
|   fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
 | |
|   to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
 | |
|   converted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SSLKEYLOGFILE Label             |  Sample fetches for the Secrets
 | |
|   --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
 | |
|   CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET     |  %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
 | |
|   CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET |  %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
 | |
|   SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET |  %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
 | |
|   CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0         |  %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
 | |
|   SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0         |  %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
 | |
|   EXPORTER_SECRET                 |  %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
 | |
|   EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET           |  %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
 | |
|   only need this line:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
 | |
|   Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
 | |
|   in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
 | |
|   does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
 | |
|   full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
 | |
|   lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
 | |
|   being used for too long.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
 | |
|   value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
 | |
|   data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
 | |
|   that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
 | |
|   process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
 | |
|   located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
 | |
|   optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
 | |
|   Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
 | |
|   keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
 | |
|   2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
 | |
|   best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
 | |
|   stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
 | |
|   the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
 | |
|   final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
 | |
|   a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
 | |
|   this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
 | |
|   allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
 | |
|   1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
 | |
|   used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
 | |
|   in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
 | |
|   Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
 | |
|   entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
 | |
|   dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
 | |
|   1000 entries.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
 | |
|   list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
 | |
|   a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
 | |
| tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
 | |
| tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
 | |
| tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
 | |
| tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
 | |
|   These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
 | |
|   variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
 | |
|   all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
 | |
|   memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
 | |
|   limits the memory for each request or response processing.
 | |
|   Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
 | |
|   the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
 | |
|   "txn" includes "reqres".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
 | |
|   "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
 | |
|   100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
 | |
|   all available space is consumed.
 | |
|   Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
 | |
|   message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
 | |
|   plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
 | |
|   Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
 | |
|   defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
 | |
|   state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
 | |
|   ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
 | |
|   between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
 | |
|   Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
 | |
|   zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
 | |
|   in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
 | |
|   8 and 15. The default value is 15.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.3. Debugging
 | |
| --------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| quiet
 | |
|   Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
 | |
|   line argument "-q".
 | |
| 
 | |
| zero-warning
 | |
|   When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
 | |
|   emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
 | |
|   this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
 | |
|   subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
 | |
|   that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
 | |
|   equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.4. Userlists
 | |
| --------------
 | |
| It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
 | |
| http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
 | |
| it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
 | |
| 
 | |
| userlist <listname>
 | |
|   Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
 | |
|   used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
 | |
|   Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
 | |
|   attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
 | |
|   proceeded by "users" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
 | |
|                 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
 | |
|   Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
 | |
|   insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
 | |
|   evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
 | |
|   capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
 | |
|   based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
 | |
|   classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
 | |
|   increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
 | |
|   used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
 | |
|   be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
 | |
|   value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
 | |
|   designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
 | |
|   force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
 | |
|   but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
 | |
|   overall CPU consumption!
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         userlist L1
 | |
|           group G1 users tiger,scott
 | |
|           group G2 users xdb,scott
 | |
| 
 | |
|           user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
 | |
|           user scott insecure-password elgato
 | |
|           user xdb insecure-password hello
 | |
| 
 | |
|         userlist L2
 | |
|           group G1
 | |
|           group G2
 | |
| 
 | |
|           user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
 | |
|           user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
 | |
|           user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.5. Peers
 | |
| ----------
 | |
| It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
 | |
| several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
 | |
| instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
 | |
| values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
 | |
| automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
 | |
| In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
 | |
| using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
 | |
| tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
 | |
| reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
 | |
| Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
 | |
| that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
 | |
| each server on all participants.
 | |
| 
 | |
| peers <peersect>
 | |
|   Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
 | |
|   which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
 | |
| 
 | |
| bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
 | |
|   Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
 | |
|   Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
 | |
| 
 | |
| disabled
 | |
|   Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
 | |
|   related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
 | |
|   tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
 | |
| 
 | |
| default-bind [param*]
 | |
|   Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
 | |
| 
 | |
| default-server [param*]
 | |
|   Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <param*>  is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
 | |
|               keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
 | |
|               section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
 | |
|               details.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
 | |
| 
 | |
| enable
 | |
|   This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
 | |
| 
 | |
| log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
 | |
|     <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
 | |
|   "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
 | |
|   log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
 | |
|   more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
| peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
 | |
|   Defines a peer inside a peers section.
 | |
|   If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
 | |
|   using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
 | |
|   HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
 | |
|   Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
 | |
|   remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
 | |
|   validate the remote peer on the server side.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
 | |
|   connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
 | |
|   peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
 | |
|   global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
 | |
|   easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
 | |
|   parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
 | |
|   "server" keyword explanation below).
 | |
| 
 | |
| server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
 | |
|   As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
 | |
|   with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
 | |
|   If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
 | |
|   These parameters must  be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
 | |
|   of this "peers" section).
 | |
|   Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     # The old way.
 | |
|     peers mypeers
 | |
|         peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
 | |
|         peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
 | |
|         peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend mybackend
 | |
|         mode tcp
 | |
|         balance roundrobin
 | |
|         stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
 | |
|         stick on src
 | |
| 
 | |
|         server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
 | |
|         server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
 | |
| 
 | |
|    Example:
 | |
|      peers mypeers
 | |
|          bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
 | |
|          default-server ssl verify none
 | |
|          server hostA  127.0.0.10:10000
 | |
|          server hostB  #local peer
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
 | |
|       size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
 | |
|   exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
 | |
|   for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
 | |
|   mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
 | |
|   sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
 | |
|   "stick-table" keyword).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
 | |
|   namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
 | |
|   different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
 | |
|   sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
 | |
|   If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
 | |
|   stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
 | |
|   of the stick-table name as follows:
 | |
| 
 | |
|       peers mypeers
 | |
|           peer A ...
 | |
|           peer B ...
 | |
|           table t1 ...
 | |
| 
 | |
|       frontend fe1
 | |
|           tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
 | |
|   used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
 | |
|   communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
 | |
|   Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
 | |
|   This is shorter version of the stick-table name  which is sent over the network.
 | |
|   There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
 | |
|   stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
 | |
|   as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
 | |
| 
 | |
|       peers mypeers
 | |
|           peer A ...
 | |
|           peer B ...
 | |
|           table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
 | |
| 
 | |
|       backend t1
 | |
|           stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
 | |
|   "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
 | |
|   level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.6. Mailers
 | |
| ------------
 | |
| It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
 | |
| If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
 | |
| in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
 | |
| 
 | |
| mailers <mailersect>
 | |
|   Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
 | |
|   independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
 | |
| 
 | |
| mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
 | |
|   Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     mailers mymailers
 | |
|         mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
 | |
|         mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend mybackend
 | |
|         mode tcp
 | |
|         balance roundrobin
 | |
| 
 | |
|         email-alert mailers mymailers
 | |
|         email-alert from test1@horms.org
 | |
|         email-alert to test2@horms.org
 | |
| 
 | |
|         server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
 | |
|         server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout mail <time>
 | |
|   Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
 | |
|   the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
 | |
|   for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
 | |
|   is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     mailers mymailers
 | |
|         timeout mail 20s
 | |
|         mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.7. Programs
 | |
| -------------
 | |
| In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
 | |
| master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
 | |
| managed the same way as the workers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
 | |
| sequence as a worker:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - the master is re-executed
 | |
|   - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
 | |
|   - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
 | |
|     instance of the program
 | |
| 
 | |
| During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| program <name>
 | |
|   This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
 | |
|   which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
 | |
|   the management guide).
 | |
| 
 | |
| command <command> [arguments*]
 | |
|   Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
 | |
|   up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
 | |
|   mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
 | |
|   be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
 | |
| 
 | |
| user <user name>
 | |
|   Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
 | |
|   See also "group".
 | |
| 
 | |
| group <group name>
 | |
|   Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
 | |
|   See also "user".
 | |
| 
 | |
| option start-on-reload
 | |
| no option start-on-reload
 | |
|   Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
 | |
|   The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
 | |
|   program section.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.8. HTTP-errors
 | |
| ----------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
 | |
| imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
 | |
| several places and can be fully or partially imported.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-errors <name>
 | |
|   Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
 | |
|   section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
 | |
| 
 | |
| errorfile <code> <file>
 | |
|   Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <code>    is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
 | |
|               generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
 | |
|               425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <file>    designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
 | |
|               recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
 | |
|               the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
 | |
|               error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
 | |
|               before any chroot is performed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-errors website-1
 | |
|         errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
 | |
|         errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
 | |
|         errorfile 408 /dev/null  # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-errors website-2
 | |
|         errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
 | |
|         errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
 | |
|         errorfile 408 /dev/null  # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.9. Rings
 | |
| ----------
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
 | |
| servers or traces.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ring <ringname>
 | |
|   Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
 | |
| 
 | |
| description <text>
 | |
|   The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
 | |
|   appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
 | |
| 
 | |
| format <format>
 | |
|   Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
 | |
|              one of the following :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       iso     A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
 | |
|               The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
 | |
|               designed to be used with a local log server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       local   Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
 | |
|               field is stripped. This is the default.
 | |
|               Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
 | |
|               rfc3164.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       raw     A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
 | |
|               process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
 | |
|               used in containers or during development, where the severity
 | |
|               only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
 | |
|               is the default.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
 | |
|               (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
 | |
| 
 | |
|       rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
 | |
|               (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
 | |
| 
 | |
|       short   A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
 | |
|               '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
 | |
|               and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
 | |
|               local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
 | |
|               logger consumes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
 | |
|               brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
 | |
|               process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
 | |
|               with a local log server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       timed   A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
 | |
|               '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
 | |
|               name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
 | |
|               used with a local log server.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxlen <length>
 | |
|   The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
 | |
|   including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
 | |
|   <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
 | |
| 
 | |
| server <name> <address> [param*]
 | |
|   Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
 | |
|   This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
 | |
|   these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
 | |
|   is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
 | |
|   will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
 | |
|   will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
 | |
|   respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
 | |
|   messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
 | |
|   to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
 | |
|   attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
 | |
|   "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
 | |
| 
 | |
| size <size>
 | |
|   This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
 | |
|   set to BUFSIZE.
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout connect <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout server <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     global
 | |
|         log ring@myring local7
 | |
| 
 | |
|     ring myring
 | |
|         description "My local buffer"
 | |
|         format rfc3164
 | |
|         maxlen 1200
 | |
|         size 32764
 | |
|         timeout connect 5s
 | |
|         timeout server 10s
 | |
|         server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
 | |
| 
 | |
| 3.10. Log forwarding
 | |
| -------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
 | |
| HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
 | |
| 
 | |
| log-forward <name>
 | |
|   Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
 | |
| 
 | |
| backlog <conns>
 | |
|   Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
 | |
|   on connections accept.
 | |
| 
 | |
| bind <addr> [param*]
 | |
|   Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
 | |
|   This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
 | |
|   those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
 | |
|   syslog protocol over TCP.
 | |
|   Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
 | |
|   modes as defined in rfc-6587.
 | |
| 
 | |
| dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
 | |
|   Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
 | |
|   Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
 | |
|   for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
 | |
|   "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
 | |
|   silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
 | |
| 
 | |
| log global
 | |
| log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
 | |
|     <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
 | |
|   Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
 | |
|   documentation.
 | |
|   If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
 | |
|   Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
 | |
|   present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
 | |
|   If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
 | |
|   exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     global
 | |
|        log stderr format iso local7
 | |
| 
 | |
|     ring myring
 | |
|         description "My local buffer"
 | |
|         format rfc5424
 | |
|         maxlen 1200
 | |
|         size 32764
 | |
|         timeout connect 5s
 | |
|         timeout server 10s
 | |
|         # syslog tcp server
 | |
|         server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
 | |
| 
 | |
|     log-forward sylog-loadb
 | |
|         dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
 | |
|         bind 127.0.0.1:1514
 | |
|         # all messages on stderr
 | |
|         log global
 | |
|         # all messages on local tcp syslog server
 | |
|         log ring@myring local0
 | |
|         # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
 | |
|         log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
 | |
|         log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
 | |
|         log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
 | |
|         log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxconn <conns>
 | |
|   Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
 | |
|   10 is the default.
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout client <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 4. Proxies
 | |
| ----------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
 | |
|  - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
 | |
|  - frontend <name>   [ from <defaults_name> ]
 | |
|  - backend  <name>   [ from <defaults_name> ]
 | |
|  - listen   <name>   [ from <defaults_name> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
| A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
 | |
| connections.
 | |
| 
 | |
| A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
 | |
| to forward incoming connections.
 | |
| 
 | |
| A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
 | |
| parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
 | |
| 
 | |
| A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
 | |
| ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
 | |
| sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
 | |
| the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
 | |
| explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
 | |
| from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
 | |
| "from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
 | |
| for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
 | |
| to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
 | |
| optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
 | |
| are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
 | |
| any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
 | |
| names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
 | |
| that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
 | |
| duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
 | |
| names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
 | |
| settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
 | |
| of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
 | |
| profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
 | |
| timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
 | |
| 
 | |
| All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
 | |
| '-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
 | |
| case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
 | |
| logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
 | |
| proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
 | |
| However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
 | |
| name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
 | |
| and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
 | |
| bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
 | |
| protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
 | |
| modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
 | |
| arbitrary criteria.
 | |
| 
 | |
| In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
 | |
| a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
 | |
| the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
 | |
|     requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
 | |
|     between responses and new requests.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
 | |
|     connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
 | |
|     client-facing connection remains open.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
 | |
|     the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
 | |
| frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
 | |
| following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
 | |
| weakest option and close is the strongest.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                    Backend mode
 | |
| 
 | |
|                 | KAL | SCL | CLO
 | |
|             ----+-----+-----+----
 | |
|             KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
 | |
|             ----+-----+-----+----
 | |
|    mode     SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
 | |
|             ----+-----+-----+----
 | |
|             CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
 | |
| only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
 | |
| within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
 | |
| as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
 | |
| content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
 | |
| and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
 | |
| possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
 | |
| 
 | |
| There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
 | |
| first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
 | |
| processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
 | |
| second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
 | |
| protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
 | |
| is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
 | |
| new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
 | |
| to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
 | |
| process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
 | |
| already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
 | |
| HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
 | |
| evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
 | |
| one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
 | |
| 
 | |
| There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
 | |
| performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
 | |
| tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
 | |
| preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
 | |
| analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
 | |
| HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
 | |
| header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
 | |
| mitigate this drawback.
 | |
| 
 | |
| There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
 | |
| method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
 | |
| set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
 | |
| in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
 | |
| is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
 | |
| to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
 | |
| above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
 | |
| to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
 | |
| "switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
 | |
| frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
 | |
| frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
 | |
| as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
 | |
| upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
 | |
| on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
 | |
| the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
 | |
| upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
 | |
| frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
 | |
| remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 4.1. Proxy keywords matrix
 | |
| --------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
 | |
| limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
 | |
| they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
 | |
| limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
 | |
| marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
 | |
| option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
 | |
| and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
 | |
| with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
 | |
| specified in a previous "defaults" section.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|  keyword                              defaults   frontend   listen    backend
 | |
| ------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
 | |
| acl                                       -          X         X         X
 | |
| backlog                                   X          X         X         -
 | |
| balance                                   X          -         X         X
 | |
| bind                                      -          X         X         -
 | |
| bind-process                              X          X         X         X
 | |
| capture cookie                            -          X         X         -
 | |
| capture request header                    -          X         X         -
 | |
| capture response header                   -          X         X         -
 | |
| clitcpka-cnt                              X          X         X         -
 | |
| clitcpka-idle                             X          X         X         -
 | |
| clitcpka-intvl                            X          X         X         -
 | |
| compression                               X          X         X         X
 | |
| cookie                                    X          -         X         X
 | |
| declare capture                           -          X         X         -
 | |
| default-server                            X          -         X         X
 | |
| default_backend                           X          X         X         -
 | |
| description                               -          X         X         X
 | |
| disabled                                  X          X         X         X
 | |
| dispatch                                  -          -         X         X
 | |
| email-alert from                          X          X         X         X
 | |
| email-alert level                         X          X         X         X
 | |
| email-alert mailers                       X          X         X         X
 | |
| email-alert myhostname                    X          X         X         X
 | |
| email-alert to                            X          X         X         X
 | |
| enabled                                   X          X         X         X
 | |
| errorfile                                 X          X         X         X
 | |
| errorfiles                                X          X         X         X
 | |
| errorloc                                  X          X         X         X
 | |
| errorloc302                               X          X         X         X
 | |
| -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
 | |
| errorloc303                               X          X         X         X
 | |
| force-persist                             -          -         X         X
 | |
| filter                                    -          X         X         X
 | |
| fullconn                                  X          -         X         X
 | |
| grace                                     X          X         X         X
 | |
| hash-type                                 X          -         X         X
 | |
| http-after-response                       -          X         X         X
 | |
| http-check comment                        X          -         X         X
 | |
| http-check connect                        X          -         X         X
 | |
| http-check disable-on-404                 X          -         X         X
 | |
| http-check expect                         X          -         X         X
 | |
| http-check send                           X          -         X         X
 | |
| http-check send-state                     X          -         X         X
 | |
| http-check set-var                        X          -         X         X
 | |
| http-check unset-var                      X          -         X         X
 | |
| http-error                                X          X         X         X
 | |
| http-request                              -          X         X         X
 | |
| http-response                             -          X         X         X
 | |
| http-reuse                                X          -         X         X
 | |
| http-send-name-header                     -          -         X         X
 | |
| id                                        -          X         X         X
 | |
| ignore-persist                            -          -         X         X
 | |
| load-server-state-from-file               X          -         X         X
 | |
| log                                  (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| log-format                                X          X         X         -
 | |
| log-format-sd                             X          X         X         -
 | |
| log-tag                                   X          X         X         X
 | |
| max-keep-alive-queue                      X          -         X         X
 | |
| maxconn                                   X          X         X         -
 | |
| mode                                      X          X         X         X
 | |
| monitor fail                              -          X         X         -
 | |
| monitor-uri                               X          X         X         -
 | |
| option abortonclose                  (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option accept-invalid-http-request   (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option accept-invalid-http-response  (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option allbackups                    (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option checkcache                    (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option clitcpka                      (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option contstats                     (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option disable-h2-upgrade            (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option dontlog-normal                (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option dontlognull                   (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
 | |
| option forwardfor                         X          X         X         X
 | |
| option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client   (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server   (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option http-buffer-request           (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option http-ignore-probes            (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option http-keep-alive               (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option http-no-delay                 (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option http-pretend-keepalive        (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option http-server-close             (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option http-use-proxy-header         (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option httpchk                            X          -         X         X
 | |
| option httpclose                     (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option httplog                            X          X         X         -
 | |
| option http_proxy                    (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option independent-streams           (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option ldap-check                         X          -         X         X
 | |
| option external-check                     X          -         X         X
 | |
| option log-health-checks             (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option log-separate-errors           (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option logasap                       (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option mysql-check                        X          -         X         X
 | |
| option nolinger                      (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option originalto                         X          X         X         X
 | |
| option persist                       (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option pgsql-check                        X          -         X         X
 | |
| option prefer-last-server            (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option redispatch                    (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option redis-check                        X          -         X         X
 | |
| option smtpchk                            X          -         X         X
 | |
| option socket-stats                  (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option splice-auto                   (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option splice-request                (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option splice-response               (*)  X          X         X         X
 | |
| option spop-check                         -          -         -         X
 | |
| option srvtcpka                      (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option ssl-hello-chk                      X          -         X         X
 | |
| -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
 | |
| option tcp-check                          X          -         X         X
 | |
| option tcp-smart-accept              (*)  X          X         X         -
 | |
| option tcp-smart-connect             (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| option tcpka                              X          X         X         X
 | |
| option tcplog                             X          X         X         X
 | |
| option transparent                   (*)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| external-check command                    X          -         X         X
 | |
| external-check path                       X          -         X         X
 | |
| persist rdp-cookie                        X          -         X         X
 | |
| rate-limit sessions                       X          X         X         -
 | |
| redirect                                  -          X         X         X
 | |
| -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
 | |
| retries                                   X          -         X         X
 | |
| retry-on                                  X          -         X         X
 | |
| server                                    -          -         X         X
 | |
| server-state-file-name                    X          -         X         X
 | |
| server-template                           -          -         X         X
 | |
| source                                    X          -         X         X
 | |
| srvtcpka-cnt                              X          -         X         X
 | |
| srvtcpka-idle                             X          -         X         X
 | |
| srvtcpka-intvl                            X          -         X         X
 | |
| stats admin                               -          X         X         X
 | |
| stats auth                                X          X         X         X
 | |
| stats enable                              X          X         X         X
 | |
| stats hide-version                        X          X         X         X
 | |
| stats http-request                        -          X         X         X
 | |
| stats realm                               X          X         X         X
 | |
| stats refresh                             X          X         X         X
 | |
| stats scope                               X          X         X         X
 | |
| stats show-desc                           X          X         X         X
 | |
| stats show-legends                        X          X         X         X
 | |
| stats show-node                           X          X         X         X
 | |
| stats uri                                 X          X         X         X
 | |
| -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
 | |
| stick match                               -          -         X         X
 | |
| stick on                                  -          -         X         X
 | |
| stick store-request                       -          -         X         X
 | |
| stick store-response                      -          -         X         X
 | |
| stick-table                               -          X         X         X
 | |
| tcp-check comment                         X          -         X         X
 | |
| tcp-check connect                         X          -         X         X
 | |
| tcp-check expect                          X          -         X         X
 | |
| tcp-check send                            X          -         X         X
 | |
| tcp-check send-lf                         X          -         X         X
 | |
| tcp-check send-binary                     X          -         X         X
 | |
| tcp-check send-binary-lf                  X          -         X         X
 | |
| tcp-check set-var                         X          -         X         X
 | |
| tcp-check unset-var                       X          -         X         X
 | |
| tcp-request connection                    -          X         X         -
 | |
| tcp-request content                       -          X         X         X
 | |
| tcp-request inspect-delay                 -          X         X         X
 | |
| tcp-request session                       -          X         X         -
 | |
| tcp-response content                      -          -         X         X
 | |
| tcp-response inspect-delay                -          -         X         X
 | |
| timeout check                             X          -         X         X
 | |
| timeout client                            X          X         X         -
 | |
| timeout client-fin                        X          X         X         -
 | |
| timeout connect                           X          -         X         X
 | |
| timeout http-keep-alive                   X          X         X         X
 | |
| timeout http-request                      X          X         X         X
 | |
| timeout queue                             X          -         X         X
 | |
| timeout server                            X          -         X         X
 | |
| timeout server-fin                        X          -         X         X
 | |
| timeout tarpit                            X          X         X         X
 | |
| timeout tunnel                            X          -         X         X
 | |
| transparent                 (deprecated)  X          -         X         X
 | |
| unique-id-format                          X          X         X         -
 | |
| unique-id-header                          X          X         X         -
 | |
| use_backend                               -          X         X         -
 | |
| use-fcgi-app                              -          -         X         X
 | |
| use-server                                -          -         X         X
 | |
| ------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
 | |
|  keyword                              defaults   frontend   listen    backend
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 4.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
 | |
| ---------------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
 | |
|   Declare or complete an access list.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         acl invalid_src  src          0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
 | |
|         acl invalid_src  src_port     0:1023
 | |
|         acl local_dst    hdr(host) -i localhost
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See section 7 about ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| backlog <conns>
 | |
|   Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <conns>   is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
 | |
|               system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
 | |
|               connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
 | |
|   the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
 | |
|   tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
 | |
|   sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
 | |
|   the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
 | |
|   to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
 | |
|   sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
 | |
|   backlog parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
 | |
|   used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
 | |
|   two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
 | |
| balance url_param <param> [check_post]
 | |
|   Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
 | |
|                 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
 | |
|                 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
 | |
|                 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       roundrobin  Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
 | |
|                   This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
 | |
|                   processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
 | |
|                   is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
 | |
|                   on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
 | |
|                   design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
 | |
|                   large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
 | |
|                   for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
 | |
|                   requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
 | |
|                   receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
 | |
|                   indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
 | |
|                   it, so that you don't worry.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       static-rr   Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
 | |
|                   This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
 | |
|                   static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
 | |
|                   fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
 | |
|                   limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
 | |
|                   up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
 | |
|                   the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
 | |
|                   run (around -1%).
 | |
| 
 | |
|       leastconn   The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
 | |
|                   connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
 | |
|                   of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
 | |
|                   of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
 | |
|                   expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
 | |
|                   suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
 | |
|                   algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
 | |
|                   adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
 | |
|                   also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
 | |
|                   the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       first       The first server with available connection slots receives the
 | |
|                   connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
 | |
|                   identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
 | |
|                   defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
 | |
|                   reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
 | |
|                   not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
 | |
|                   The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
 | |
|                   number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
 | |
|                   during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
 | |
|                   weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
 | |
|                   or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
 | |
|                   order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
 | |
|                   that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
 | |
|                   them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
 | |
|                   turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
 | |
|                   using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       source      The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
 | |
|                   weight of the running servers to designate which server will
 | |
|                   receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
 | |
|                   address will always reach the same server as long as no
 | |
|                   server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
 | |
|                   number of running servers changing, many clients will be
 | |
|                   directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
 | |
|                   used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
 | |
|                   be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
 | |
|                   to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
 | |
|                   static by default, which means that changing a server's
 | |
|                   weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
 | |
|                   changed using "hash-type".
 | |
| 
 | |
|       uri         This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
 | |
|                   the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
 | |
|                   is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
 | |
|                   the running servers. The result designates which server will
 | |
|                   receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
 | |
|                   always be directed to the same server as long as no server
 | |
|                   goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
 | |
|                   anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
 | |
|                   Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
 | |
|                   This algorithm is static by default, which means that
 | |
|                   changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
 | |
|                   but this can be changed using "hash-type".
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
 | |
|                   "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
 | |
|                   options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
 | |
|                   based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
 | |
|                   indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
 | |
|                   characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
 | |
|                   Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
 | |
|                   URIs start with a leading "/".
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
 | |
|                   to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
 | |
|                   slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
 | |
|                   evaluation stops when either is reached.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
 | |
|                   at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
 | |
|                   authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
 | |
|                   and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       url_param   The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
 | |
|                   the query string of each HTTP GET request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
 | |
|                   request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
 | |
|                   when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
 | |
|                   ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
 | |
|                   analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
 | |
|                   received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
 | |
|                   that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
 | |
|                   scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
 | |
|                   be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
 | |
|                   an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
 | |
|                   a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
 | |
|                   weight of the running servers. The result designates which
 | |
|                   server will receive the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
 | |
|                   that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
 | |
|                   long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
 | |
|                   the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
 | |
|                   applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
 | |
|                   backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
 | |
|                   that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
 | |
|                   effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
 | |
| 
 | |
|       hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
 | |
|                   request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
 | |
|                   the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
 | |
|                   header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
 | |
|                   roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
 | |
|                   reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
 | |
|                   specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
 | |
|                   value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   This algorithm is static by default, which means that
 | |
|                   changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
 | |
|                   but this can be changed using "hash-type".
 | |
| 
 | |
|       random
 | |
|       random(<draws>)
 | |
|                   A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
 | |
|                   hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
 | |
|                   respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
 | |
|                   well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
 | |
|                   useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
 | |
|                   or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
 | |
|                   result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
 | |
|                   hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
 | |
|                   fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
 | |
|                   where servers show highly variable response times. When an
 | |
|                   argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
 | |
|                   or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
 | |
|                   the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
 | |
|                   that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
 | |
|                   significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
 | |
|                   always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
 | |
|                   and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
 | |
|                   unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
 | |
|                   will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
 | |
|                   expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
 | |
|                   will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
 | |
|                   The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
 | |
|                   distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
 | |
|                   the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
 | |
|                   http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
 | |
| 
 | |
|       rdp-cookie
 | |
|       rdp-cookie(<name>)
 | |
|                   The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
 | |
|                   looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
 | |
|                   with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
 | |
|                   is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
 | |
|                   persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
 | |
|                   same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
 | |
|                   cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
 | |
|                   used instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
 | |
|                   RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
 | |
|                   you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
 | |
|                   a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   This algorithm is static by default, which means that
 | |
|                   changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
 | |
|                   but this can be changed using "hash-type".
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
 | |
|                 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
 | |
|                 optional argument.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
 | |
|   algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
 | |
|   for each backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
 | |
|   based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
 | |
|   to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
 | |
|   NTLM relies on.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|         balance roundrobin
 | |
|         balance url_param userid
 | |
|         balance url_param session_id check_post 64
 | |
|         balance hdr(User-Agent)
 | |
|         balance hdr(host)
 | |
|         balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
 | |
|   extension with "url_param" must be considered :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
 | |
|       to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
 | |
|       may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
 | |
|       restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
 | |
|       the body. (see acl http_end)
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
 | |
|       make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
 | |
|       defaults to 16 kB.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
 | |
|       fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
 | |
|       Round Robin.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
 | |
|       If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
 | |
|       selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
 | |
|       actually appeared in the first chunk).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
 | |
|       contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
 | |
|       white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
 | |
|       might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
 | |
|       type message bodies.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
 | |
| bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
 | |
|   Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <address>     is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
 | |
|                   address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
 | |
|                   listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
 | |
|                   listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
 | |
|                   special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
 | |
|                   Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
 | |
|                   address to force the family regardless of the address format,
 | |
|                   which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
 | |
|                   no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
 | |
|                     - 'ipv4@'  -> address is always IPv4
 | |
|                     - 'ipv6@'  -> address is always IPv6
 | |
|                     - 'udp@'   -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
 | |
|                       protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
 | |
|                       supported only in log-forward sections.
 | |
|                     - 'udp4@'  -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
 | |
|                       is used. Currently those listeners are supported
 | |
|                       only in log-forward sections.
 | |
|                     - 'udp6@'  -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
 | |
|                       is used. Currently those listeners are supported
 | |
|                       only in log-forward sections.
 | |
|                     - 'unix@'  -> address is a path to a local unix socket
 | |
|                     - 'abns@'  -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
 | |
|                       Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
 | |
|                             do not cope well with multi-process mode during
 | |
|                             soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
 | |
|                             nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
 | |
|                             new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
 | |
|                             will be able to rebind to the socket.
 | |
|                     - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
 | |
|                       parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
 | |
|                       be listening.
 | |
|                     - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
 | |
|                       connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
 | |
|                       to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
 | |
|                       was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
 | |
|                   You may want to reference some environment variables in the
 | |
|                   address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
 | |
|                   variables.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <port_range>  is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
 | |
|                   proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
 | |
|                   above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
 | |
|                   the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
 | |
|                   after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
 | |
|                    - a numerical port (ex: '80')
 | |
|                    - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
 | |
|                      and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
 | |
|                      the range.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
 | |
|                   every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
 | |
|                   descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
 | |
|                   with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
 | |
|                   <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
 | |
|                   instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
 | |
|                   to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
 | |
|                   privileges to start the program, which are independent of
 | |
|                   the 'uid' parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <path>        is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
 | |
|                   alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
 | |
|                   receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
 | |
|                   The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
 | |
|                   It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
 | |
|                   the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
 | |
|                   followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
 | |
|                   for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <param*>      is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
 | |
|                   same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
 | |
|                   options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
 | |
|                   refer to section 5 to for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
 | |
|   commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
 | |
|   fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
 | |
|   a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
 | |
|   in a frontend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         listen http_proxy
 | |
|             bind :80,:443
 | |
|             bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
 | |
|             bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
 | |
| 
 | |
|         listen http_https_proxy
 | |
|             bind :80
 | |
|             bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
 | |
| 
 | |
|         listen http_https_proxy_explicit
 | |
|             bind ipv6@:80
 | |
|             bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
 | |
|             bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
 | |
| 
 | |
|         listen external_bind_app1
 | |
|             bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
 | |
|         sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
 | |
|         such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
 | |
|         ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
 | |
|         make it compatible with HAProxy's.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
 | |
|              documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
 | |
|   Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     all           All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
 | |
|                   may be used to override a default value.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     odd           This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
 | |
|                   option may be combined with other numbers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     even          This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
 | |
|                   option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
 | |
|                   with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
 | |
|                   missing from all processes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     process_num   The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
 | |
|                   whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
 | |
|                   the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
 | |
|                   higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
 | |
|                   the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
 | |
|                   process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
 | |
|                   will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
 | |
|                   specified, or to all processes otherwise.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
 | |
|   is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
 | |
|   ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
 | |
|   'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
 | |
|   and 'even' instances.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
 | |
|   using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
 | |
|   Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
 | |
|   word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
 | |
|   please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
 | |
|   the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
 | |
|   easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
 | |
|   backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         listen app_ip1
 | |
|             bind 10.0.0.1:80
 | |
|             bind-process odd
 | |
| 
 | |
|         listen app_ip2
 | |
|             bind 10.0.0.2:80
 | |
|             bind-process even
 | |
| 
 | |
|         listen management
 | |
|             bind 10.0.0.3:80
 | |
|             bind-process 1 2 3 4
 | |
| 
 | |
|         listen management
 | |
|             bind 10.0.0.4:80
 | |
|             bind-process 1-4
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture cookie <name> len <length>
 | |
|   Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>    is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
 | |
|               to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
 | |
|               sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
 | |
|               useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
 | |
|               and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <length>  is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
 | |
|               include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
 | |
|               standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
 | |
|               right if it exceeds <length>.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
 | |
|   "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
 | |
|   check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
 | |
|   users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
 | |
|   will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
 | |
|   server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
 | |
|   the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
 | |
|   backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
 | |
|   "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
 | |
|   by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
 | |
|   is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
 | |
|             section 8 about logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture request header <name> len <length>
 | |
|   Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>    is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
 | |
|               case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
 | |
|               appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
 | |
|               upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
 | |
|               value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <length>  is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
 | |
|               report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
 | |
|               it exceeds <length>.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
 | |
|   value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
 | |
|   are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
 | |
|   in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
 | |
|   headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
 | |
|   header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
 | |
|   "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
 | |
|   differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
 | |
|   environments to find where the request came from.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
 | |
|   logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
 | |
|   you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
 | |
|   braces.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
 | |
|   length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
 | |
|   In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
 | |
|   can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
 | |
|   in a "defaults" section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         capture request header Host len 15
 | |
|         capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
 | |
|         capture request header Referer len 15
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
 | |
|              about logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture response header <name> len <length>
 | |
|   Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>    is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
 | |
|               case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
 | |
|               appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
 | |
|               upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
 | |
|               value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <length>  is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
 | |
|               report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
 | |
|               it exceeds <length>.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
 | |
|   result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
 | |
|   request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
 | |
|   a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
 | |
|   the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
 | |
|   string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
 | |
|   header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
 | |
|   "Location" header to track redirections.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
 | |
|   length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
 | |
|   In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
 | |
|   can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
 | |
|   in a "defaults" section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         capture response header Content-length len 9
 | |
|         capture response header Location len 15
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
 | |
|              about logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| clitcpka-cnt <count>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
 | |
|   the connection on the client side.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <count>   is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
 | |
|   is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
 | |
|   The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
 | |
|   known to work on Linux.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| clitcpka-idle <timeout>
 | |
|   Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
 | |
|   keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
 | |
|   client side.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
 | |
|               sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
 | |
|               but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
 | |
|               unit, as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
 | |
|   is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
 | |
|   The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
 | |
|   known to work on Linux.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
 | |
|   Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
 | |
|               in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
 | |
|               is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
 | |
|               document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
 | |
|   is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
 | |
|   The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
 | |
|   known to work on Linux.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| compression algo <algorithm> ...
 | |
| compression type <mime type> ...
 | |
| compression offload
 | |
|   Enable HTTP compression.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     algo     is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
 | |
|     type     is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
 | |
|     offload  makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The currently supported algorithms are :
 | |
|     identity     this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
 | |
|                  the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
 | |
|                  data.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     gzip         applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
 | |
|                  support for zlib or libslz was built in.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     deflate      same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
 | |
|                  Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
 | |
|                  browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
 | |
|                  strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
 | |
|                  experimentation. This setting is only available when support
 | |
|                  for zlib or libslz was built in.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     raw-deflate  same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
 | |
|                  alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
 | |
|                  browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
 | |
|                  it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
 | |
|                  and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
 | |
|                  with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
 | |
|                  to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
 | |
|                  available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
 | |
|   header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
 | |
|   If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
 | |
|   will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
 | |
|   compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
 | |
|   there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
 | |
|   matching response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
 | |
|   prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
 | |
|   recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
 | |
|   will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
 | |
|   deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
 | |
|   with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
 | |
|   In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
 | |
|   invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
 | |
|   configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
 | |
|   so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
 | |
|   then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
 | |
|   ignored when set in a defaults section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Compression is disabled when:
 | |
|     * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
 | |
|       "Accept-Encoding" header
 | |
|     * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
 | |
|     * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
 | |
|     * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
 | |
|       "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
 | |
|     * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
 | |
|       "multipart"
 | |
|     * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
 | |
|       header
 | |
|     * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
 | |
|       and later
 | |
|     * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
 | |
|       response is already compressed (see compression offload)
 | |
|     * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|         compression algo gzip
 | |
|         compression type text/html text/plain
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
 | |
|               [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
 | |
|               [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
 | |
|               [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
 | |
|   Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>    is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
 | |
|               inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
 | |
|               the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
 | |
|               brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
 | |
|               Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
 | |
|               conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
 | |
|               backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
 | |
|               HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
 | |
|               between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     rewrite   This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
 | |
|               server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
 | |
|               server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
 | |
|               of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
 | |
|               headers is left to the application. The application can then
 | |
|               decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
 | |
|               cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
 | |
|               doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
 | |
|               behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
 | |
|               start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
 | |
|               incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
 | |
| 
 | |
|     insert    This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
 | |
|               be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
 | |
| 
 | |
|               already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
 | |
|               server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
 | |
|               emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
 | |
|               processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
 | |
|               existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
 | |
|               will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
 | |
|               client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
 | |
|               the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
 | |
|               caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
 | |
|               "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
 | |
|               compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
 | |
| 
 | |
|     prefix    This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
 | |
|               cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
 | |
|               This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
 | |
|               does not support more than one single cookie and the application
 | |
|               already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
 | |
|               named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
 | |
|               and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
 | |
|               requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
 | |
|               Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
 | |
|               this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
 | |
|               not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
 | |
|               recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
 | |
|               cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     indirect  When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
 | |
|               client which already has a valid one for the server which has
 | |
|               processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
 | |
|               it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
 | |
|               "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
 | |
|               requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
 | |
|               mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
 | |
|               Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
 | |
|               "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
 | |
|               clients.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     nocache   This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
 | |
|               when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
 | |
|               ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
 | |
|               a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
 | |
|               persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
 | |
|               instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
 | |
|               outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
 | |
|               leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
 | |
|               See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     postonly  This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
 | |
|               on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
 | |
|               "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
 | |
|               this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
 | |
|               Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
 | |
|               first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
 | |
|               efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
 | |
|               persistence cookie in the cache.
 | |
|               See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     preserve  This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
 | |
|               allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
 | |
|               case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
 | |
|               untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
 | |
|               logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
 | |
|               emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
 | |
|               the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
 | |
|               check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
 | |
|               shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
 | |
|               they logout.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     httponly  This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
 | |
|               when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
 | |
|               user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
 | |
|               Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     secure    This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
 | |
|               a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
 | |
|               never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
 | |
|               that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
 | |
|               SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
 | |
|               this attribute.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     domain    This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
 | |
|               inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
 | |
|               name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
 | |
|               use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
 | |
|               specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
 | |
|               times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
 | |
|               domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
 | |
|               10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     maxidle   This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
 | |
|               time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
 | |
|               sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
 | |
|               Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
 | |
|               than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
 | |
|               be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
 | |
|               response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
 | |
|               prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
 | |
|               too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
 | |
|               this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
 | |
|               accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
 | |
|               ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
 | |
|               date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
 | |
|               lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
 | |
|               the site.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     maxlife   This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
 | |
|               time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
 | |
|               mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
 | |
|               this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
 | |
|               of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
 | |
|               the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
 | |
|               the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
 | |
|               Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
 | |
|               ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
 | |
|               kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
 | |
|               not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
 | |
|               maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
 | |
|               prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
 | |
|               too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
 | |
|               is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
 | |
|               redispatch after some absolute delay.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     dynamic   Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
 | |
|               dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
 | |
|               of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
 | |
|               "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
 | |
|               The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
 | |
|               and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     attr      This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
 | |
|               cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
 | |
|               characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
 | |
|               repeated.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
 | |
|   declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
 | |
|   indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
 | |
|   is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|         cookie JSESSIONID prefix
 | |
|         cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
 | |
|         cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
 | |
|         cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
 | |
|   Declares a capture slot.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
 | |
|   reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
 | |
|   capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
 | |
|   for use in the response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
 | |
|             "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
 | |
|             "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| default-server [param*]
 | |
|   Change default options for a server in a backend
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <param*>  is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
 | |
|               keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
 | |
|               section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
 | |
|               details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         default-server inter 1000 weight 13
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| default_backend <backend>
 | |
|   Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
 | |
|   "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
 | |
|   used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
 | |
|   will catch all undetermined requests.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
| 
 | |
|         use_backend     dynamic  if  url_dyn
 | |
|         use_backend     static   if  url_css url_img extension_img
 | |
|         default_backend dynamic
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "use_backend"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| description <string>
 | |
|   Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : string
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
 | |
|   stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
 | |
|   it describes.
 | |
|   No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| disabled
 | |
|   Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
 | |
|   liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
 | |
|   will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
 | |
|   created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
 | |
|   will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
 | |
|   is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
 | |
|   keyword in a "defaults" section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "enabled"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| dispatch <address>:<port>
 | |
|   Set a default server address
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
 | |
|               resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
 | |
|               during start-up.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <ports>   is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
 | |
|               to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
 | |
|               possible with normal servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
 | |
|   server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
 | |
|   persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
 | |
|   syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
 | |
|   use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "server"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| dynamic-cookie-key <string>
 | |
|   Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : The secret key to be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
 | |
|   a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
 | |
|   specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
 | |
|   server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
 | |
|   That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
 | |
|   even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
 | |
| 
 | |
| enabled
 | |
|   Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
 | |
|   defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "disabled"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| errorfile <code> <file>
 | |
|   Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <code>    is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
 | |
|               generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
 | |
|               413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <file>    designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
 | |
|               recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
 | |
|               the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
 | |
|               error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
 | |
|               before any chroot is performed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
 | |
|   errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
 | |
|   This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
 | |
|   HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
 | |
|   (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
 | |
|   returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
 | |
|   (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
 | |
|   servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
 | |
|   image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
 | |
|   so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
 | |
|   "tune.maxrewrite").
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
 | |
|   For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
 | |
|   chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
 | |
|   simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
 | |
|   403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
 | |
|         errorfile 408 /dev/null  # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
 | |
|         errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
 | |
|         errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
 | |
|   Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
 | |
|   section.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>  is the name of an existing http-errors section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <code>  is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
 | |
|             Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
 | |
|             403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
 | |
|             and 504.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
 | |
|   in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
 | |
|   http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
 | |
|   the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
 | |
|   defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
 | |
|   ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
 | |
|   hand using "errorfile" directives.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
 | |
|              "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         errorfiles generic
 | |
| 	errorfiles site-1 403 404
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| errorloc <code> <url>
 | |
| errorloc302 <code> <url>
 | |
|   Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <code>    is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
 | |
|               generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
 | |
|               413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <url>     it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
 | |
|               either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
 | |
|               or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
 | |
|               Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
 | |
|               loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
 | |
|   errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
 | |
|   This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
 | |
|   client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
 | |
|   quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
 | |
|   sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
 | |
|   work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
 | |
|   status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
 | |
|   request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| errorloc303 <code> <url>
 | |
|   Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <code>    is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
 | |
|               generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
 | |
|               413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <url>     it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
 | |
|               either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
 | |
|               or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
 | |
|               Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
 | |
|               loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
 | |
|   errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
 | |
|   This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
 | |
|   client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
 | |
|   solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
 | |
|   possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
 | |
|   it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| email-alert from <emailaddr>
 | |
|   Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
 | |
|   of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
 | |
|   and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
 | |
|              "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
 | |
|              mailers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| email-alert level <level>
 | |
|   Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
 | |
|   sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
 | |
|               emerg alert crit err warning notice info  debug
 | |
|             The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default level is alert
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
 | |
|   "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
 | |
|   for the proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Alerts are sent when :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
 | |
|   * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
 | |
|   * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
 | |
|     is notice or lower
 | |
|   * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
 | |
|      and a health check status update occurs
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
 | |
|              "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
 | |
|              section 3.6 about mailers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| email-alert mailers <mailersect>
 | |
|   Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
 | |
|   and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
 | |
|              "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| email-alert myhostname <hostname>
 | |
|   Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
 | |
|   mailers.
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default the systems hostname is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
 | |
|   "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
 | |
|   for the proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
 | |
|              "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| email-alert to <emailaddr>
 | |
|   Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
 | |
|   header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
 | |
|   and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
 | |
|              "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
 | |
|   Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
 | |
|   force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
 | |
|   to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
 | |
|   possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
 | |
|   marked down for maintenance operations.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
 | |
|   conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
 | |
|   a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
 | |
|   server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
 | |
|   configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
 | |
|   use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
 | |
|   the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
 | |
|   page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
 | |
|   to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
 | |
|   "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
 | |
|   is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
 | |
|              and section 7 about ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| filter <name> [param*]
 | |
|   Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |   yes    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>     is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
 | |
|                referenced in section 9.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <param*>   is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
 | |
|                parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
 | |
|                filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
 | |
|                filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
 | |
|   same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|       listen
 | |
|         bind *:80
 | |
| 
 | |
|         filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
 | |
|         filter compression
 | |
|         filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
 | |
| 
 | |
|         compression algo gzip
 | |
|         compression offload
 | |
| 
 | |
|         server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : section 9.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| fullconn <conns>
 | |
|   Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <conns>   is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
 | |
|               servers use the maximal number of connections.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
 | |
|   of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
 | |
|   "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
 | |
|   load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
 | |
|   never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
 | |
|   values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
 | |
|   makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
 | |
|   push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
 | |
|   exceptional loads.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
 | |
|   10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
 | |
|   backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
 | |
|   safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
 | |
|   not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|      # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
 | |
|      # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
 | |
|      # connections.
 | |
|      backend dynamic
 | |
|         fullconn   10000
 | |
|         server     srv1   dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
 | |
|         server     srv2   dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "maxconn", "server"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| grace <time> (deprecated)
 | |
|   Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <time>    is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
 | |
|               will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
 | |
|               when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
 | |
|   This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
 | |
|   external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
 | |
|   needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
 | |
|   and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
 | |
|   simplify it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| hash-balance-factor <factor>
 | |
|   Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   no   |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
 | |
|              send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
 | |
|              of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
 | |
|   enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
 | |
|   requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
 | |
|   others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
 | |
|   <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
 | |
|   then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
 | |
|   If server weights are used, they will be respected.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
 | |
|   server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
 | |
|   found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
 | |
|   lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
 | |
|   performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
 | |
|   consistent hashing mechanism.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
 | |
|   Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
 | |
|              the <function> :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       map-based   the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
 | |
|                   The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
 | |
|                   will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
 | |
|                   will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
 | |
|                   Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
 | |
|                   most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
 | |
|                   means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
 | |
|                   added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
 | |
|                   different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
 | |
|                   instance.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       consistent  the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
 | |
|                   server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
 | |
|                   server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
 | |
|                   weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
 | |
|                   slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
 | |
|                   goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
 | |
|                   server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
 | |
|                   are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
 | |
|                   However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
 | |
|                   very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
 | |
|                   server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
 | |
|                   In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
 | |
|                   balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
 | |
|                   same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
 | |
|                   hash function is specified.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <function> is the hash function to be used :
 | |
| 
 | |
|        sdbm   this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
 | |
|               reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
 | |
|               well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
 | |
|               and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
 | |
|               function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
 | |
|               is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
 | |
|               modifier may help.
 | |
| 
 | |
|        djb2   this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
 | |
|               on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
 | |
|               function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
 | |
|               works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
 | |
|               poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
 | |
|               a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|        wt6    this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
 | |
|               functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
 | |
|               is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
 | |
|               servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
 | |
|               djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
 | |
|               data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
 | |
|               parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|        crc32  this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
 | |
|               gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
 | |
|               a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
 | |
|               used on strings.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
 | |
| 
 | |
|        avalanche   This directive indicates that the result from the hash
 | |
|                    function above should not be used in its raw form but that
 | |
|                    a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
 | |
|                    purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
 | |
|                    previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
 | |
|                    the input contains some limited values or when the number of
 | |
|                    servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
 | |
|                    for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
 | |
|                    result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
 | |
|                    using the original function. Some testing might be needed
 | |
|                    with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
 | |
|                    by Bob Jenkins.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
 | |
|   default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
 | |
|   the range of the values being hashed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
|   Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
 | |
|   ones).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                 no    |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
 | |
|   7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
 | |
|   are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
 | |
|   followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
 | |
|   if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
 | |
|   rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
 | |
|   server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
 | |
|   evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
 | |
|   below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
 | |
|   instance.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
 | |
|         multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
 | |
|         http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
 | |
|     http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
 | |
|     http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
 | |
|   value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
 | |
|   Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
 | |
|   example, or to pass some internal information.
 | |
|   This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
 | |
|   Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
 | |
|   the resulting header from a previous rule.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
 | |
|   No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
 | |
|   is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
 | |
|   are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
 | |
|   (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
 | |
|   method is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
 | |
|                                    [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This works like "http-response replace-header".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # applied to:
 | |
|     Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # outputs:
 | |
|     Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
 | |
|                                  [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This works like "http-response replace-value".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # applied to:
 | |
|     Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # outputs:
 | |
|     Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
 | |
|   removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
 | |
|   the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
 | |
|                                [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
 | |
|   between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
 | |
|   by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
 | |
|   fallback.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
 | |
|     http-response set-status 431
 | |
|     # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
 | |
|     http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
 | |
|   inline.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <var-name>  The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
 | |
|                 scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|                   "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|                   "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|                   "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction
 | |
|                            (request and response)
 | |
|                   "req"  : the variable is shared only during request
 | |
|                            processing
 | |
|                   "res"  : the variable is shared only during response
 | |
|                            processing
 | |
|                 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
 | |
|                 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
 | |
|                 and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <expr>      Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|                 followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
 | |
|   does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
 | |
|   performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
 | |
|   rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
 | |
|   silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
 | |
|   rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
 | |
|   processing.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
 | |
|   when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
 | |
|   the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
 | |
|   rules evaluation.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
 | |
|   details about <var-name>.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-check comment <string>
 | |
|   Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
 | |
|   it fails.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <string>  is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
 | |
|               rule fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
 | |
|   user-friendly error reporting.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
 | |
|              "http-check expect".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
 | |
|                    [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
 | |
| 		   [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
 | |
|   Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     comment <msg>  defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     default      Use default options of the server line to do the health
 | |
|                  checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     port <expr>  if not set, check port or server port is used.
 | |
|                  It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
 | |
|                  <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
 | |
|                  65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     addr <ip>    defines the IP address to do the health check.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     send-proxy   send a PROXY protocol string
 | |
| 
 | |
|     via-socks4   enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     ssl          opens a ciphered connection
 | |
| 
 | |
|     sni <sni>    specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     alpn <alpn>  defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
 | |
|                  list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
 | |
|                  for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
 | |
|                  is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
 | |
|                  It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
 | |
|                  backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
 | |
|                  haproxy -vv.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     linger       cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
 | |
|   to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
 | |
|   describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
 | |
|   different ports or with different servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
 | |
|   directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
 | |
|   the port with a "http-check connect".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
 | |
|   the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
 | |
|   do.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
 | |
|   unset-var or comment rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|          # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
 | |
|          # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
 | |
|          # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
 | |
|          option httpchk
 | |
| 
 | |
|          http-check connect
 | |
|          http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
 | |
|          http-check expect status 200-399
 | |
|          http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
 | |
|          http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
 | |
|          http-check expect status 200-399
 | |
| 
 | |
|          server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-check disable-on-404
 | |
|   Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
 | |
|   excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
 | |
|   connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
 | |
|   to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
 | |
|   that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
 | |
|   generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
 | |
|   will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
 | |
|   reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
 | |
|   option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
 | |
|   is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
 | |
|   responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
 | |
|   server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
 | |
|   evaluated for running servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
 | |
|                   [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
 | |
|                   [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
 | |
|                   [!] <match> <pattern>
 | |
|   Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     comment <msg>  defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     min-recv  is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
 | |
|               evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
 | |
|               is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
 | |
|               option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
 | |
|               avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
 | |
|               incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
 | |
|               string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
 | |
|               ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
 | |
|               the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
 | |
|               result is always conclusive.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     ok-status <st>     is optional and can be used to set the check status if
 | |
|                        the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
 | |
|                        the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
 | |
|                        "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
 | |
|                          - L7OK  : check passed on layer 7
 | |
|                          - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
 | |
|                                    server to NOLB state.
 | |
|                          - L6OK  : check passed on layer 6
 | |
|                          - L4OK  : check passed on layer 4
 | |
|                        By default "L7OK" is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     error-status <st>  is optional and can be used to set the check status if
 | |
|                        an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
 | |
|                        "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
 | |
|                        supported :
 | |
|                          - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
 | |
|                                    server to NOLB state.
 | |
|                          - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
 | |
|                          - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
 | |
|                          - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
 | |
|                          - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
 | |
|                        By default "L7RSP" is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     tout-status <st>   is optional and can be used to set the check status if
 | |
|                        a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
 | |
|                        "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
 | |
|                          - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
 | |
|                          - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
 | |
|                          - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
 | |
|                        By default "L7TOUT" is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     on-success <fmt>   is optional and can be used to customize the
 | |
|                        informational message reported in logs if the expect
 | |
|                        rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
 | |
|                        in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     on-error <fmt>     is optional and can be used to customize the
 | |
|                        informational message reported in logs if an error
 | |
|                        occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
 | |
|                        log-format string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <match>   is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
 | |
|               response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
 | |
|               "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
 | |
|               exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
 | |
|               between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
 | |
|               details on the supported keywords.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
 | |
|               expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
 | |
|               the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
 | |
|               usual backslash ('\').
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
 | |
|   are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
 | |
|   it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
 | |
|   statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
 | |
|   out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     status <codes> :  test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
 | |
|                       must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
 | |
|                       codes. A health check response will be considered as
 | |
|                       valid if the response's status code matches any status
 | |
|                       code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
 | |
|                       keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
 | |
|                       considered invalid if the status code matches.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
 | |
|                       A health check response will be considered valid if the
 | |
|                       response's status code matches the expression. If the
 | |
|                       "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
 | |
|                       will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
 | |
|                       This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     hdr  { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
 | |
|          [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
 | |
|                       test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
 | |
|                       headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
 | |
|                       pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
 | |
|                       presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
 | |
|                       applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
 | |
|                       matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
 | |
|                       match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
 | |
|                       "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
 | |
|                       method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
 | |
|                       <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
 | |
|                       parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
 | |
|                       string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
 | |
|                       matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
 | |
|                       as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
 | |
|                       insensitive on the header names.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
 | |
|          [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
 | |
|                       test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
 | |
|                       response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
 | |
|                       keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
 | |
|                       are not considered as delimiters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
 | |
|                       A health check response will be considered valid if the
 | |
|                       response's body contains this exact string. If the
 | |
|                       "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
 | |
|                       will be considered invalid if the body contains this
 | |
|                       string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
 | |
|                       the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
 | |
|                       specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
 | |
|                       trace).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
 | |
|                       A health check response will be considered valid if the
 | |
|                       response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
 | |
|                       keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
 | |
|                       considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
 | |
|                       This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
 | |
|                       of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
 | |
|                       error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
 | |
|                       A health check response will be considered valid if the
 | |
|                       response's body contains the  string resulting of the
 | |
|                       evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
 | |
|                       If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
 | |
|                       considered invalid if the body contains the string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
 | |
|   defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
 | |
|   Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
 | |
|   "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
 | |
|   possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
 | |
|   However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
 | |
|   waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
 | |
|   it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
 | |
|   rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
 | |
|   is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
 | |
|   defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
 | |
|   is set.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
 | |
|   then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|          # only accept status 200 as valid
 | |
|          http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
 | |
| 
 | |
|          # be sure a sessid coookie is set
 | |
|          http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
 | |
| 
 | |
|          # consider SQL errors as errors
 | |
|          http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
 | |
| 
 | |
|          # consider status 5xx only as errors
 | |
|          http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
 | |
| 
 | |
|          # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
 | |
|          http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
 | |
|              and "http-check send".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
 | |
|                 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
 | |
|                 [comment <msg>]
 | |
|   Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
 | |
|   health checks.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     comment <msg>  defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     meth <method>  is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
 | |
|                    set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
 | |
|                    low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
 | |
|                    logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
 | |
|                    to invent non-standard ones.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     uri <uri>      is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
 | |
|                    to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
 | |
|                    by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
 | |
|                    other URI. Query strings are permitted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     uri-lf <fmt>   is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
 | |
|                    using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
 | |
|                    is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
 | |
|                    changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     ver <version>  is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
 | |
|                    "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
 | |
|                    1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
 | |
|                    the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
 | |
|                    to add it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     hdr <name> <fmt>  adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
 | |
|                       <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
 | |
|                       to the log-format rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     body <string>  add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
 | |
|                    HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
 | |
|                    is thus automatically added to the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     body-lf <fmt>  add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
 | |
|                    request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
 | |
|                    "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
 | |
|                    request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
 | |
|   this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
 | |
|   request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
 | |
|   "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
 | |
|   "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
 | |
|   "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
 | |
|   headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
 | |
|   deprecated.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
 | |
|   will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
 | |
|   header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
 | |
|   automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
 | |
|   Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
 | |
|   updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
 | |
|   configured request authority.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
 | |
|   requests. You should add it explicitly.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-check send-state
 | |
|   Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
 | |
|   "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
 | |
|   how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
 | |
|   manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
 | |
|   HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
 | |
|   is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
 | |
|   checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
 | |
|   interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
 | |
|   no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
 | |
|     - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
 | |
|       This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
 | |
|       unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
 | |
|       corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
 | |
|       domain sockets, it will read "unix".
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
 | |
|       ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
 | |
|       checked in multiple backends.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
 | |
|       global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
 | |
|       and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
 | |
|       helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
 | |
|       one fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
 | |
|       on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
 | |
|       connections on all servers of the same backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
 | |
|       server's queue.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example of a header received by the application server :
 | |
|     >>>  X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
 | |
|            scur=13/22; qcur=0
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
 | |
|              "http-check send".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
 | |
|   This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <var-name>  The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
 | |
|                 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
 | |
|                   "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
 | |
|                   "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
 | |
|                   "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
 | |
|                 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
 | |
|                 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
 | |
|                 and '-'.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <expr>      Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|         http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
 | |
|   Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <var-name>  The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
 | |
|                 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
 | |
|                   "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
 | |
|                   "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
 | |
|                   "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
 | |
|                 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
 | |
|                 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
 | |
|                 and '-'.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|         http-check unset-var(check.port)
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
 | |
|            [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
 | |
|                file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
 | |
|            [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
 | |
|   Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     status <code>        is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
 | |
|                          Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
 | |
|                          200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
 | |
|                          429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     content-type <type>  is the response content type, for instance
 | |
|                          "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
 | |
|                          omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
 | |
|                          payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     default-errorfiles   Reset the previously defined error message for current
 | |
|                          proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
 | |
|                          frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
 | |
|                          a frontend, the default error message is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     errorfile <file>     designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
 | |
|                          It is recommended to follow the common practice of
 | |
|                          appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
 | |
|                          not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
 | |
|                          use absolute paths, since files are read before any
 | |
|                          chroot is performed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     errorfiles <name>    designates the http-errors section to use to import
 | |
|                          the error message with the status code <code>. If no
 | |
|                          such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
 | |
|                          considered.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     file <file>          specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
 | |
|                          file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
 | |
|                          argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
 | |
|                          "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
 | |
|                          considered as a raw string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     string <str>         specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
 | |
|                          The content-type must always be set as argument to
 | |
|                          "content-type".
 | |
| 
 | |
|     lf-file <file>       specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
 | |
|                          file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
 | |
|                          argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
 | |
|                          "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
 | |
|                          evaluated as a log-format string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     lf-string <str>      specifies the log-format string to use as response
 | |
|                          payload. The content-type must always be set as
 | |
|                          argument to "content-type".
 | |
| 
 | |
|     hdr <name> <fmt>     adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
 | |
|                          is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
 | |
|                          <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
 | |
|                          This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
 | |
|   message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
 | |
|   returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
 | |
|   starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
 | |
|   response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
 | |
|   internal error will be returned.  Finally, if you consider to use some
 | |
|   http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
 | |
|   should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
 | |
|   For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
 | |
|   chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
 | |
|         handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
 | |
|         supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
 | |
|         "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
 | |
|         exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
 | |
|              "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
|   Access control for Layer 7 requests
 | |
| 
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                 no    |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
 | |
|   processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
 | |
|   met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
 | |
|   followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
 | |
|   if the condition is true.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
 | |
|   below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
 | |
|         acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
 | |
|         acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
 | |
| 
 | |
|         http-request allow if nagios
 | |
|         http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
 | |
|         http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
 | |
|         http-request deny
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
 | |
|         acl add path /addacl
 | |
|         acl del path /delacl
 | |
| 
 | |
|         acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
 | |
| 
 | |
|         http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
 | |
|         http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         acl value  req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
 | |
|         acl setmap path /setmap
 | |
|         acl delmap path /delmap
 | |
| 
 | |
|         use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
 | |
| 
 | |
|         http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
 | |
|         http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src]                     if delmap
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
 | |
|              about ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
 | |
|   file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
 | |
|   passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
 | |
|   log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
 | |
|   in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
 | |
|   lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
 | |
|   It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
 | |
|   be triggered by an HTTP request.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
 | |
|   whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
 | |
|   Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
 | |
|   connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
 | |
|   certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
 | |
|   final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
 | |
|   addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
 | |
|   header from a previous rule.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
 | |
|   No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
 | |
|   HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
 | |
|   and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
 | |
|   "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
 | |
|   returned with the response (typically the application's name).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
 | |
|   an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
 | |
|   occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
 | |
|   one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
 | |
|   responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
 | |
|   message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
 | |
|   instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
 | |
|         http-request auth unless auth_ok
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See section 6.2 about cache setup.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
 | |
|                      [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
 | |
|   converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
 | |
|   stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
 | |
|   to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
 | |
|   and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
 | |
|   into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
 | |
|   will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
 | |
|   Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
 | |
|   more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
 | |
|   captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
 | |
|   captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
 | |
|   "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
 | |
|   frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
 | |
|   ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
 | |
|   due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
 | |
|   file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
 | |
|   passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
 | |
|   log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
 | |
|   It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
 | |
|   be triggered by an HTTP request.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
 | |
|   is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
 | |
|   are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
 | |
|   (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
 | |
|   method is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
 | |
|   file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
 | |
|   passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
 | |
|   log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
 | |
|   It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
 | |
|   command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
 | |
|           [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
 | |
|               file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
 | |
|           [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
 | |
|           [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
 | |
|   By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
 | |
|   using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
 | |
|   return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
 | |
|   or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
 | |
|   "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
 | |
|   "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
 | |
|   No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
 | |
|   See also "http-request return".
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
|   This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
 | |
|   reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
 | |
|   sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
 | |
|   the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
 | |
|   pointed by <resolvers>.
 | |
|   It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
 | |
|   arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
 | |
|   When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
 | |
|   pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
 | |
|   If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
 | |
|   error occurs, then <var> is not set.
 | |
|   One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
 | |
|   based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
 | |
|   If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
 | |
|   "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
 | |
|   to 0.0.0.0.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     resolvers mydns
 | |
|       nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
 | |
|       nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
 | |
|       timeout retry   1s
 | |
|       hold valid 10s
 | |
|       hold nx 3s
 | |
|       hold other 3s
 | |
|       hold obsolete 0s
 | |
|       accepted_payload_size 8192
 | |
| 
 | |
|     frontend fe
 | |
|       bind 10.42.0.1:80
 | |
|       http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
 | |
|       http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
 | |
| 
 | |
|       # return 503 when the variable is not set,
 | |
|       # which mean DNS resolution error
 | |
|       use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       default_backend be
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend b_503
 | |
|       # dummy backend used to return 503.
 | |
|       # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
 | |
|       # 503 error page to end users
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend be
 | |
|       # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
 | |
|       # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
 | |
|       http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
 | |
|       http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
 | |
|       server clear 0.0.0.0:0
 | |
| 
 | |
|   NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
 | |
|         be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
 | |
|   This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
 | |
|   <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
 | |
|   (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
 | |
|   to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
 | |
|   HTML documents.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See RFC 8297 for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Performs normalization of the request's URI.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
 | |
|   technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
 | |
|   'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
 | |
|   prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
 | |
|   issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
 | |
|   fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
 | |
|   the supported backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
 | |
|   fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
 | |
|   filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
 | |
|   number of segments in the path.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
 | |
|   transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
 | |
|   of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
 | |
|   when improperly combined.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
 | |
|   unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
 | |
|   such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
 | |
|   turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
 | |
|   such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The following normalizers are available:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
 | |
| 
 | |
|       The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
 | |
|       that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - /#foo  -> /%23foo
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
 | |
|       be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
 | |
|       not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - /#foo  -> /
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
 | |
|       (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
 | |
|       the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - /.            -> /
 | |
|       - /./bar/       -> /bar/
 | |
|       - /a/./a        -> /a/a
 | |
|       - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
 | |
|       (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
 | |
| 
 | |
|       This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
 | |
|       their preceding segment.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
 | |
|       normalizer first if this is undesired.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
 | |
|       the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - /foo/../     -> /
 | |
|       - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
 | |
|       - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
 | |
|       - /../bar/     -> /../bar/
 | |
|       - /bar/../../  -> /../
 | |
|       - /foo//../    -> /foo/
 | |
|       - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
 | |
| 
 | |
|       If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
 | |
|       removed as well:
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - /../bar/     -> /bar/
 | |
|       - /bar/../../  -> /
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
 | |
|       into a single slash.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - //        -> /
 | |
|       - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
 | |
|       their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
 | |
| 
 | |
|       The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
 | |
|       ".", "_", and "~".
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - /%61dmin       -> /admin
 | |
|       - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
 | |
|       - /%%36%36       -> /%66           (unsafe)
 | |
|       - /%ZZ           -> /%ZZ
 | |
| 
 | |
|       If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
 | |
|       in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
 | |
|       - /%ZZ     -> HTTP 400
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
 | |
|       (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - /%6f -> /%6F
 | |
|       - /%zz -> /%zz
 | |
| 
 | |
|       If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
 | |
|       in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - /%zz -> HTTP 400
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
 | |
|       Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
 | |
|       longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|       - /?c=3&a=1&b=2         -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
 | |
|       - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2      -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
 | |
|       - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
 | |
|   the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
 | |
|   which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
 | |
|   these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
 | |
|   rule's syntax.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
 | |
|   without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
 | |
|   "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
 | |
|   connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
 | |
|                             [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
 | |
|   <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
 | |
|   completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
 | |
|   <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
 | |
|   Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
 | |
|   supported.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
 | |
|   they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
 | |
|   containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
 | |
|   contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
 | |
|   using "http-request replace-value".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # applied to:
 | |
|     Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # outputs:
 | |
|     Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # applied to:
 | |
|     User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # outputs:
 | |
|     User-Agent: foo
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
 | |
|                            [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
 | |
|   component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
 | |
|   after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
 | |
|   the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
 | |
|   query-string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
 | |
|   than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
 | |
|   performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
 | |
|     http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
 | |
|     http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
 | |
|     # or more efficient if only some requests match :
 | |
|     http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
 | |
|                            [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
 | |
|   contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
 | |
|   query-string are replaced.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
 | |
|     http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
 | |
|                            [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
 | |
|   instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
 | |
|   query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
 | |
|   against.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
 | |
|   than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
 | |
|   performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
 | |
|   by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
 | |
|   that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
 | |
|   only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
 | |
|   certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
 | |
|   works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
 | |
|   with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
 | |
|   like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
 | |
|   rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
 | |
|   to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
 | |
|   should be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
 | |
|     http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
 | |
|     http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
 | |
|                            [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
 | |
|   every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
 | |
|   entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
 | |
|   more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # applied to:
 | |
|     X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # outputs:
 | |
|     X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
 | |
|           [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
 | |
|               file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
 | |
| 	  [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
 | |
|           [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
 | |
|   default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
 | |
|   specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
 | |
|   specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
 | |
|   be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
 | |
|   or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
 | |
|   are followed to create the response :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
 | |
|     response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
 | |
|     any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
 | |
|     ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
 | |
|     considered.  If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
 | |
|     status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
 | |
|     425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
 | |
|     any, is ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
 | |
|     corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
 | |
|     "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
 | |
|     by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
 | |
|     502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
 | |
|     corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
 | |
|     HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
 | |
|     must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
 | |
|     408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
 | |
|     argument, if any, is ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
 | |
|     used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
 | |
|     must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
 | |
|     argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
 | |
|     evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
 | |
|     as a raw content.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
 | |
|     used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
 | |
|     argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
 | |
|     evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
 | |
|     considered as a raw string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
 | |
|   header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
 | |
|   arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
 | |
|   and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
 | |
|   any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
 | |
|   reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
 | |
|         if { path /ping }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico  \
 | |
|         if { path /favicon.ico }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain    \
 | |
|         lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted."  \
 | |
|         if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
 | |
|   counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
 | |
|   and the actions evaluation continues.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
 | |
|                                   [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
 | |
|   designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
 | |
|   boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
 | |
|   evaluation continues.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
 | |
|   expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
 | |
|   but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
 | |
|   privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
 | |
|   server address in the backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <expr>  Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
 | |
|             by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
 | |
|     http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
 | |
|   address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
 | |
|   expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
 | |
|   as a server address in the backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <expr>  Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|             followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
 | |
|     http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
 | |
|   long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
 | |
|   destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
 | |
|   is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
 | |
|   information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
 | |
|   external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
 | |
|   is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
 | |
|         http-request set-header X-SSL                  %[ssl_fc]
 | |
|         http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID       %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
 | |
|         http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify    %[ssl_c_verify]
 | |
|         http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN        %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
 | |
|         http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN        %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
 | |
|         http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer           %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
 | |
|         http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
 | |
|         http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter  %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
 | |
|   condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
 | |
|   keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
 | |
|   request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
 | |
|   can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
 | |
|                                   [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
 | |
|   file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
 | |
|   passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
 | |
|   log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
 | |
|   log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
 | |
|   It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
 | |
|   more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
 | |
|   with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
 | |
|   stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
 | |
|   the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
 | |
|   unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
 | |
|   table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
 | |
|   "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
 | |
|   (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
 | |
|   kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
 | |
|   string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
 | |
|   this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
 | |
|   has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
 | |
|   The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
 | |
|   line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
 | |
|   the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
 | |
|   other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
 | |
|   lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
 | |
|   prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|     This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
 | |
|     string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
 | |
|     authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
 | |
|     request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
 | |
|     This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
 | |
|     example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
 | |
| 
 | |
|     Example :
 | |
|       # prepend the host name before the path
 | |
|       http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
 | |
|   also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
 | |
|   question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
 | |
|   The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
 | |
|   range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
 | |
|   The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
 | |
|   processed. Lower values have higher priority.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
 | |
|   request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
 | |
|   in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
 | |
|   When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
 | |
|   the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
 | |
|   values have higher priority.
 | |
|   Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
 | |
|   for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
 | |
|   adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
 | |
|   priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
 | |
|   combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
 | |
|   question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
 | |
|   The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
 | |
|   contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
 | |
|   the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
 | |
|   present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
 | |
|   used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
 | |
|     http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
|   This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
 | |
|   expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
 | |
|   provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
 | |
|   privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
 | |
|   (see example).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <expr>  Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
 | |
|             by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also "option forwardfor".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
 | |
|     http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # After the masking this will track connections
 | |
|     # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
 | |
|     http-request track-sc0 src
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
 | |
|   address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
 | |
|   expression.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <expr>  Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
 | |
|             by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
 | |
|     http-request set-src-port int(4000)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
 | |
|   the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
 | |
|   IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
 | |
|                                        [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
 | |
|   current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
 | |
|   other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
 | |
|   this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
 | |
|   a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
 | |
|   and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
 | |
|   capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
 | |
|   results.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
 | |
|     http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
 | |
|   to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
 | |
|   represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
 | |
|   decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
 | |
|   bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
 | |
|   be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
 | |
|   information from the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
 | |
|   string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
 | |
|   at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
 | |
|   perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
 | |
|   path and the query string.
 | |
|   See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
 | |
|   inline.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <var-name>  The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
 | |
|                 scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|                   "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|                   "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|                   "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction
 | |
|                            (request and response)
 | |
|                   "req"  : the variable is shared only during request
 | |
|                            processing
 | |
|                   "res"  : the variable is shared only during response
 | |
|                            processing
 | |
|                 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
 | |
|                 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
 | |
|                 and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <expr>      Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|                 followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
 | |
|                              [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
 | |
|   the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
 | |
|   group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
 | |
|   filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
 | |
|   agent name must be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <engine-name>  The SPOE engine name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <group-name>   The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
 | |
|                    configuration.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
 | |
|   suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
 | |
|   client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
 | |
|   established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
 | |
|   achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
 | |
|   resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
 | |
|   loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
 | |
|   understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
 | |
|   between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
 | |
|   keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
 | |
|   action.
 | |
|   On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
 | |
|   option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
 | |
|   socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
 | |
|   router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
 | |
|   you fully understand how it works.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request strict-mode { on | off }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
 | |
|   does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
 | |
|   performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
 | |
|   rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
 | |
|   silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
 | |
|   rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
 | |
|   processing.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
 | |
|   when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
 | |
|   the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
 | |
|   rules evaluation.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
 | |
|           [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
 | |
|               file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
 | |
|           [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
 | |
|           [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
 | |
|   without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
 | |
|   "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
 | |
|   is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
 | |
|   suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
 | |
|   the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
 | |
|   on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
 | |
|   dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
 | |
|   a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
 | |
|   things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
 | |
|   number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
 | |
|   But the response may be customized using same syntax than
 | |
|   "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
 | |
|   For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
 | |
|   the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
 | |
|   "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
 | |
|   "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
 | |
|   No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
 | |
|   See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
 | |
|   not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
 | |
|   that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
 | |
|   MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
 | |
|   so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
 | |
|   "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
 | |
|   table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
 | |
|   of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
 | |
|   "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
 | |
|   table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
 | |
|   counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
 | |
|   ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <key>   is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
 | |
|             section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
 | |
|             connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
 | |
|             select which table entry to update the counters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
 | |
|             is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
 | |
|             for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
 | |
|             that table until the session ends.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
 | |
|   it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
 | |
|   is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
 | |
|   as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
 | |
|   systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
 | |
|   that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
 | |
|   counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
 | |
|   useful information.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
 | |
|   for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
 | |
|   that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
 | |
|   checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
 | |
|   checks that make use of it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
 | |
|   and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
 | |
|   sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
 | |
|   without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
 | |
|   Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
 | |
|   further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <service-name>  is mandatory. It is the service to call
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
 | |
|              [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
 | |
|   most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
 | |
|   to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
 | |
|   limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
 | |
|   HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
 | |
|   buffer is full.  This action may be used as a replacement to "option
 | |
|   http-buffer-request".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <time>    is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
 | |
|               follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <bytes>   is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
 | |
|               wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
 | |
|               bytes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option http-buffer-request"
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
 | |
|   happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
 | |
|   sure they are valid.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
|   Access control for Layer 7 responses
 | |
| 
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                 no    |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
 | |
|   processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
 | |
|   met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
 | |
|   followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
 | |
|   if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
 | |
|   rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
 | |
|   below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
 | |
| 
 | |
|     acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
 | |
|     http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     acl value  res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
 | |
| 
 | |
|     use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
 | |
|     http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src]                     if ! value
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
 | |
|              ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
 | |
|   file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
 | |
|   passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
 | |
|   log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
 | |
|   in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
 | |
|   This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
 | |
|   It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
 | |
|   be triggered by an HTTP response.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
 | |
|   value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
 | |
|   Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
 | |
|   example, or to pass some internal information.
 | |
|   This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
 | |
|   Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
 | |
|   the resulting header from a previous rule.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
 | |
|   No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See section 6.2 about cache setup.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
 | |
|   converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
 | |
|   "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
 | |
|   headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
 | |
|   possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
 | |
|   anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
 | |
|   "capture response header" for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
 | |
|   string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
 | |
|   This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
 | |
|   previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
 | |
|   keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
 | |
|   frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
 | |
|   ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
 | |
|   due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
 | |
|   file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
 | |
|   passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
 | |
|   log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
 | |
|   It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
 | |
|   be triggered by an HTTP response.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
 | |
|   is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
 | |
|   are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
 | |
|   (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
 | |
|   method is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
 | |
|   file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
 | |
|   passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
 | |
|   log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
 | |
|   It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
 | |
|   command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
 | |
|           [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
 | |
|               file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
 | |
|           [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
 | |
|           [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
 | |
|   By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
 | |
|   using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
 | |
|   "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
 | |
|   argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
 | |
|   is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
 | |
|   of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
 | |
|   No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
 | |
|   See also "http-response return".
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
 | |
|   This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
 | |
|   with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
 | |
|   the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
 | |
|   redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
 | |
|   closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
 | |
|                              [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
 | |
|   server's response instead of the client's request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # applied to:
 | |
|     Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # outputs:
 | |
|     Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
 | |
|                             [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
 | |
|   server's response instead of the client's request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # applied to:
 | |
|     Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # outputs:
 | |
|     Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
 | |
|           [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
 | |
|               file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
 | |
| 	  [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
 | |
|           [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
 | |
|   default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
 | |
|   specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
 | |
|   specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
 | |
|   be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
 | |
|   or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
 | |
|   are followed to create the response :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
 | |
|     response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
 | |
|     any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
 | |
|     ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
 | |
|     considered.  If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
 | |
|     status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
 | |
|     425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
 | |
|     any, is ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
 | |
|     corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
 | |
|     "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
 | |
|     by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
 | |
|     502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
 | |
|     corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
 | |
|     HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
 | |
|     must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
 | |
|     408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
 | |
|     argument, if any, is ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
 | |
|     used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
 | |
|     must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
 | |
|     argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
 | |
|     evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
 | |
|     as a raw content.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
 | |
|     used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
 | |
|     argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
 | |
|     evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
 | |
|     considered as a raw string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
 | |
|   header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
 | |
|   arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
 | |
|   and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
 | |
|   any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
 | |
|   reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
 | |
|         if { status eq 404 }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http-response return content-type text/plain  \
 | |
|         string "This is the end !"                \
 | |
|         if { status eq 500 }
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
 | |
|   counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
 | |
|   and the actions evaluation continues.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
 | |
|                                    [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
 | |
|   designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
 | |
|   boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
 | |
|   evaluation continues.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
 | |
|   the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
 | |
|   group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
 | |
|   filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
 | |
|   agent name must be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <engine-name>  The SPOE engine name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <group-name>   The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
 | |
|                    configuration.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
 | |
|   removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
 | |
|   the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
 | |
|   condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
 | |
|   keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
 | |
|   request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
 | |
|   be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
 | |
|   file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
 | |
|   passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
 | |
|   log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
 | |
|   log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
 | |
|   lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
 | |
|   This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
 | |
|   It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
 | |
|   be triggered by an HTTP response.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
 | |
|   the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
 | |
|   unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
 | |
|   table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
 | |
|   by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
 | |
|   route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
 | |
|   Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
 | |
|   It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
 | |
|   time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
 | |
|   "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
 | |
|   nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
 | |
|   than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
 | |
|   lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
 | |
|   prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
 | |
|                          [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
 | |
|   between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
 | |
|   by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
 | |
|   fallback.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
 | |
|     http-response set-status 431
 | |
|     # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
 | |
|     http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
 | |
|   to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
 | |
|   This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
 | |
|   expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
 | |
|   only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
 | |
|   always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
 | |
|   based on some information from the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
 | |
|   inline.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <var-name>  The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
 | |
|                 scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|                   "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|                   "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|                   "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction
 | |
|                            (request and response)
 | |
|                   "req"  : the variable is shared only during request
 | |
|                            processing
 | |
|                   "res"  : the variable is shared only during response
 | |
|                            processing
 | |
|                 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
 | |
|                 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
 | |
|                 and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <expr>      Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|                 followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
 | |
|   suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
 | |
|   client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
 | |
|   established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
 | |
|   achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
 | |
|   resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
 | |
|   loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
 | |
|   understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
 | |
|   between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
 | |
|   keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
 | |
|   action.
 | |
|   On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
 | |
|   option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
 | |
|   socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
 | |
|   router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
 | |
|   you fully understand how it works.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response strict-mode { on | off }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
 | |
|   does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
 | |
|   performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
 | |
|   rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
 | |
|   silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
 | |
|   rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
 | |
|   processing.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
 | |
|   when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
 | |
|   the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
 | |
|   rules evaluation.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
 | |
|   to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
 | |
|   from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
 | |
|   of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
 | |
|   (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
 | |
|   supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
 | |
|   about <var-name>.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
 | |
|              [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
 | |
|   most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
 | |
|   to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
 | |
|   limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
 | |
|   HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
 | |
|   buffer is full.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <time>    is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
 | |
|               follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <bytes>   is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
 | |
|               wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
 | |
|               bytes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
 | |
|   Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
 | |
| 
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
 | |
|   which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
 | |
|   connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
 | |
|   "safe" strategy below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "never"  : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
 | |
|                  may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
 | |
|                  a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
 | |
|                  old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
 | |
|                  the same connection come from the same client and it is not
 | |
|                  possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
 | |
|                  disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
 | |
|                  such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
 | |
|                  insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
 | |
|                  first one.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "safe"   : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
 | |
|                  request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
 | |
|                  and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
 | |
|                  existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
 | |
|                  closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
 | |
|                  browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
 | |
|                  equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
 | |
|                  effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
 | |
|                  using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
 | |
|                  h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
 | |
|                  processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
 | |
|                  of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
 | |
|                  connection is released and can be reused.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
 | |
|                  all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
 | |
|                  appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
 | |
|                  connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
 | |
|                  over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
 | |
|                  proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
 | |
|                  It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
 | |
|                  retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
 | |
|                  of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
 | |
|                  downsides of rare connection failures.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
 | |
|                  known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
 | |
|                  releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
 | |
|                  sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
 | |
|                  performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
 | |
|                  is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
 | |
|                  consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
 | |
|                  sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
 | |
|                  remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
 | |
|                  usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
 | |
|                  gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
 | |
|                  used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
 | |
|   connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
 | |
|   and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
 | |
|   and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
 | |
|   if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
 | |
|   on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
 | |
|   because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
 | |
|   remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-send-name-header [<header>]
 | |
|   Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <header>  The header string to use to send the server name
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
 | |
|   to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
 | |
|   to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
 | |
|   Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
 | |
|   the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
 | |
|   very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
 | |
|   modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
 | |
|   connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
 | |
|   invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
 | |
|   that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
 | |
|   header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
 | |
|   as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
 | |
|   and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
 | |
|   technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
 | |
|   consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
 | |
|   to the correct host name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "server"
 | |
| 
 | |
| id <value>
 | |
|   Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
 | |
|   An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
 | |
|   value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
 | |
|   Declare a condition to ignore persistence
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
 | |
|   the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
 | |
|   and running).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
 | |
|   conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
 | |
|   This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
 | |
|   often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
 | |
|   persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
 | |
|   "unless" condition is met.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|       acl url_static  path_beg         /static /images /img /css
 | |
|       acl url_static  path_end         .gif .png .jpg .css .js
 | |
|       ignore-persist  if url_static
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
 | |
|   Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   yes   |    no   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
 | |
|   running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
 | |
|   traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
 | |
|   reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
 | |
|   to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
 | |
|   loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
 | |
|   The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
 | |
|   over the stats socket and redirect output.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
 | |
|   please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
 | |
|   9.3 of Management Guide).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     global     load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
 | |
|                named "server-state-file".
 | |
| 
 | |
|     local      load the content of the file pointed by the directive
 | |
|                "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
 | |
|                name is used as a file name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     none       don't load any stat for this backend
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Notes:
 | |
|     - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
 | |
|       order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
 | |
|       means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
 | |
|       be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
 | |
|       will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
 | |
|       has changed between previous and new configuration files.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: Minimal configuration
 | |
| 
 | |
|       global
 | |
|        stats socket /tmp/socket
 | |
|        server-state-file /tmp/server_state
 | |
| 
 | |
|       defaults
 | |
|        load-server-state-from-file global
 | |
| 
 | |
|       backend bk
 | |
|        server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
 | |
|        server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Then one can run :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     1
 | |
|     # <field names skipped for the doc example>
 | |
|     1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
 | |
|     1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: Minimal configuration
 | |
| 
 | |
|     global
 | |
|      stats socket /tmp/socket
 | |
|      server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
 | |
| 
 | |
|     defaults
 | |
|      load-server-state-from-file local
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend bk
 | |
|      server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
 | |
|      server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Then one can run :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     1
 | |
|     # <field names skipped for the doc example>
 | |
|     1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
 | |
|     1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
 | |
|   "show servers state"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| log global
 | |
| log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
 | |
|     <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
 | |
| no log
 | |
|   Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Prefix :
 | |
|     no         should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
 | |
|                if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
 | |
|                prefix does not allow arguments.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     global     should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
 | |
|                same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
 | |
|                replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
 | |
|                entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
 | |
|                statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
 | |
|                parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <address>  indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
 | |
|                for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
 | |
| 
 | |
|                - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
 | |
|                  port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
 | |
|                  standard syslog port).
 | |
| 
 | |
|                - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
 | |
|                  port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
 | |
|                  standard syslog port).
 | |
| 
 | |
|                - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
 | |
|                  considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
 | |
|                  inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
 | |
|                  appropriately writable).
 | |
| 
 | |
|                - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
 | |
|                  point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
 | |
|                  logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
 | |
|                  is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
 | |
|                  sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
 | |
|                  which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
 | |
|                  writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
 | |
|                  PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
 | |
|                  which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
 | |
|                  larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
 | |
|                  processes.  Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
 | |
|                  descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
 | |
|                  significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
 | |
|                  ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
 | |
|                  file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
 | |
|                  syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
 | |
|                  with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
 | |
|                  formats below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
 | |
|                  and "fd@2", see above.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
 | |
|                  to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
 | |
|                  "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
 | |
|                  their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
 | |
|                  when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
 | |
|                  having the logs instantly available.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
 | |
|                  "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
 | |
|                  a stream forward server targeting the given address.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                You may want to reference some environment variables in the
 | |
|                address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <length>   is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
 | |
|                value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
 | |
|                syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
 | |
|                support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
 | |
|                larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
 | |
|                lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
 | |
|                truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
 | |
|                it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
 | |
|                values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
 | |
|                generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
 | |
|                long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <ranges>   A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
 | |
|                This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
 | |
|                server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
 | |
|                from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
 | |
|                be set with <sample_size> parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <sample_size>
 | |
|                The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
 | |
|                their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
 | |
|                send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
 | |
|                maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
 | |
|                (see also <ranges> parameter).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
 | |
|              one of the following :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       local     Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
 | |
|                 field is stripped. This is the default.
 | |
|                 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
 | |
|                 rfc3164.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       rfc3164   The RFC3164 syslog message format.
 | |
|                 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
 | |
| 
 | |
|       rfc5424   The RFC5424 syslog message format.
 | |
|                 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
 | |
| 
 | |
|       priority  A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
 | |
|                 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
 | |
|                 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
 | |
|                 designed to be used with a local log server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       short     A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
 | |
|                 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
 | |
|                 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
 | |
|                 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
 | |
|                 systemd logger consumes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       timed     A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
 | |
|                 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
 | |
|                 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
 | |
|                 used with a local log server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       iso       A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
 | |
|                 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
 | |
|                 designed to be used with a local log server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       raw       A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
 | |
|                 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
 | |
|                 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
 | |
|                 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
 | |
| 
 | |
|                    kern   user   mail   daemon auth   syslog lpr    news
 | |
|                    uucp   cron   auth2  ftp    ntp    audit  alert  cron2
 | |
|                    local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
 | |
| 
 | |
|                Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
 | |
|                formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
 | |
|                recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
 | |
|                it's only supposed to be used locally.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <level>    is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
 | |
|                default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
 | |
|                messages with a severity at least as important as this level
 | |
|                will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
 | |
|                is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
 | |
|                be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
 | |
|                messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
 | |
|                Eight levels are known :
 | |
| 
 | |
|                  emerg  alert  crit   err    warning notice info  debug
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
 | |
|   log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
 | |
|   from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
 | |
|   will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
 | |
|   "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
 | |
|   termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
 | |
|          being emitted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     log global
 | |
|     log stdout format short daemon          # send log to systemd
 | |
|     log stdout format raw daemon            # send everything to stdout
 | |
|     log stderr format raw daemon notice     # send important events to stderr
 | |
|     log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice         # only send important events
 | |
|     log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice  # same but limit output
 | |
|                                                 # level and send in tcp
 | |
|     log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice   # send to local server
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| log-format <string>
 | |
|   Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |    no
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
 | |
|   resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
 | |
|   directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
 | |
|   the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
 | |
|   string in depth.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
 | |
|   "option httplog" directives.
 | |
| 
 | |
| log-format-sd <string>
 | |
|   Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |    no
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
 | |
|   will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
 | |
|   using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
 | |
|   subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
 | |
|   which covers the log format string in depth.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
 | |
|   about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
 | |
|          log format to "rfc5424".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| log-tag <string>
 | |
|   Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
 | |
|   log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
 | |
|   from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
 | |
|   to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
 | |
|   differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
 | |
|   logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
 | |
|   to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
 | |
|   all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
 | |
|   in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
| max-keep-alive-queue <value>
 | |
|   Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |     no   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
 | |
|   but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
 | |
|   of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
 | |
|   servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
 | |
|   connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
 | |
|   to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
 | |
|   of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
 | |
|   servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
 | |
|   breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
 | |
|   use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
 | |
|   higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
 | |
|   picking a different server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
 | |
|   server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
 | |
|   even if they have to be queued.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
 | |
|              "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
 | |
| 
 | |
| max-session-srv-conns <nb>
 | |
|   Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
 | |
|   client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
 | |
|   defined at build time).
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxconn <conns>
 | |
|   Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <conns>   is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
 | |
|               accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
 | |
|               in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
 | |
|               closes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
 | |
|   very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
 | |
|   clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
 | |
|   global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
 | |
|   of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
 | |
|   in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
 | |
|   that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
 | |
|   20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
 | |
|   are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
 | |
|   to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
 | |
|   value is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| mode { tcp|http }
 | |
|   Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     tcp       The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
 | |
|               will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
 | |
|               examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
 | |
|               should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
 | |
| 
 | |
|     http      The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
 | |
|               analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
 | |
|               which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
 | |
|               processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
 | |
|               brings HAProxy most of its value.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
 | |
|   backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
 | |
|   will be refused.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|      defaults http_instances
 | |
|          mode http
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
 | |
|   Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     if <cond>     the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
 | |
|                   and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
 | |
|                   combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
 | |
|                   are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
 | |
|                   backend and its backup.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
 | |
|                   satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
 | |
|                   based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
 | |
|                   servers in a list of backends.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
 | |
|   request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
 | |
|   the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
 | |
|   conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
 | |
|   very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
 | |
|   routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
 | |
|   HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
 | |
|   criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
 | |
|   messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|      frontend www
 | |
|         mode http
 | |
|         acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
 | |
|         acl site_dead nbsrv(static)  lt 2
 | |
|         monitor-uri   /site_alive
 | |
|         monitor fail  if site_dead
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| monitor-uri <uri>
 | |
|   Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <uri>     is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
 | |
|               health status instead of forwarding the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
 | |
|   HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
 | |
|   "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
 | |
|   conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
 | |
|   front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
 | |
|   forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
 | |
|   version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
 | |
|   at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
 | |
|   and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
 | |
|   tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
 | |
|   purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
 | |
|   nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
 | |
|   "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
 | |
|   can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
 | |
|         request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
 | |
|         the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
 | |
|         are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
 | |
|     frontend www
 | |
|         mode http
 | |
|         monitor-uri /haproxy_test
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "monitor fail"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option abortonclose
 | |
| no option abortonclose
 | |
|   Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |     no   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
 | |
|   The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
 | |
|   increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
 | |
|   response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
 | |
|   often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
 | |
|   the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
 | |
|   request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
 | |
|   encountered while delivering the response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
 | |
|   close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
 | |
|   that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
 | |
|   the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
 | |
|   do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
 | |
|   all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
 | |
|   support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
 | |
|   hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
 | |
|   to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
 | |
|   of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
 | |
|   low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
 | |
|   still not served and not pollute the servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
 | |
|   "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
 | |
|   compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
 | |
|   specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
 | |
|   it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
 | |
|   during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
 | |
|   the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
 | |
|   on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
 | |
|   reduces the response time for other users.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option accept-invalid-http-request
 | |
| no option accept-invalid-http-request
 | |
|   Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
 | |
|   means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
 | |
|   error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
 | |
|   forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
 | |
|   weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
 | |
|   server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
 | |
|   implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
 | |
|   it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
 | |
|   even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
 | |
|   list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
 | |
|   chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
 | |
|   ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
 | |
|   not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
 | |
|   remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
 | |
|   option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
 | |
|   to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
 | |
|   and the minor version.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
 | |
|   and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
 | |
|   been confirmed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
 | |
|   requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
 | |
|   analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
 | |
|   requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
 | |
|   also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
 | |
|              stats socket.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option accept-invalid-http-response
 | |
| no option accept-invalid-http-response
 | |
|   Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |     no   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
 | |
|   means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
 | |
|   error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
 | |
|   forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
 | |
|   weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
 | |
|   server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
 | |
|   implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
 | |
|   it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
 | |
|   even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
 | |
|   relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
 | |
|   both the major and the minor version.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
 | |
|   and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
 | |
|   been confirmed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
 | |
|   responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
 | |
|   later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
 | |
|   Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
 | |
|              stats socket.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option allbackups
 | |
| no option allbackups
 | |
|   Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |     no   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
 | |
|   servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
 | |
|   at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
 | |
|   the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
 | |
|   ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
 | |
|   servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
 | |
|   order between the backup servers anymore.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
 | |
|   "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option checkcache
 | |
| no option checkcache
 | |
|   Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |     no   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
 | |
|   always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
 | |
|   be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
 | |
|   high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
 | |
|   caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
 | |
|   some sensitive session information go in the wild.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
 | |
|   strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
 | |
|   carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
 | |
|   response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
 | |
|   proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
 | |
|   to the client are :
 | |
|     - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
 | |
|     - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
 | |
|       404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
 | |
|       "Cache-control: public" header field;
 | |
|     - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
 | |
|       OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
 | |
|       public' header field;
 | |
|     - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
 | |
|     - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
 | |
|     - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
 | |
|     - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
 | |
|     - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
 | |
|     - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
 | |
|     - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
 | |
|     - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
 | |
|       (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
 | |
|   just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
 | |
|   gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
 | |
|   response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
 | |
|   the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
 | |
|   in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
 | |
|   good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
 | |
|   production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option clitcpka
 | |
| no option clitcpka
 | |
|   Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
 | |
|   a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
 | |
|   periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
 | |
|   components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
 | |
|   to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
 | |
|   keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
 | |
|   operating system and its tuning parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
 | |
|   received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
 | |
|   them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
 | |
|   to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
 | |
|   forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
 | |
|   client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
 | |
|   noticed between HAProxy and a client.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option contstats
 | |
|   Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
 | |
|   only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
 | |
|   objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
 | |
|   with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
 | |
|   a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
 | |
|   along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
 | |
|   produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
 | |
|   not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
 | |
|   session counts and cause a small performance drop.
 | |
| 
 | |
| option disable-h2-upgrade
 | |
| no option disable-h2-upgrade
 | |
|   Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
 | |
|   connection.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
 | |
|   connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
 | |
|   given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
 | |
|   "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
 | |
|   HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
 | |
|   used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
 | |
|   supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
 | |
|   force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
 | |
|   line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
 | |
|   HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| option dontlog-normal
 | |
| no option dontlog-normal
 | |
|   Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
 | |
|   and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
 | |
|   logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
 | |
|   normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
 | |
|   redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
 | |
|   mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
 | |
|   logged.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
 | |
|   complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
 | |
|   need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
 | |
|              logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option dontlognull
 | |
| no option dontlognull
 | |
|   Enable or disable logging of null connections
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
 | |
|   various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
 | |
|   another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
 | |
|   simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
 | |
|   the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
 | |
|   that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
 | |
|   which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
 | |
|   returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
 | |
|   desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
 | |
|   environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
 | |
|   would not be logged.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
 | |
|              section 8 about logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
 | |
|   Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
 | |
|               matching <network>
 | |
|     <name>    an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
 | |
|               header name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
 | |
|   their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
 | |
|   is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
 | |
|   "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
 | |
|   This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
 | |
|   header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
 | |
|   must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
 | |
|   the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
 | |
|   that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
 | |
|   possible that the client has already brought one.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
 | |
|   the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
 | |
|   have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
 | |
|   and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
 | |
|   "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
 | |
|   require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
 | |
|   access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
 | |
|   used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
 | |
|   header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
 | |
|   followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
 | |
|   network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
 | |
|   private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
 | |
|   added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
 | |
|   environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
 | |
|   are under the control of the end-user.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
 | |
|   least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
 | |
|   setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
 | |
|   both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
 | |
|   the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
 | |
|   mandatory, so it wins.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
 | |
|     frontend www
 | |
|         mode http
 | |
|         option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1  # stunnel already adds the header
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
 | |
|     backend www
 | |
|         mode http
 | |
|         option forwardfor header X-Client
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
 | |
|              "option http-keep-alive"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
 | |
| no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
 | |
|   Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
 | |
|   they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
 | |
|   insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
 | |
|   erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
 | |
|   becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
 | |
|   lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
 | |
|   sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
 | |
|   lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
 | |
|   known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
 | |
|   from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
 | |
|   different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
 | |
|   enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
 | |
|   using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
 | |
|   must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
 | |
|   fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
 | |
|   content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
 | |
|   "h1-case-adjust-file".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
 | |
| no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
 | |
|   Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
 | |
|   they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
 | |
|   insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
 | |
|   erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
 | |
|   becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
 | |
|   lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
 | |
|   sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
 | |
|   lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
 | |
|   known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
 | |
|   from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
 | |
|   different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
 | |
|   enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
 | |
|   using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
 | |
|   must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
 | |
|   fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
 | |
|   content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
 | |
|   "h1-case-adjust-file".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option http-buffer-request
 | |
| no option http-buffer-request
 | |
|   Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
 | |
|   taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
 | |
|   example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
 | |
|   connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
 | |
|   decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
 | |
|   frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
 | |
|   body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
 | |
|   effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
 | |
|   transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
 | |
|   not be used by default.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
 | |
|              "http-request wait-for-body"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option http-ignore-probes
 | |
| no option http-ignore-probes
 | |
|   Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
 | |
|   consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
 | |
|   just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
 | |
|   connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
 | |
|   Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
 | |
|   decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
 | |
|   counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
 | |
|   this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
 | |
|      - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
 | |
|        was received over a connection before it was closed;
 | |
|      - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
 | |
|      - prevent any error counter from being incremented
 | |
| 
 | |
|   That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
 | |
|   not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
 | |
|   real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
 | |
|   a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
 | |
|   element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
 | |
|   generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
 | |
|   are often the only way to detect them.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option http-keep-alive
 | |
| no option http-keep-alive
 | |
|   Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
 | |
|   connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
 | |
|   leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
 | |
|   the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
 | |
|   as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
 | |
|   set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
 | |
|   in a defaults section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
 | |
|   and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
 | |
|   network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
 | |
|   of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
 | |
|   with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
 | |
|   "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
 | |
|   situations where this option may be useful :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
 | |
|       instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
 | |
|       compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
 | |
|   In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
 | |
|   connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
 | |
|   request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
 | |
|   content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
 | |
|   immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
 | |
|   available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
 | |
|   attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
 | |
|   session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
 | |
|   of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
 | |
|   waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
 | |
|   timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
 | |
|   not set.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
 | |
|   http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
 | |
|   options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
 | |
|              "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
 | |
|              and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option http-no-delay
 | |
| no option http-no-delay
 | |
|   Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
 | |
|   Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
 | |
|   There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
 | |
|   protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
 | |
|   interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
 | |
|   absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
 | |
|   most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
 | |
|   HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
 | |
|   optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
 | |
|   enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
 | |
|   delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
 | |
|   abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
 | |
|   affected.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
 | |
|   used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
 | |
|   make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
 | |
|   the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
 | |
|   HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
 | |
|   by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
 | |
|   is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
 | |
|   usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
 | |
|   latency environments.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option http-buffer-request"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option http-pretend-keepalive
 | |
| no option http-pretend-keepalive
 | |
|   Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
 | |
|   adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
 | |
|   Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
 | |
|   from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
 | |
|   is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
 | |
|   maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
 | |
|   a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
 | |
|   consider the response complete.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
 | |
|   believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
 | |
|   to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
 | |
|   will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
 | |
|   "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
 | |
|   connection is correctly closed on the server side.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
 | |
|   will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
 | |
|   and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
 | |
|   network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
 | |
|   worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
 | |
|   less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
 | |
|   enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
 | |
|   section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
 | |
|   a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
 | |
|   frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
 | |
|   cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
 | |
|   the client. This practice is discouraged though.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
 | |
|              "option http-keep-alive"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option http-server-close
 | |
| no option http-server-close
 | |
|   Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
 | |
|   connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
 | |
|   leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
 | |
|   the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
 | |
|   as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
 | |
|   http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
 | |
|   while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
 | |
|   client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
 | |
|   network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
 | |
|   resources, similarly to "option httpclose".  It also permits non-keepalive
 | |
|   capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
 | |
|   conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
 | |
|   always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
 | |
|   request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
 | |
|   consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
 | |
|   session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
 | |
|   of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
 | |
|   waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
 | |
|   timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
 | |
|   not set.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
 | |
|   at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
 | |
|   It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
 | |
|   http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
 | |
|   combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
 | |
|              "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
 | |
| 
 | |
| option http-use-proxy-header
 | |
| no option http-use-proxy-header
 | |
|   Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
 | |
|   Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
 | |
|   connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
 | |
|   connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
 | |
|   header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
 | |
|   browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
 | |
|   HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
 | |
|   that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
 | |
|   defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
 | |
|   is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
 | |
|   specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
 | |
|   automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
 | |
|   proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
 | |
|   front of an existing proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
 | |
| 
 | |
| option httpchk
 | |
| option httpchk <uri>
 | |
| option httpchk <method> <uri>
 | |
| option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
 | |
|   Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <method>  is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
 | |
|               the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
 | |
|               processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
 | |
|               may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
 | |
|               ones.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <uri>     is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
 | |
|               which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
 | |
|               changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
 | |
|               but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
 | |
|               it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
 | |
|               mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
 | |
|   connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
 | |
|   sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
 | |
|   considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
 | |
|   the lack of any response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
 | |
|   request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
 | |
|   response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
 | |
|   with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
 | |
|   HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
 | |
|   using "http-check connect" rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
 | |
|   with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
 | |
|   bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
 | |
|   internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
 | |
|   formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
 | |
|          used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
 | |
|          of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
 | |
| 	 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|         # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
 | |
|         # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
 | |
|         backend https_relay
 | |
|             mode tcp
 | |
|             option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
 | |
|             http-check send hdr Host www
 | |
|             server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
 | |
|              "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
 | |
|              "inter" server options.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option httpclose
 | |
| no option httpclose
 | |
|   Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
 | |
|   connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
 | |
|   leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
 | |
|   the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
 | |
|   as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
 | |
|   and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
 | |
|   also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
 | |
|   and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
 | |
|   will also be removed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
 | |
|   will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
 | |
|   the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
 | |
|   at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
 | |
|   It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
 | |
|   http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
 | |
|   combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option httplog [ clf ]
 | |
|   Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     clf       if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
 | |
|               the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
 | |
|               use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
 | |
|               log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
 | |
|               extensible.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
 | |
|   source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
 | |
|   "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
 | |
|   but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
 | |
|   status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
 | |
|   frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
 | |
|   ports.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
 | |
|   if it was set by default.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also :  section 8 about logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option http_proxy
 | |
| no option http_proxy
 | |
|   Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
 | |
|   basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
 | |
|   it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
 | |
|   set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
 | |
|   the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
 | |
|   addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
 | |
|   it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
 | |
|   is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
 | |
|     backend direct_forward
 | |
|         option httpclose
 | |
|         option http_proxy
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpclose"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option independent-streams
 | |
| no option independent-streams
 | |
|   Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |  yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
 | |
|   read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
 | |
|   activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
 | |
|   receive data or not.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
 | |
|   exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
 | |
|   read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
 | |
|   timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
 | |
|   server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
 | |
|   socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
 | |
|   to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
 | |
|   the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
 | |
|   to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
 | |
|   happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
 | |
|   socket buffers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
 | |
|   on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
 | |
|   the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
 | |
|   data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
 | |
|   slow lines, so use it with caution.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option ldap-check
 | |
|   Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
 | |
|   testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
 | |
|   LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
 | |
|   is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
 | |
|   resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
 | |
|   configure it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         option ldap-check
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpchk"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option external-check
 | |
|   Use external processes for server health checks
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
 | |
|   This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
 | |
|   command".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option log-health-checks
 | |
| no option log-health-checks
 | |
|   Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |  yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
 | |
|   health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
 | |
|   information is limited.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
 | |
|   the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
 | |
|   that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
 | |
|   it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
 | |
|   reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
 | |
|   the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
 | |
|             "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
 | |
|             "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option log-separate-errors
 | |
| no option log-separate-errors
 | |
|   Change log level for non-completely successful connections
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
 | |
|   raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
 | |
|   as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
 | |
|   level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
 | |
|   separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
 | |
|   remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
 | |
|   provides very important information.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
 | |
|   second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
 | |
|   error logs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
 | |
|              logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option logasap
 | |
| no option logasap
 | |
|   Enable or disable early logging.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
 | |
|   fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
 | |
|   when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
 | |
|   to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
 | |
|   it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
 | |
|   Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
 | |
|   connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
 | |
|   complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
 | |
|   total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
 | |
|   before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
 | |
|   remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
 | |
|   of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
 | |
|   so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
 | |
|   transferred.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|       listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
 | |
|           mode http
 | |
|           option httplog
 | |
|           option logasap
 | |
|           log 192.168.2.200 local3
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> Feb  6 12:14:14 localhost \
 | |
|           haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
 | |
|           static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
 | |
|           "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
 | |
|              logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
 | |
|   Use MySQL health checks for server testing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
 | |
|                server.
 | |
|     post-41    Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
 | |
|     pre-41     Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
 | |
|   one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
 | |
|   MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
 | |
|   Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
 | |
|   aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
 | |
|   in the MySQL table, like this :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       USE mysql;
 | |
|       INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
 | |
|       FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
 | |
|   check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
 | |
|   Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
 | |
|   can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
 | |
|   traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
 | |
|   value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
 | |
|   "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
 | |
|   the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
 | |
|   blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
 | |
|   To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
 | |
|   various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
 | |
|   When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
 | |
|   connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
 | |
|   which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
 | |
|   server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "option httpchk"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option nolinger
 | |
| no option nolinger
 | |
|   Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
 | |
|   physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
 | |
|   closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
 | |
|   using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
 | |
|   connections.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
 | |
|   the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
 | |
|   a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
 | |
|   instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
 | |
|   a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
 | |
|   block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
 | |
|   it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
 | |
|   aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
 | |
|   the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
 | |
|   network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
 | |
|   the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
 | |
|   purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
 | |
|   retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
 | |
|   it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
 | |
|   packets.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
 | |
|   unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
 | |
|   "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
 | |
|   reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
 | |
|   server setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
 | |
|   where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
 | |
|   for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
 | |
|   sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
 | |
|   propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
 | |
|             keywords.
 | |
| 
 | |
| option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
 | |
|   Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
 | |
|               matching <network>
 | |
|     <name>    an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
 | |
|               header name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
 | |
|   be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
 | |
|   complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
 | |
|   be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
 | |
|   addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
 | |
|   added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
 | |
|   value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
 | |
|   configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
 | |
|   only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
 | |
|   possible that the client has already brought one.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
 | |
|   the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
 | |
|   have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
 | |
|   preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
 | |
|   header and requires different one.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
 | |
|   access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
 | |
|   used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
 | |
|   header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
 | |
|   keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
 | |
|   matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
 | |
|   uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
 | |
|   supported.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
 | |
|   least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
 | |
|   setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
 | |
|   both are defined.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|     # Original Destination address
 | |
|     frontend www
 | |
|         mode http
 | |
|         option originalto except 127.0.0.1
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
 | |
|     backend www
 | |
|         mode http
 | |
|         option originalto header X-Client-Dst
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option persist
 | |
| no option persist
 | |
|   Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
 | |
|   server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
 | |
|   force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
 | |
|   if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
 | |
|   load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
 | |
|   directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
 | |
|   correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
 | |
|   with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
 | |
|   the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
 | |
|   redirected to another valid server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
 | |
|   Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
 | |
|                PostgreSQL server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
 | |
|   Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
 | |
|   test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
 | |
|   This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "option httpchk"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option prefer-last-server
 | |
| no option prefer-last-server
 | |
|   Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
 | |
|   request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
 | |
|   sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
 | |
|   server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
 | |
|   we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
 | |
|   of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
 | |
|   this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
 | |
|   attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
 | |
|   close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
 | |
|   not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
 | |
|   HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
 | |
|   to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
 | |
|   balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
 | |
|   broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
 | |
|   troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
 | |
|   desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
 | |
|   after every other response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "option http-keep-alive"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option redispatch
 | |
| option redispatch <interval>
 | |
| no option redispatch
 | |
|   Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
 | |
|                occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
 | |
|                redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
 | |
|                N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
 | |
|                last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
 | |
|                historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
 | |
|                positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
 | |
|                and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
 | |
|                third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
 | |
|   definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
 | |
|   be able to access the service anymore.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
 | |
|   consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
 | |
|   servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
 | |
|   health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
 | |
|   following order:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
 | |
| 
 | |
|     2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
 | |
|        list, or
 | |
| 
 | |
|     3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
 | |
|   one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
 | |
|   occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
 | |
|   remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
 | |
|   connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
 | |
|   connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
 | |
|   value.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "retries", "force-persist"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option redis-check
 | |
|   Use redis health checks for server testing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
 | |
|   of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
 | |
|   a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
 | |
|   find the "+PONG" response message.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         option redis-check
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option smtpchk
 | |
| option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
 | |
|   Use SMTP health checks for server testing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <hello>   is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
 | |
|               be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
 | |
|               values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <domain>  is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
 | |
|               specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
 | |
|               specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
 | |
|   connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
 | |
|   "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
 | |
|   starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
 | |
|   including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
 | |
|   dead server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
 | |
|   request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
 | |
|   so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
 | |
|   25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
 | |
|   various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
 | |
|   possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
 | |
|   connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
 | |
|   which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpchk", "source"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option socket-stats
 | |
| no option socket-stats
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option splice-auto
 | |
| no option splice-auto
 | |
|   Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
 | |
|   will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
 | |
|   forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
 | |
|   uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
 | |
|   not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
 | |
|   are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
 | |
|   option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
 | |
|   disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
 | |
|   requires that there are enough spare pipes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
 | |
|   first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
 | |
|   transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
 | |
|   providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
 | |
|   early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
 | |
|   feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
 | |
|   While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
 | |
|   2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
 | |
|   case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
 | |
|   keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         option splice-auto
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
 | |
|              options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option splice-request
 | |
| no option splice-request
 | |
|   Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
 | |
|   will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
 | |
|   the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
 | |
|   are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
 | |
|   compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
 | |
|   Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         option splice-request
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
 | |
|              "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option splice-response
 | |
| no option splice-response
 | |
|   Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
 | |
|   will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
 | |
|   the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
 | |
|   are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
 | |
|   compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
 | |
|   Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         option splice-response
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
 | |
|              "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option spop-check
 | |
|   Use SPOP health checks for server testing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    no    |   no   |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
 | |
|   of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
 | |
|   a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
 | |
|   response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         option spop-check
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option httpchk"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option srvtcpka
 | |
| no option srvtcpka
 | |
|   Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
 | |
|   a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
 | |
|   periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
 | |
|   components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
 | |
|   to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
 | |
|   keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
 | |
|   operating system and its tuning parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
 | |
|   received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
 | |
|   them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
 | |
|   to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
 | |
|   forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
 | |
|   server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
 | |
|   noticed between HAProxy and a server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option ssl-hello-chk
 | |
|   Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
 | |
|   possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
 | |
|   that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
 | |
|   SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
 | |
|   the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
 | |
|   The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
 | |
|   hello message.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
 | |
|   and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
 | |
|   messages, which is appreciable.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
 | |
|   because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
 | |
|   to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option tcp-check
 | |
|   Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
 | |
|   lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
 | |
|     - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
 | |
|       attempt, which remains the default mode.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
 | |
|       used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
 | |
|       protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
 | |
|       the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
 | |
|       check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
 | |
|       only.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
 | |
|       The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
 | |
|       contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
 | |
|       on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
 | |
|       POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
 | |
|       used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
 | |
|       responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
 | |
|       the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
 | |
|       suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
 | |
|       LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
 | |
|       already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
 | |
|       the respective protocols.
 | |
|       In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
 | |
|       analyzed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
 | |
|   followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
 | |
|   debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.  The
 | |
|   "comment" is of course optional.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
 | |
|   store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
 | |
|   variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|          # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
 | |
| 
 | |
|          # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
 | |
| 
 | |
|          # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
 | |
|          # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
 | |
|          # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check comment PING\ phase
 | |
|          tcp-check send PING\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string +PONG
 | |
|          tcp-check comment role\ check
 | |
|          tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string role:master
 | |
|          tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
 | |
|          tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string +OK
 | |
| 
 | |
|          forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
 | |
|          (send many headers before analyzing)
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
 | |
|          tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check send \r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option tcp-smart-accept
 | |
| no option tcp-smart-accept
 | |
|   Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |    no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
 | |
|   behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
 | |
|   system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
 | |
|   connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
 | |
|   have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
 | |
|   very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
 | |
|   sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
 | |
|   Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
 | |
|   after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
 | |
|   this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
 | |
|   when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
 | |
|   fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
 | |
|   "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
 | |
|   such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
 | |
|   of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
 | |
|   "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option tcp-smart-connect
 | |
| no option tcp-smart-connect
 | |
|   Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
 | |
|   immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
 | |
|   send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
 | |
|   thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
 | |
|   immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
 | |
|   It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
 | |
|   complex.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
 | |
|   such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
 | |
|   the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
 | |
|   in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option tcpka
 | |
|   Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
 | |
|   a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
 | |
|   periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
 | |
|   components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
 | |
|   to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
 | |
|   keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
 | |
|   operating system and its tuning parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
 | |
|   received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
 | |
|   them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
 | |
|   to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
 | |
|   forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
 | |
|   the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
 | |
|   only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
 | |
|   frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
 | |
|   used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
 | |
|   reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
 | |
|   "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
 | |
|   backends.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option tcplog
 | |
|   Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
 | |
|   source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
 | |
|   "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
 | |
|   not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
 | |
|   numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
 | |
|   address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
 | |
|   find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
 | |
|   proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also :  "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| option transparent
 | |
| no option transparent
 | |
|   Enable client-side transparent proxying
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
 | |
|   load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
 | |
|   connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
 | |
|   this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
 | |
|   used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
 | |
|   IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
 | |
|   equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
 | |
|   appropriate server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
 | |
|   present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
 | |
|             "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| external-check command <command>
 | |
|   Executable to run when performing an external-check
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <command> is the external command to run
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The arguments passed to the to the command are:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
 | |
|   that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
 | |
|   listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
 | |
|   <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
 | |
|   possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
 | |
|   will have the string value "NOT_USED".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Some values are also provided through environment variables.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Environment variables :
 | |
|     HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR      The first bind address if available (or empty if not
 | |
|                             applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     HAPROXY_PROXY_ID        The backend id.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME      The backend name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT      The first bind port if available (or empty if not
 | |
|                             applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
 | |
|                             for a UNIX socket).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR     The server address.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN  The current number of connections on the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     HAPROXY_SERVER_ID       The server id.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN  The server max connections.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME     The server name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT     The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
 | |
|                             socket).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     PATH                    The PATH environment variable used when executing
 | |
|                             the command may be set using "external-check path".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
 | |
|   considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
 | |
|   failed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         external-check command /bin/true
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| external-check path <path>
 | |
|   The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The default path is "".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
 | |
|              "external-check command"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| persist rdp-cookie
 | |
| persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
 | |
|   Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>    is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
 | |
|               default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
 | |
|               valid reason to change this name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
 | |
|   contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
 | |
|   servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
 | |
|   and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
 | |
|   which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
 | |
|   forwarded to this server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
 | |
|   frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
 | |
|   in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
 | |
|   load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
 | |
|   a single "listen" section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
 | |
|   RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
 | |
|   that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         listen tse-farm
 | |
|             bind :3389
 | |
|             # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
 | |
|             tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
 | |
|             tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
 | |
|             # apply RDP cookie persistence
 | |
|             persist rdp-cookie
 | |
|             # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
 | |
|             # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
 | |
|             balance rdp-cookie
 | |
|             server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
 | |
|             server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
 | |
|   the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| rate-limit sessions <rate>
 | |
|   Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <rate>    The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
 | |
|               of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
 | |
|   stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
 | |
|   During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
 | |
|   (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
 | |
|   pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
 | |
|   sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
 | |
|   or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
 | |
|   millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
 | |
|   no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
 | |
|         listen smtp
 | |
|             mode tcp
 | |
|             bind :25
 | |
|             rate-limit sessions 10
 | |
|             server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
 | |
|          but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
 | |
|          "socket-stats" option is enabled.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
| redirect prefix   <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
| redirect scheme   <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
|   Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
 | |
|   response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <loc>     With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
 | |
|               the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
 | |
|               <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
 | |
|               dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <pfx>     With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
 | |
|               concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
 | |
|               query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
 | |
|               below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
 | |
|               nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
 | |
|               redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
 | |
|               used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
 | |
|               rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
 | |
|               in section 8.2.4).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <sch>     With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
 | |
|               concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
 | |
|               "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
 | |
|               unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
 | |
|               path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
 | |
|               no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
 | |
|               returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
 | |
|               the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
 | |
|               HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
 | |
|               the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
 | |
|               Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <code>    The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
 | |
|               is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
 | |
|               with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
 | |
|               "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
 | |
|               means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
 | |
|               cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
 | |
|               browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
 | |
|               like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
 | |
|               Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <option>  There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
 | |
|               expected behavior of a redirection :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       - "drop-query"
 | |
|         When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
 | |
|         location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
 | |
|         for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
 | |
|         with a location-type redirect.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       - "append-slash"
 | |
|         This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
 | |
|         users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
 | |
|         It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
 | |
|         For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
 | |
|         A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
 | |
|         to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
 | |
|         been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
 | |
|         cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
 | |
|         that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
 | |
|         different from a cookie with an equal sign.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
 | |
|         A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
 | |
|         with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
 | |
|         delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
 | |
|         important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
 | |
|         cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
 | |
|         that, because the browser makes the difference.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
 | |
|         acl clear      dst_port  80
 | |
|         acl secure     dst_port  8080
 | |
|         acl login_page url_beg   /login
 | |
|         acl logout     url_beg   /logout
 | |
|         acl uid_given  url_reg   /login?userid=[^&]+
 | |
|         acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
 | |
| 
 | |
|         redirect prefix   https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
 | |
|         redirect prefix   https://mysite.com           if login_page !secure
 | |
|         redirect prefix   http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
 | |
|         redirect location http://mysite.com/           if !login_page secure
 | |
|         redirect location / clear-cookie USERID=       if logout
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
 | |
|         acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
 | |
|         redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
 | |
|         redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
 | |
|         http-request redirect code 301 location      \
 | |
|           http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri]  \
 | |
|           unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See section 7 about ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| retries <value>
 | |
|   Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <value>   is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
 | |
|               a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
 | |
|               default value is 3.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
 | |
|   connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
 | |
|   been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
 | |
|   a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
 | |
|   a retry occurs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
 | |
|   server even if a cookie references a different server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option redispatch"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| retry-on [list of keywords]
 | |
|   Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
 | |
|   This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
 | |
|   otherwise.
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <keywords>  is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
 | |
|                 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
 | |
|                 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
 | |
|                 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       none              never retry
 | |
| 
 | |
|       conn-failure      retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
 | |
|                         and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       empty-response    retry when the server connection was closed after part
 | |
|                         of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
 | |
|                         the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
 | |
|                         request timeout on the server side, poor network
 | |
|                         condition, or a server crash or restart while
 | |
|                         processing the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       junk-response     retry when the server returned something not looking
 | |
|                         like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
 | |
|                         responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
 | |
|                         usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
 | |
|                         may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
 | |
|                         or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
 | |
|                         overflow attack for example).
 | |
| 
 | |
|       response-timeout  the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
 | |
|                         to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
 | |
|                         network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
 | |
|                         which has expired on the path, or by the request being
 | |
|                         extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
 | |
|                         idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
 | |
|                         heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
 | |
|                         amplify denial of service attacks.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       0rtt-rejected     retry requests which were sent over early data and were
 | |
|                         rejected by the server. These requests are generally
 | |
|                         considered to be safe to retry.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       <status>          any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
 | |
|                         (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
 | |
|                         "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
 | |
|                         Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
 | |
|                         Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
 | |
| 
 | |
|       all-retryable-errors
 | |
|                         retry request for any error that are considered
 | |
| 			retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
 | |
| 			"empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
 | |
| 			"0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
 | |
|   not cumulative.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
 | |
|   to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
 | |
|   performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
 | |
|   retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
 | |
|   in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
 | |
|   same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
 | |
|   value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
 | |
|   generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
 | |
|   be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
 | |
|   memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
 | |
|   immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
 | |
|   redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
 | |
|   of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
 | |
|   server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
 | |
|   or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
 | |
|   should not use this directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The default is "conn-failure".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
 | |
| 
 | |
| server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
 | |
|   Declare a server in a backend
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>    is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
 | |
|               appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
 | |
|               set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
 | |
|               resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
 | |
|               during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
 | |
|               It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
 | |
|               address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
 | |
|               transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
 | |
|               intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
 | |
|               address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
 | |
|               except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
 | |
|               to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
 | |
|               used before the address to force the family regardless of the
 | |
|               address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
 | |
|               socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
 | |
|                     - 'ipv4@'  -> address is always IPv4
 | |
|                     - 'ipv6@'  -> address is always IPv6
 | |
|                     - 'unix@'  -> address is a path to a local unix socket
 | |
|                     - 'abns@'  -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
 | |
|                     - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
 | |
|                       socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
 | |
|                       backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
 | |
|                       one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
 | |
|                       received socket as the client FD. Should be used
 | |
|                       carefully.
 | |
|               You may want to reference some environment variables in the
 | |
|               address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
 | |
|               variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
 | |
|               IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <port>    is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
 | |
|               be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
 | |
|               connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
 | |
|               or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
 | |
|               adding this value to the client's port.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <param*>  is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
 | |
|               accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
 | |
|               dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|         server first  10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first  check inter 1000
 | |
|         server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
 | |
|         server transp ipv4@
 | |
|         server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
 | |
|         server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
 | |
|         server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
 | |
|         sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
 | |
|         such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
 | |
|         ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
 | |
|         make it compatible with HAProxy's.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
 | |
|              server options
 | |
| 
 | |
| server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
 | |
|   Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
 | |
|   this backend.
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    no   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
 | |
|   "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
 | |
|   this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
 | |
|   slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
 | |
|   concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
 | |
|            state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
 | |
| 
 | |
|     global
 | |
|       server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend bk
 | |
|       load-server-state-from-file
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
 | |
|   "show servers state"
 | |
| 
 | |
| server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
 | |
|   Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
 | |
|   The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <prefix>  A prefix for the server names to be built.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <num | range>
 | |
|               If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
 | |
|               with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
 | |
|               <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
 | |
|               <num_high> as server name suffixes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <fqdn>    A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <port>    Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <params*>
 | |
|               Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
 | |
|               keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples:
 | |
|     # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
 | |
|     # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
 | |
|     server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # or
 | |
|     server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # would be equivalent to:
 | |
|     server srv1 google.com:80 check
 | |
|     server srv2 google.com:80 check
 | |
|     server srv3 google.com:80 check
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
 | |
| source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
 | |
| source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
 | |
|   Set the source address for outgoing connections
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <addr>    is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
 | |
|               server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
 | |
| 
 | |
|               The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
 | |
|               the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
 | |
|               an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
 | |
|               the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
 | |
|               to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
 | |
|               supported prefixes are :
 | |
|                 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
 | |
|                 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
 | |
|                 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
 | |
|                 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
 | |
|               You may want to reference some environment variables in the
 | |
|               address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <port>    is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
 | |
|               in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
 | |
|               the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
 | |
|               supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
 | |
|               have to specify them on each "server" line.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <addr2>   is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
 | |
|               forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
 | |
|               supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
 | |
|               specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
 | |
|               with this address, while health checks will still use the address
 | |
|               <addr>.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <port2>   is the optional port to present to the server when connections
 | |
|               are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
 | |
|               The default value of zero means the system will select a free
 | |
|               port.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <hdr>     is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
 | |
|               This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
 | |
|               contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
 | |
|               used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
 | |
|               and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
 | |
|               by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
 | |
|               occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
 | |
|               below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
 | |
|               is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
 | |
|               keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
 | |
|               HTTP header.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <occ>     is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
 | |
|               header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
 | |
|               in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
 | |
|               address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
 | |
|               occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
 | |
|               positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
 | |
|               is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
 | |
|               at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
 | |
|               proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
 | |
|               assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <name>    is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
 | |
|               traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
 | |
|               Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
 | |
|               this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
 | |
|               based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
 | |
|               Note that using this option requires root privileges.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
 | |
|   address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
 | |
|   private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
 | |
|   known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
 | |
|   through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
 | |
|   servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
 | |
|   is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
 | |
|   servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
 | |
|   running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
 | |
|   address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
 | |
|   common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
 | |
|   there are two methods :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
 | |
|       mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
 | |
|       the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
 | |
|       states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
 | |
|       limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
 | |
|       of the client ranges may be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
 | |
|       solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
 | |
|       firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
 | |
|       of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
 | |
|       However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
 | |
|       connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
 | |
|       same session.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
 | |
|   also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
 | |
|   is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
 | |
|   section 5 for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|         backend private
 | |
|             # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
 | |
|             source 192.168.1.200
 | |
| 
 | |
|         backend transparent_ssl1
 | |
|             # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
 | |
|             source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
 | |
| 
 | |
|         backend transparent_ssl2
 | |
|             # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
 | |
|             # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
 | |
|             source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
 | |
| 
 | |
|         backend transparent_ssl3
 | |
|             # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
 | |
|             # is more conntrack-friendly.
 | |
|             source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
 | |
| 
 | |
|         backend transparent_smtp
 | |
|             # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
 | |
|             # with Tproxy version 4.
 | |
|             source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
 | |
| 
 | |
|         backend transparent_http
 | |
|             # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
 | |
|             # proxy.
 | |
|             source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
 | |
|              the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| srvtcpka-cnt <count>
 | |
|   Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
 | |
|   the connection on the server side.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <count>   is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
 | |
|   is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
 | |
|   The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
 | |
|   known to work on Linux.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
 | |
|   Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
 | |
|   keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
 | |
|   server side.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
 | |
|               sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
 | |
|               but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
 | |
|               unit, as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
 | |
|   is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
 | |
|   The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
 | |
|   known to work on Linux.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
 | |
|   Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
 | |
|               in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
 | |
|               is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
 | |
|               document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
 | |
|   is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
 | |
|   The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
 | |
|   known to work on Linux.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
 | |
|   Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
 | |
|   matched.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
 | |
|   default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
 | |
|          unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
 | |
|          processes, which can result in random behaviors.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
 | |
|   buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
 | |
|   request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
 | |
|   time.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # statistics admin level only for localhost
 | |
|     backend stats_localhost
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats admin if LOCALHOST
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
 | |
|     backend stats_auth
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats auth  admin:AdMiN123
 | |
|         stats admin if TRUE
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
 | |
|     userlist stats-auth
 | |
|         group admin    users admin
 | |
|         user  admin    insecure-password AdMiN123
 | |
|         group readonly users haproxy
 | |
|         user  haproxy  insecure-password haproxy
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend stats_auth
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         acl AUTH       http_auth(stats-auth)
 | |
|         acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
 | |
|         stats http-request auth unless AUTH
 | |
|         stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
 | |
|              "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
 | |
|              ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats auth <user>:<passwd>
 | |
|   Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <user>    is a user name to grant access to
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <passwd>  is the cleartext password associated to this user
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
 | |
|   to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
 | |
|   allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
 | |
|   without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
 | |
|   the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
 | |
|   which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
 | |
|   circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
 | |
|   configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
 | |
|   that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
 | |
|   report using "stats scope".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # public access (limited to this backend only)
 | |
|     backend public_www
 | |
|         server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats hide-version
 | |
|         stats scope   .
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats realm   HAProxy\ Statistics
 | |
|         stats auth    admin1:AdMiN123
 | |
|         stats auth    admin2:AdMiN321
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
 | |
|     backend private_monitoring
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats refresh 5s
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats enable
 | |
|   Enable statistics reporting with default settings
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
 | |
|   at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
 | |
|     - stats uri   : /haproxy?stats
 | |
|     - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
 | |
|     - stats auth  : no authentication
 | |
|     - stats scope : no restriction
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # public access (limited to this backend only)
 | |
|     backend public_www
 | |
|         server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats hide-version
 | |
|         stats scope   .
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats realm   HAProxy\ Statistics
 | |
|         stats auth    admin1:AdMiN123
 | |
|         stats auth    admin2:AdMiN321
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
 | |
|     backend private_monitoring
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats refresh 5s
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats hide-version
 | |
|   Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
 | |
|   the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
 | |
|   considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
 | |
|   target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
 | |
|   statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
 | |
|   for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # public access (limited to this backend only)
 | |
|     backend public_www
 | |
|         server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats hide-version
 | |
|         stats scope   .
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats realm   HAProxy\ Statistics
 | |
|         stats auth    admin1:AdMiN123
 | |
|         stats auth    admin2:AdMiN321
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
 | |
|     backend private_monitoring
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats refresh 5s
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
 | |
|              [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
|   Access control for statistics
 | |
| 
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                 no    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
 | |
|   statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
 | |
|   First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
 | |
|   For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
 | |
|   performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
 | |
|   should be asked to enter a username and password.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
 | |
|   instance.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
 | |
|              about ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats realm <realm>
 | |
|   Enable statistics and set authentication realm
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <realm>   is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
 | |
|               the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
 | |
|               inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
 | |
|   using a backslash ('\').
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
 | |
|   only related to authentication.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # public access (limited to this backend only)
 | |
|     backend public_www
 | |
|         server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats hide-version
 | |
|         stats scope   .
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats realm   HAProxy\ Statistics
 | |
|         stats auth    admin1:AdMiN123
 | |
|         stats auth    admin2:AdMiN321
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
 | |
|     backend private_monitoring
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats refresh 5s
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats refresh <delay>
 | |
|   Enable statistics with automatic refresh
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <delay>   is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
 | |
|               be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
 | |
|               browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
 | |
|               and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
 | |
|               be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
 | |
|               unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
 | |
|   reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
 | |
|   include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
 | |
|   they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # public access (limited to this backend only)
 | |
|     backend public_www
 | |
|         server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats hide-version
 | |
|         stats scope   .
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats realm   HAProxy\ Statistics
 | |
|         stats auth    admin1:AdMiN123
 | |
|         stats auth    admin2:AdMiN321
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
 | |
|     backend private_monitoring
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats refresh 5s
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats scope { <name> | "." }
 | |
|   Enable statistics and limit access scope
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>    is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
 | |
|               reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
 | |
|               section in which the statement appears.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
 | |
|   statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
 | |
|   statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
 | |
|   reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
 | |
|   comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
 | |
|   exists.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # public access (limited to this backend only)
 | |
|     backend public_www
 | |
|         server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats hide-version
 | |
|         stats scope   .
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats realm   HAProxy\ Statistics
 | |
|         stats auth    admin1:AdMiN123
 | |
|         stats auth    admin2:AdMiN321
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
 | |
|     backend private_monitoring
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats refresh 5s
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
 | |
|   Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <desc>    is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
 | |
|               description from global section is automatically used instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
 | |
|   customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
 | |
|     backend private_monitoring
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
 | |
|         stats uri       /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats refresh   5s
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
 | |
|             global section.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats show-legends
 | |
|   Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
 | |
|     - cap: capabilities (proxy)
 | |
|     - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
 | |
|     - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
 | |
|     - IP (socket, server)
 | |
|     - cookie (backend, server)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats show-modules
 | |
|   Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
 | |
|   values as a tooltip.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats show-node [ <name> ]
 | |
|   Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <name>    is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
 | |
|               node name from global section is automatically used instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
 | |
|   customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
 | |
|   provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
 | |
|     backend private_monitoring
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats show-node Europe-1
 | |
|         stats uri       /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats refresh   5s
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
 | |
|             section.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stats uri <prefix>
 | |
|   Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <prefix>  is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
 | |
|               prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
 | |
|               query string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
 | |
|   page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
 | |
|   selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
 | |
|   possible to reach it in the application.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
 | |
|   changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
 | |
|   It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
 | |
|   intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
 | |
|   beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
 | |
|   mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
 | |
|   statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
 | |
|   an address or a port to statistics only.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
 | |
|   recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
 | |
|   unobvious parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # public access (limited to this backend only)
 | |
|     backend public_www
 | |
|         server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats hide-version
 | |
|         stats scope   .
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats realm   HAProxy\ Statistics
 | |
|         stats auth    admin1:AdMiN123
 | |
|         stats auth    admin2:AdMiN321
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
 | |
|     backend private_monitoring
 | |
|         stats enable
 | |
|         stats uri     /admin?stats
 | |
|         stats refresh 5s
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
 | |
|   Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <pattern>  is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
 | |
|                describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
 | |
|                will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
 | |
|                stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <table>    is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
 | |
|                backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
 | |
|                the "stick-table" statement.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <cond>     is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
 | |
|                on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
 | |
|                not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
 | |
|                address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
 | |
|                which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
 | |
|   always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
 | |
|   describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
 | |
|   or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
 | |
|   transformation rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
 | |
|   a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
 | |
|   in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
 | |
|   referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
 | |
|   the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
 | |
|   start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
 | |
|   doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
 | |
|   will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
 | |
|   ACL based conditions.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
 | |
|   applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
 | |
|   as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
 | |
|   matches can be used as fallbacks.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
 | |
|   affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
 | |
|   way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
 | |
|   order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
 | |
|          unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
 | |
|          processes, which can result in random behaviors.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
 | |
|     # last 30 minutes
 | |
|     backend pop
 | |
|         mode tcp
 | |
|         balance roundrobin
 | |
|         stick store-request src
 | |
|         stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
 | |
|         server s1 192.168.1.1:110
 | |
|         server s2 192.168.1.1:110
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend smtp
 | |
|         mode tcp
 | |
|         balance roundrobin
 | |
|         stick match src table pop
 | |
|         server s1 192.168.1.1:25
 | |
|         server s2 192.168.1.1:25
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
 | |
|              about ACLs and samples fetching.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
|   Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
 | |
|          "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
 | |
|          to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
 | |
|          for writing more maintainable configurations.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
 | |
|          unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
 | |
|          processes, which can result in random behaviors.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|     # The following form ...
 | |
|     stick on src table pop if !localhost
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
 | |
|     stick match src table pop if !localhost
 | |
|     stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
 | |
|     # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
 | |
|     backend http
 | |
|         mode http
 | |
|         balance roundrobin
 | |
|         stick on src table https
 | |
|         cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
 | |
|         server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
 | |
|         server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend https
 | |
|         mode tcp
 | |
|         balance roundrobin
 | |
|         stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
 | |
|         stick on src
 | |
|         server s1 192.168.1.1:443
 | |
|         server s2 192.168.1.1:443
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
|   Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <pattern>  is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
 | |
|                describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
 | |
|                will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
 | |
|                server is selected.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <table>    is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
 | |
|                backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
 | |
|                the "stick-table" statement.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <cond>     is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
 | |
|                certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
 | |
|                For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
 | |
|                except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
 | |
|                case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
 | |
|                address.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
 | |
|   always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
 | |
|   describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
 | |
|   it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
 | |
|   match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
 | |
|   make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
 | |
|   client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
 | |
|   URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
 | |
|   any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
 | |
|   list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
 | |
|   a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
 | |
|   in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
 | |
|   referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
 | |
|   the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
 | |
|   start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
 | |
|   doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
 | |
|   statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
 | |
|   condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
 | |
|   used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
 | |
|   there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
 | |
|   makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
 | |
|   request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
 | |
|   ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
 | |
|   tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
 | |
|   another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
 | |
|   the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
 | |
|   on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
 | |
|   extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
 | |
|   request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
 | |
|   not be evaluated.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
 | |
|   established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
 | |
|   the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
 | |
|          unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
 | |
|          processes, which can result in random behaviors.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
 | |
|     # last 30 minutes
 | |
|     backend pop
 | |
|         mode tcp
 | |
|         balance roundrobin
 | |
|         stick store-request src
 | |
|         stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
 | |
|         server s1 192.168.1.1:110
 | |
|         server s2 192.168.1.1:110
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend smtp
 | |
|         mode tcp
 | |
|         balance roundrobin
 | |
|         stick match src table pop
 | |
|         server s1 192.168.1.1:25
 | |
|         server s2 192.168.1.1:25
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
 | |
|              about ACLs and sample fetching.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
 | |
|             size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
 | |
|             [store <data_type>]*
 | |
|   Configure the stickiness table for the current section
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     ip         a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
 | |
|                This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
 | |
|                very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
 | |
|                is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     ipv6       a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
 | |
|                This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
 | |
|                very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
 | |
|                is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     integer    a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
 | |
|                which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
 | |
|                instance.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     string     a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
 | |
|                to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
 | |
|                extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
 | |
|                being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
 | |
|                compared between the string in the table and the extracted
 | |
|                pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
 | |
|                to 32 characters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     binary     a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
 | |
|                of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
 | |
|                extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
 | |
|                being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
 | |
|                is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
 | |
|                specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <length>   is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
 | |
|                "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
 | |
|                of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
 | |
|                changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
 | |
|                increase.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <size>     is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
 | |
|                value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
 | |
|                50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
 | |
|                supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     [nopurge]  indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
 | |
|                is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
 | |
|                wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
 | |
|                entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
 | |
|                most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
 | |
|                be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
 | |
|                ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
 | |
|                far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
 | |
|                to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
 | |
|                using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
 | |
|                parameter (see below).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
 | |
|                which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
 | |
|                the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
 | |
|                automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
 | |
|                soft restart.
 | |
| 
 | |
|                NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
 | |
|                       belonging to the same unique process.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <expire>   defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
 | |
|                was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
 | |
|                defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
 | |
|                timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
 | |
|                section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
 | |
|                the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
 | |
|                be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
 | |
|                if not expiration delay is specified.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <srvkey>   specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
 | |
|                stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
 | |
|                given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
 | |
|                a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
 | |
|                by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
 | |
|                especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
 | |
|                the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
 | |
|                to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
 | |
|                token.
 | |
| 
 | |
|    <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
 | |
|                may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
 | |
|                to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
 | |
|                item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
 | |
|                that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
 | |
|                stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
 | |
|                the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
 | |
|                it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
 | |
|                several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
 | |
|                automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
 | |
|                explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
 | |
|                type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
 | |
|                data types require an argument which must be passed just after
 | |
|                the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
 | |
|                types and their arguments.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
 | |
|     - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
 | |
|       request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
 | |
|       and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
 | |
|       integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
 | |
|       to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
 | |
|       specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
 | |
|       over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
 | |
|       for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
 | |
|       a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
 | |
|       incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
 | |
|       occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
 | |
|       integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
 | |
|       to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
 | |
|       specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
 | |
|       over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
 | |
|       for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
 | |
|       a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
 | |
|       incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
 | |
|       occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
 | |
|       the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
 | |
|       this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
 | |
|       they were received.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
 | |
|       stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
 | |
|       once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
 | |
|       connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
 | |
|       number of concurrent connections for an entry.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
 | |
|       integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
 | |
|       of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
 | |
|       incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
 | |
|       result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
 | |
|       the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
 | |
|       entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
 | |
|       integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
 | |
|       of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
 | |
|       incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
 | |
|       result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
 | |
|       counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
 | |
|       matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
 | |
|       not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
 | |
|       the client side.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
 | |
|       integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
 | |
|       of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
 | |
|       HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
 | |
|       an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
 | |
|       they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
 | |
|       when keep-alive is used on the client side.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
 | |
|       counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
 | |
|       which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
 | |
|       requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
 | |
|       authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
 | |
|       also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
 | |
|       (e.g. vulnerability scan).
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
 | |
|       integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
 | |
|       of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
 | |
|       HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
 | |
|       http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
 | |
|       integer which can be matched using ACLs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
 | |
|       counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
 | |
|       which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
 | |
|       responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
 | |
|       being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
 | |
|       an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
 | |
|       of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
 | |
|       HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
 | |
|       http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
 | |
|       integer which can be matched using ACLs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
 | |
|       integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
 | |
|       which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
 | |
|       used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
 | |
|       integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
 | |
|       of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
 | |
|       incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
 | |
|       to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
 | |
|       uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
 | |
|       once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
 | |
|       instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
 | |
|       "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
 | |
|       recommended for better fairness.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
 | |
|       integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
 | |
|       matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
 | |
|       to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
 | |
|       an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
 | |
|       of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
 | |
|       outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
 | |
|       to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
 | |
|       transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
 | |
|       counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
 | |
|       transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
 | |
|       smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
 | |
|       byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
 | |
|   it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
 | |
|   to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
 | |
|   reference it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
 | |
|   has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
 | |
|   lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
 | |
|   information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
 | |
|   complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
 | |
|   Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
 | |
|   per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
 | |
|   something that can be ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
 | |
|         # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
 | |
|         # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
 | |
|         stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
 | |
|              about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
|   Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <pattern>  is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
 | |
|                describes what elements of the response or connection will
 | |
|                be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
 | |
|                server is selected.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <table>    is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
 | |
|                backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
 | |
|                the "stick-table" statement.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <cond>     is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
 | |
|                certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
 | |
|                For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
 | |
|                when the response is a SSL server hello.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
 | |
|   always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
 | |
|   statement  describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
 | |
|   when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
 | |
|   requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
 | |
|   extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
 | |
|   request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
 | |
|   See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
 | |
|   rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
 | |
|   a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
 | |
|   in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
 | |
|   referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
 | |
|   the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
 | |
|   start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
 | |
|   doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
 | |
|   statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
 | |
|   condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
 | |
|   be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
 | |
|   there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
 | |
|   makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
 | |
|   request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
 | |
|   ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
 | |
|   tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
 | |
|   another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
 | |
|   the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
 | |
|   on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
 | |
|   extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
 | |
|   response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
 | |
|   not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
 | |
|   store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
 | |
|   may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
 | |
|   response at once.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
 | |
|     backend https
 | |
|         mode tcp
 | |
|         balance roundrobin
 | |
|         # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
 | |
|         stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
 | |
| 
 | |
|         acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
 | |
|         acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
 | |
| 
 | |
|         # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
 | |
|         tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
 | |
|         tcp-request content accept if clienthello
 | |
| 
 | |
|         # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
 | |
|         tcp-response content accept if serverhello
 | |
| 
 | |
|         # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
 | |
|         # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
 | |
|         # at offset 44.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         # Match and learn on request if client hello.
 | |
|         stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
 | |
| 
 | |
|         # Learn on response if server hello.
 | |
|         stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
 | |
| 
 | |
|         server s1 192.168.1.1:443
 | |
|         server s2 192.168.1.1:443
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
 | |
|              extraction.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-check comment <string>
 | |
|   Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
 | |
|   it fails.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <string>  is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
 | |
|               rule fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
 | |
|   user-friendly error reporting.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
 | |
|              "tcp-check expect".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
 | |
|                   [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
 | |
|                   [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
 | |
|   Opens a new connection
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     comment <msg>  defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     default      Use default options of the server line to do the health
 | |
|                  checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     port <expr>  if not set, check port or server port is used.
 | |
|                  It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
 | |
|                  <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
 | |
|                  65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     addr <ip>    defines the IP address to do the health check.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     send-proxy   send a PROXY protocol string
 | |
| 
 | |
|     via-socks4   enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     ssl          opens a ciphered connection
 | |
| 
 | |
|     sni <sni>    specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     alpn <alpn>  defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
 | |
|                  list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
 | |
|                  for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
 | |
|                  If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
 | |
|                  It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
 | |
|                  backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
 | |
|                  haproxy -vv.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     linger       cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
 | |
|   load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
 | |
|   the services individually before considering a server as operational.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
 | |
|   directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
 | |
|   of the sequence.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
 | |
|   the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
 | |
|   do.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
 | |
|   unset-var or comment rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|          # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
 | |
|          # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
 | |
|          # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check connect
 | |
|          tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check send \r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
 | |
|          tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
 | |
|          tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check send \r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
 | |
|          server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
 | |
| 
 | |
|          # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check connect port 110 linger
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
 | |
|          tcp-check connect port 143
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
 | |
|          server mail 10.0.0.1 check
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
 | |
|                  [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
 | |
|                  [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
 | |
|                  [!] <match> <pattern>
 | |
|   Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     comment <msg>  defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     min-recv  is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
 | |
|               evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
 | |
|               is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
 | |
|               option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
 | |
|               avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
 | |
|               incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
 | |
|               minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
 | |
|               This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
 | |
|               does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
 | |
|               the evaluation result is always conclusive.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <match>   is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
 | |
|               response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
 | |
|               "rbinary".
 | |
|               The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
 | |
|               the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
 | |
|               keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     ok-status <st>     is optional and can be used to set the check status if
 | |
|                        the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
 | |
|                        the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
 | |
|                        "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
 | |
|                          - L7OK  : check passed on layer 7
 | |
|                          - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
 | |
|                                    server to NOLB state.
 | |
|                          - L6OK  : check passed on layer 6
 | |
|                          - L4OK  : check passed on layer 4
 | |
|                         By default "L7OK" is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     error-status <st>  is optional and can be used to set the check status if
 | |
|                        an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
 | |
|                        "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
 | |
|                        supported :
 | |
|                          - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
 | |
|                                    server to NOLB state.
 | |
|                          - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
 | |
|                          - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
 | |
|                          - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
 | |
|                          - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
 | |
|                        By default "L7RSP" is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     tout-status <st>   is optional and can be used to set the check status if
 | |
|                        a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
 | |
|                        "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
 | |
|                          - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
 | |
|                          - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
 | |
|                          - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
 | |
|                        By default "L7TOUT" is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     on-success <fmt>   is optional and can be used to customize the
 | |
|                        informational message reported in logs if the expect
 | |
|                        rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
 | |
|                        in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     on-error <fmt>     is optional and can be used to customize the
 | |
|                        informational message reported in logs if an error
 | |
|                        occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
 | |
|                        log-format string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
 | |
|                        reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
 | |
|                        standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|                        followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
 | |
|               expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
 | |
|               with the usual backslash ('\').
 | |
|               If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
 | |
|               a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
 | |
|               two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
 | |
|               used upper or lower case.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
 | |
|                       A health check response will be considered valid if the
 | |
|                       response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
 | |
|                       "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
 | |
|                       will be considered invalid if the body contains this
 | |
|                       string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
 | |
|                       in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
 | |
|                       specific error appears in a protocol banner.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
 | |
|                       A health check response will be considered valid if the
 | |
|                       response's buffer matches this expression. If the
 | |
|                       "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
 | |
|                       will be considered invalid if the body matches the
 | |
|                       expression.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
 | |
|                       A health check response will be considered valid if the
 | |
|                       response's buffer contains the  string resulting of the
 | |
|                       evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
 | |
|                       If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
 | |
|                       considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
 | |
|                          in the response buffer. A health check response will
 | |
|                          be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
 | |
|                          this exact hexadecimal string.
 | |
|                          Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
 | |
|                       "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
 | |
|                       into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
 | |
|                       allows using all regex engines to match any binary
 | |
|                       content.  The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
 | |
|                       size of the original response. As such, the expected
 | |
|                       pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
 | |
|                       size.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
 | |
|                          match in the response's buffer. A health check response
 | |
|                          will be considered valid if the response's buffer
 | |
|                          contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
 | |
|                          evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
 | |
|                          rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
 | |
|                          considered invalid if the buffer contains the
 | |
|                          hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
 | |
|                          in a binary string before matching the response's
 | |
|                          buffer.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
 | |
|   defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
 | |
|   Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
 | |
|   "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
 | |
|   is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
 | |
|   However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
 | |
|   waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
 | |
|   it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
 | |
|   current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
 | |
|   character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
 | |
|   the null character.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|          # perform a POP check
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
 | |
| 
 | |
|          # perform an IMAP check
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
 | |
| 
 | |
|          # look for the redis master server
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check send PING\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string +PONG
 | |
|          tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string role:master
 | |
|          tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string +OK
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
 | |
|              "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
 | |
| tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
 | |
|   Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
 | |
|   generic health check
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     comment <msg>  defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <data>         is the string that will be sent during a generic health
 | |
|                    check session.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <fmt>          is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
 | |
|                    during a generic health check session.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|          # look for the redis master server
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect string role:master
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
 | |
|              "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
 | |
| tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
 | |
|   Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
 | |
|   a binary question during a raw tcp health check
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     comment <msg>  defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <hexstring>    is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
 | |
|                    to binary, during a generic health check session.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <hexfmt>       is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
 | |
|                    evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
 | |
|                    check session.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|          # redis check in binary
 | |
|          option tcp-check
 | |
|          tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
 | |
|          tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
 | |
|              "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
 | |
|   This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <var-name>  The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
 | |
|                 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
 | |
|                   "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
 | |
|                   "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
 | |
|                   "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
 | |
|                 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
 | |
|                 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
 | |
|                 and '-'.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <expr>      Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|     tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
 | |
|   Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
 | |
|   May be used in sections:   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                yes    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <var-name>  The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
 | |
|                 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
 | |
|                   "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
 | |
|                   "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
 | |
|                   "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
 | |
|                 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
 | |
|                 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
 | |
|                 and '-'.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|     tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
|   Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <action>    defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
 | |
|                 below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
 | |
|   evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
 | |
|   or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
 | |
|   any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
 | |
|   buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
 | |
|   accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
 | |
|   some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
 | |
|   "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
 | |
|   order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
 | |
|   accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
 | |
|   rules which may be inserted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Four types of actions are supported :
 | |
|     - accept :
 | |
|         accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
 | |
|         or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
 | |
|         the rules evaluation.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - reject :
 | |
|         rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
 | |
|         or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
 | |
|         the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
 | |
|         session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
 | |
|         as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
 | |
|         rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
 | |
|         should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
 | |
|         the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
 | |
|         conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
 | |
|         system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
 | |
|         logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
 | |
|         be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - expect-proxy layer4 :
 | |
|         configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
 | |
|         header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
 | |
|         having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
 | |
|         the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
 | |
|         IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
 | |
|         of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
 | |
|         hosts.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
 | |
|         configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
 | |
|         IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
 | |
|         This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
 | |
|         "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
 | |
|         to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
 | |
|         is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
 | |
|         through by traffic coming from public hosts.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - capture <sample> len <length> :
 | |
|         This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
 | |
|         expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
 | |
|         string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
 | |
|         the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
 | |
|         some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
 | |
|         logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
 | |
|         feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
 | |
|         that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
 | |
|         session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
 | |
|         request header" for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
 | |
|         enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
 | |
|         rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
 | |
|         number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
 | |
|         connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
 | |
|         haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
 | |
|         and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
 | |
|         tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
 | |
|         first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
 | |
|         specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
 | |
|         enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
 | |
|         set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
 | |
|         the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
 | |
|         But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         These actions take one or two arguments :
 | |
|           <key>   is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
 | |
|                   in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
 | |
|                   request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
 | |
|                   and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
 | |
|                   Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
 | |
|                   fetches.
 | |
| 
 | |
|          <table>  is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
 | |
|                   which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
 | |
|                   the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
 | |
|                   then be performed in that table until the session ends.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
 | |
|         and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
 | |
|         that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
 | |
|         counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
 | |
|         counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
 | |
|         Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
 | |
|         been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
 | |
|         tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
 | |
|         layer7 information is extracted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
 | |
|         counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
 | |
|         expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
 | |
|         advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
 | |
|         performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
 | |
|         The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
 | |
|         counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
 | |
|         fails and the actions evaluation continues.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
 | |
|         The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
 | |
|         counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
 | |
|         fails and the actions evaluation continues.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
 | |
|         This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
 | |
|         counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
 | |
|         expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
 | |
|         fails and the actions evaluation continues.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - set-src <expr> :
 | |
|       Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
 | |
|       expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
 | |
|       If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
 | |
|       set-src".
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Arguments:
 | |
|          <expr>  Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|                  followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|          tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
 | |
| 
 | |
|       When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
 | |
|       address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - set-src-port <expr> :
 | |
|       Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
 | |
|       expression.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Arguments:
 | |
|          <expr>  Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|                  followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
|          tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
 | |
| 
 | |
|       When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
 | |
|       as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
 | |
|       address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - set-dst <expr> :
 | |
|       Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
 | |
|       expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
 | |
|       If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
 | |
|       set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
 | |
|       '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|          <expr>    Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|                    followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|          tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
 | |
|          tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
 | |
| 
 | |
|       When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
 | |
|       the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - set-dst-port <expr> :
 | |
|       Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
 | |
|       expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
 | |
|       '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|          <expr>    Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|                    followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|          tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
 | |
| 
 | |
|       When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
 | |
|       long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
 | |
|       destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "silent-drop" :
 | |
|         This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
 | |
|         connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
 | |
|         to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
 | |
|         client still sees an established connection while there's none on
 | |
|         HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
 | |
|         except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
 | |
|         running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
 | |
|         slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
 | |
|         of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
 | |
|         client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
 | |
|         the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
 | |
|         action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
 | |
|         TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
 | |
|         reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
 | |
|         TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
 | |
|         local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
 | |
|   the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
 | |
|   "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
 | |
|            connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
 | |
|            This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
 | |
|         tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
 | |
|         tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
 | |
|            connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
 | |
|            being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
 | |
|         tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
 | |
|         tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See section 7 about ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
|   Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <action>    defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
 | |
|                 below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
 | |
|   called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
 | |
|   evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
 | |
|   "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
 | |
|   inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
 | |
|   is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
 | |
|   decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
 | |
|   validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
 | |
|   both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
 | |
|   tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
 | |
|   what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
 | |
|   "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
 | |
|   processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
 | |
|   being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
 | |
|   when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
 | |
|   L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
 | |
|   rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
 | |
|   contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
 | |
|   inserted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Several types of actions are supported :
 | |
|     - accept : the request is accepted
 | |
|     - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
 | |
|     - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
 | |
|     - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
 | |
|     - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
 | |
|     - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
 | |
|     - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
 | |
|     - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
 | |
|     - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
 | |
|     - set-dst <expr>
 | |
|     - set-dst-port <expr>
 | |
|     - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
 | |
|     - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
 | |
|     - unset-var(<var-name>)
 | |
|     - silent-drop
 | |
|     - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
 | |
|     - use-service <service-name>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
 | |
|   so please refer to that section for a complete description.
 | |
|   For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
 | |
|   configuration section.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
 | |
|   track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
 | |
|   content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
 | |
|   rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
 | |
|   and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
 | |
|   may be used everywhere.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
 | |
|   the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
 | |
|   "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
 | |
|   information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
 | |
|   frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
 | |
|   lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
 | |
|   level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
 | |
|   prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
 | |
|   rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
 | |
|   preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
 | |
|   data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
 | |
|   ACL does not match.  The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
 | |
|   as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
 | |
|   differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
 | |
|   HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
 | |
|   first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
 | |
|   connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
 | |
|   "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
 | |
|   are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
 | |
|   wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
 | |
|   available.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
 | |
|   IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
 | |
|   declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
 | |
|   variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
 | |
|                its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|                  "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|                  "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|                  "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction
 | |
|                           (request and response)
 | |
|                  "req"  : the variable is shared only during request
 | |
|                           processing
 | |
|                  "res"  : the variable is shared only during response
 | |
|                           processing
 | |
|                This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
 | |
|                The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
 | |
|                '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <expr>     Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|                followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
 | |
|   upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
 | |
|   specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
 | |
|   capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
 | |
|   "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
 | |
|   preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
 | |
|   used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
 | |
|   warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
 | |
|   is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
 | |
|   unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
 | |
|   <var-name>.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
 | |
|   current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
 | |
|   integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
 | |
|   truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
 | |
|   are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
 | |
|   of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
 | |
|   to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
 | |
|   truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
 | |
|   class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
 | |
|   milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
 | |
|   Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
 | |
|   524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
 | |
|   adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
 | |
|   priority.  Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
 | |
|   combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
 | |
|   messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
 | |
|   well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
 | |
|   existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
 | |
|   the SPOE agent name must be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <group-name>  The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
 | |
|   request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
 | |
|   reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
 | |
|   connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
 | |
|   to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
 | |
|   evaluated.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|         tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
 | |
|         tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
 | |
|         # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
 | |
|         acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
 | |
|         tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
 | |
|         tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
 | |
|         tcp-request content reject
 | |
| 
 | |
|         # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
 | |
|         # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
 | |
|         acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
 | |
|         tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
 | |
|         tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
 | |
|         tcp-request reject   # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
 | |
|         ...
 | |
|         http-request reject unless is_host_com
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
 | |
|         tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
 | |
|         acl content_present req_len gt 0
 | |
|         tcp-request content reject if content_present
 | |
| 
 | |
|         # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
 | |
|         tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
 | |
|         acl content_present req_len gt 0
 | |
|         tcp-request content accept if content_present
 | |
|         tcp-request content reject
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
 | |
|         tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
 | |
|         tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
 | |
|         # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
 | |
|         tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
 | |
|         tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
 | |
|         tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
 | |
|            frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
 | |
| 
 | |
|         frontend http
 | |
|             # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
 | |
|             # protecting all our sites
 | |
|             stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
 | |
|             tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
 | |
|             tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
 | |
|             ...
 | |
|             use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
 | |
| 
 | |
|         backend http_dynamic
 | |
|             # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
 | |
|             # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
 | |
|             stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
 | |
|             acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
 | |
|             acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
 | |
|             tcp-request content track-sc1 src
 | |
|             tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See section 7 about ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
 | |
|              "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
 | |
|   risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
 | |
|   order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
 | |
|   the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
 | |
|   data for at most the specified amount of time.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
 | |
|   frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
 | |
|   means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
 | |
|   second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
 | |
|   rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
 | |
|   those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
 | |
|   a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
 | |
|   contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
 | |
|   and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
 | |
|   Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
 | |
|   setups are not recommended.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
 | |
|   the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
 | |
|   it pass through unaffected.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
 | |
|   send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
 | |
|   cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
 | |
|   to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
 | |
|   before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
 | |
|   data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
 | |
|   least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
 | |
|   closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
 | |
|   since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
 | |
|              "timeout client".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
|   Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <action>    defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
 | |
|                 below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
 | |
|   called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
 | |
|   evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
 | |
|   "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
 | |
|   delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
 | |
|   rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
 | |
|   contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
 | |
|   inserted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Several types of actions are supported :
 | |
|     - accept :
 | |
|         accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
 | |
|         or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
 | |
|         the rules evaluation.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - close :
 | |
|         immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
 | |
|         true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
 | |
|         first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
 | |
|         this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
 | |
|         and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
 | |
|         some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
 | |
|         connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
 | |
|         protocols.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - reject :
 | |
|         rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
 | |
|         or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
 | |
|         the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
 | |
|         Sets a variable.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - unset-var(<var-name>)
 | |
|         Unsets a variable.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
 | |
|         This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
 | |
|         counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
 | |
|         silently and the actions evaluation continues.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
 | |
|         This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
 | |
|         counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
 | |
|         silently and the actions evaluation continues.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
 | |
|         This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
 | |
|         counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
 | |
|         expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
 | |
|         fails and the actions evaluation continues.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - "silent-drop" :
 | |
|         This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
 | |
|         connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
 | |
|         to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
 | |
|         client still sees an established connection while there's none on
 | |
|         HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
 | |
|         except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
 | |
|         running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
 | |
|         slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
 | |
|         of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
 | |
|         client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
 | |
|         the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
 | |
|         action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
 | |
|         TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
 | |
|         reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
 | |
|         TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
 | |
|         local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
 | |
|         Send a group of SPOE messages.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
 | |
|   the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
 | |
|   for changing the default action to a reject.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
 | |
|   content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
 | |
|   been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
 | |
|   the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
 | |
|   period.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
 | |
|   declared inline.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
 | |
|                its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|                  "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|                  "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|                  "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction
 | |
|                           (request and response)
 | |
|                  "req"  : the variable is shared only during request
 | |
|                           processing
 | |
|                  "res"  : the variable is shared only during response
 | |
|                           processing
 | |
|                This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
 | |
|                The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
 | |
|                '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <expr>     Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
 | |
|                followed by some converters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|         tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
 | |
|   <var-name>.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|         tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
 | |
|   messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
 | |
|   well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
 | |
|   existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
 | |
|   the SPOE agent name must be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <group-name>  The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See section 7 about ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
|   Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <action>    defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
 | |
|                 below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
 | |
|   it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
 | |
|   must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
 | |
|   cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
 | |
|   the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
 | |
|   early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
 | |
|   session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
 | |
|   such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
 | |
|   from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
 | |
|   extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
 | |
|   "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
 | |
|   with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
 | |
|   in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
 | |
|   for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
 | |
|   rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
 | |
|   that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
 | |
|   assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
 | |
|   an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
 | |
|   order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
 | |
|   instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
 | |
|   order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
 | |
|   accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
 | |
|   rules which may be inserted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Several types of actions are supported :
 | |
|     - accept : the request is accepted
 | |
|     - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
 | |
|     - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
 | |
|     - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
 | |
|     - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
 | |
|     - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
 | |
|     - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
 | |
|     - unset-var(<var-name>)
 | |
|     - silent-drop
 | |
| 
 | |
|   These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
 | |
|   "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
 | |
|   sections for a complete description.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
 | |
|   the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
 | |
|   "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
 | |
|            in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
 | |
|            proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
 | |
|            PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
 | |
|            address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
 | |
|         tcp-request session track-sc0 src
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
 | |
|            sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
 | |
|            This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
 | |
|         tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
 | |
|         tcp-request session track-sc0 src
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
 | |
|            sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
 | |
|            being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
 | |
|         tcp-request session track-sc0 src
 | |
|         tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See section 7 about ACL usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  no    |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout check <timeout>
 | |
|   Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
 | |
|   established.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   May be used in sections:    defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
 | |
|   for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
 | |
|   used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
 | |
|   who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
 | |
|   (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
 | |
|   timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
 | |
|   avoid that).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
 | |
|   timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
 | |
|   requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
 | |
|   be smaller than "timeout server".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
 | |
|   "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
 | |
|   forget about it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
 | |
|             "timeout tarpit".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout client <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
 | |
|   send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
 | |
|   during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
 | |
|   response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
 | |
|   first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
 | |
|   protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
 | |
|   milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
 | |
|   suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
 | |
|   (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
 | |
|   client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
 | |
|   situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
 | |
|   losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
 | |
|   (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
 | |
|   sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
 | |
|   which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
 | |
|   "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
 | |
|   "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
 | |
|   forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
 | |
|   is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
 | |
|   during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
 | |
|   the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout client-fin <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
 | |
|   send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
 | |
|   from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
 | |
|   in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
 | |
|   FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
 | |
|   problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
 | |
|   Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
 | |
|   down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
 | |
|   frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
 | |
|   ends.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
 | |
|   "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
 | |
|   will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout connect <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
 | |
|   immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
 | |
|   cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
 | |
|   slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
 | |
|   connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
 | |
|   if these have not been specified.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
 | |
|   "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
 | |
|   forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
 | |
|   is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
 | |
|   during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
 | |
|   the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
 | |
|   by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
 | |
|   people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
 | |
|   faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
 | |
|   once the request has started to present itself.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
 | |
|   wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
 | |
|   the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
 | |
|   to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
 | |
|   new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
 | |
|   expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
 | |
|   just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
 | |
|   connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
 | |
|   milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
 | |
|   without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
 | |
|   1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
 | |
|   non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
 | |
|   with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
 | |
|   are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
 | |
|   set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
 | |
|   which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
 | |
|   using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
 | |
|   (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout http-request <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
 | |
|   accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
 | |
|   timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
 | |
|   nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
 | |
|   this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
 | |
|   attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
 | |
|   trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
 | |
|   types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
 | |
|   timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
 | |
|   about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
 | |
|   termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
 | |
|   standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
 | |
|   code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
 | |
|   more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
 | |
|   and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
 | |
|   not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
 | |
|   timeout also applies to the body of the request..
 | |
|   It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
 | |
|   request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
 | |
|   full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
 | |
|   retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
 | |
|   generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
 | |
|   will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
 | |
|   chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
 | |
|   effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
 | |
|   timeout will be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
 | |
|              "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout queue <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
 | |
|   which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
 | |
|   indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
 | |
|   timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
 | |
|   served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
 | |
|   be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
 | |
|   connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
 | |
|   with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "timeout connect".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout server <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
 | |
|   send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
 | |
|   during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
 | |
|   headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
 | |
|   request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
 | |
|   what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
 | |
|   to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
 | |
|   unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
 | |
|   document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
 | |
|   recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
 | |
|   order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
 | |
|   response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
 | |
|   packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
 | |
|   seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
 | |
|   with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
 | |
|   "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
 | |
|   tunnels.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
 | |
|   "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
 | |
|   forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
 | |
|   is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
 | |
|   during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
 | |
|   the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout server-fin <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
 | |
|   send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
 | |
|   from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
 | |
|   in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
 | |
|   FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
 | |
|   This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
 | |
|   Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
 | |
|   down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
 | |
|   situations, it should not be needed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
 | |
|   "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
 | |
|   will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout tarpit <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    yes   |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
 | |
|   open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
 | |
|   tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
 | |
|   unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
 | |
|   document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
 | |
|   ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
 | |
|   with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "timeout connect".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout tunnel <timeout>
 | |
|   Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
 | |
|               can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
 | |
|               as explained at the top of this document.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
 | |
|   between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
 | |
|   directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
 | |
|   the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
 | |
|   analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
 | |
|   accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
 | |
|   when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
 | |
|   to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
 | |
|   specified.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
 | |
|   it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
 | |
|   situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
 | |
|   acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
 | |
|   data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
 | |
|   and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
 | |
|   state.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
 | |
|   unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
 | |
|   document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
 | |
|   cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
 | |
|   are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
 | |
|   "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
 | |
|   forget about it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         defaults http
 | |
|             option http-server-close
 | |
|             timeout connect 5s
 | |
|             timeout client 30s
 | |
|             timeout client-fin 30s
 | |
|             timeout server 30s
 | |
|             timeout tunnel  1h    # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| transparent (deprecated)
 | |
|   Enable client-side transparent proxying
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                  yes   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments : none
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
 | |
|   3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
 | |
|   connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
 | |
|   this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
 | |
|   used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
 | |
|   IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
 | |
|   equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
 | |
|   appropriate server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
 | |
|   present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "option transparent"
 | |
| 
 | |
| unique-id-format <string>
 | |
|   Generate a unique ID for each request.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   yes  |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <string>   is a log-format string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
 | |
|   unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
 | |
|   a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
 | |
|   %ID tag the log-format string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
 | |
|   unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
 | |
|   are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
 | |
|   needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
 | |
|   and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
 | |
|   connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
 | |
|   Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
 | |
|   Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
 | |
|   makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|         unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
 | |
| 
 | |
|         will generate:
 | |
| 
 | |
|                7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "unique-id-header"
 | |
| 
 | |
| unique-id-header <name>
 | |
|   Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   yes  |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>   is the name of the header.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
 | |
|   unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|         unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
 | |
|         unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
 | |
| 
 | |
|         will generate:
 | |
| 
 | |
|            X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
 | |
| 
 | |
|     See also: "unique-id-format"
 | |
| 
 | |
| use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
 | |
|   Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    yes   |   yes  |   no
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <backend>   is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
 | |
|                 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
 | |
|                 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
 | |
|   dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
 | |
|   relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
 | |
|   "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
 | |
|   also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
 | |
|   source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
 | |
|   some payload.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
 | |
|   evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
 | |
|   assign the backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
 | |
|   second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
 | |
|   condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
 | |
|   If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
 | |
|   used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
 | |
|   used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
 | |
|   this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
 | |
|   and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
 | |
|   a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
 | |
|   must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
 | |
|   error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
 | |
|   a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
 | |
|   the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
 | |
|   backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
 | |
|   evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
 | |
|   when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
 | |
|   that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
 | |
|   cannot be forced from the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
 | |
|   used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
 | |
|   backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
 | |
|             section 7 about ACLs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| use-fcgi-app <name>
 | |
|   Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    no    |   yes   |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>    is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
 | |
| 
 | |
| use-server <server> if <condition>
 | |
| use-server <server> unless <condition>
 | |
|   Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
 | |
|   May be used in sections :   defaults | frontend | listen | backend
 | |
|                                   no   |    no    |   yes  |   yes
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <server>    is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
 | |
|                 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
 | |
|   the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
 | |
|   persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
 | |
|   server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
 | |
|   can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
 | |
|   the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
 | |
|   on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
 | |
|   rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
 | |
|   matches will assign the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
 | |
|   and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
 | |
|   with the next rules until one matches.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
 | |
|   second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
 | |
|   condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
 | |
|   according to other persistence mechanisms.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
 | |
|   does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
 | |
|   stripped.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
 | |
|   suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
 | |
|   be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
 | |
|   implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
 | |
|   set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|      # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
 | |
|      use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
 | |
|      server     www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
 | |
|      use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
 | |
|      server     mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
 | |
|      use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
 | |
|      server     imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
 | |
|      # all the rest is forwarded to this server
 | |
|      server  default 192.168.0.2:443 check
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
 | |
|   configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
 | |
|   If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
 | |
|   and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
 | |
|   was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
 | |
|   and we fall back to load balancing.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 5. Bind and server options
 | |
| --------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
 | |
| depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
 | |
| settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
 | |
| written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
 | |
| described in this section.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 5.1. Bind options
 | |
| -----------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
 | |
| as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
 | |
| no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
 | |
| parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
 | |
| while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
 | |
| provided immediately after the setting name.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The currently supported settings are the following ones.
 | |
| 
 | |
| accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
 | |
|   Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
 | |
|   connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
 | |
|   NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
 | |
|   the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
 | |
|   only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
 | |
|   real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
 | |
|   protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real  address will still
 | |
|   be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
 | |
|   used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
 | |
|   mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
 | |
|   "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
 | |
|   which client is allowed to use the protocol.
 | |
| 
 | |
| accept-proxy
 | |
|   Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
 | |
|   the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
 | |
|   are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
 | |
|   3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
 | |
|   used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
 | |
|   only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
 | |
|   indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
 | |
|   address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
 | |
|   components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
 | |
|   X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
 | |
|   usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
 | |
|   setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
 | |
| 
 | |
| allow-0rtt
 | |
|   Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
 | |
|   due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
 | |
|   you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
 | |
|   that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
 | |
|   request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
 | |
| 
 | |
| alpn <protocols>
 | |
|   This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
 | |
|   list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
 | |
|   delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
 | |
|   quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
 | |
|   extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
 | |
|   initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
 | |
|   Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
 | |
|   now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
 | |
|   support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
 | |
|   a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
 | |
|   are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
 | |
|   preference, like below :
 | |
| 
 | |
|        bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
 | |
| 
 | |
| backlog <backlog>
 | |
|   Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
 | |
|   backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
 | |
| 
 | |
| curves <curves>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
 | |
|   the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
 | |
|   that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
 | |
|   string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
 | |
|   Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
 | |
|   When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ecdhe <named curve>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
 | |
|   the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
 | |
|   used named curve is prime256v1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ca-file <cafile>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
 | |
|   client's certificate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
 | |
|   Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
 | |
|   If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
 | |
|   error is ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ca-sign-file <cafile>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
 | |
|   key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
 | |
|   setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
 | |
|   'generate-certificates' for details.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
 | |
|   the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
 | |
|   the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
 | |
|   'generate-certificates' for details.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ca-verify-file <cafile>
 | |
|   This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
 | |
|   verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
 | |
|   included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
 | |
|   be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
 | |
|   certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ciphers <ciphers>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
 | |
|   the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
 | |
|   negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
 | |
|   string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
 | |
|   information and recommendations see e.g.
 | |
|   (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
 | |
|   (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
 | |
|   cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
 | |
|   OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
 | |
|   the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
 | |
|   TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
 | |
|   OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
 | |
|   for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| crl-file <crlfile>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
 | |
|   to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
 | |
|   list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
 | |
| 
 | |
| crt <cert>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
 | |
|   associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
 | |
|   PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
 | |
|   requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
 | |
|   file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
 | |
|   "issuers-chain-path" directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
 | |
|   the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
 | |
|   are loaded.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
 | |
|   that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
 | |
|   with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
 | |
|   directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
 | |
|   multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
 | |
|   who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
 | |
|   CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
 | |
|   is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
 | |
|   www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
 | |
|   TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
 | |
|   match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
 | |
|   This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
 | |
|   recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
 | |
|   always be the first one in the directory.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
 | |
|   include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
 | |
|   choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
 | |
|   GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
 | |
|   others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
 | |
|   clients).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
 | |
|   suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
 | |
|   Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
 | |
|   enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
 | |
|   a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
 | |
|   must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
 | |
|   it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
 | |
|   has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
 | |
|   the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to  identify
 | |
|   which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
 | |
|   necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
 | |
|   be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
 | |
|   if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
 | |
|   path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
 | |
|   Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
 | |
|   valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
 | |
|   to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
 | |
|   and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
 | |
|   that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
 | |
|   simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
 | |
|   by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
 | |
|   bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
 | |
| 
 | |
| crt-ignore-err <errors>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
 | |
|   comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
 | |
|   set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
 | |
|   is ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
| crt-list <file>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
 | |
|   filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
 | |
| 
 | |
|         <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
 | |
|   "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
 | |
|   "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
 | |
|   "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
 | |
|   configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
 | |
|   useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
 | |
|   after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
 | |
|   Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
 | |
|   TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
 | |
|   filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
 | |
|   multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
 | |
|   certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
 | |
|   the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
 | |
|   as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
 | |
|   the same work on all bundled certificates.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
 | |
|   certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
 | |
|   the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
 | |
|   be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
 | |
|   filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
 | |
|   declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
 | |
|   never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
 | |
|   declared certificate act as a fallback.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   crt-list file example:
 | |
|         cert1.pem !*
 | |
|         # comment
 | |
|         cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
 | |
|         certW.pem                   *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
 | |
|         certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
 | |
| 
 | |
| defer-accept
 | |
|   Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
 | |
|   states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
 | |
|   or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
 | |
|   for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
 | |
|   performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
 | |
|   the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
 | |
|   connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
 | |
|   broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
 | |
|   the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
 | |
|   an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
 | |
|   option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
 | |
| 
 | |
| expose-fd listeners
 | |
|   This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
 | |
|   the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
 | |
|   During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
 | |
|   reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
 | |
|   See also "-x" in the management guide.
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-sslv3
 | |
|   This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
 | |
|   this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
 | |
|   for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-tlsv10
 | |
|   This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
 | |
|   this listener. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-tlsv11
 | |
|   This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
 | |
|   this listener. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-tlsv12
 | |
|   This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
 | |
|   this listener. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-tlsv13
 | |
|   This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
 | |
|   this listener. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| generate-certificates
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
 | |
|   private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
 | |
|   a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
 | |
|   name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
 | |
|   enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
 | |
|   indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
 | |
|   hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
 | |
|   used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
 | |
|   It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
 | |
|   deployment of an architecture with many backends.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
 | |
|   to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
 | |
|   increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
 | |
|   certificate is used many times.
 | |
| 
 | |
| gid <gid>
 | |
|   Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
 | |
|   be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
 | |
|   some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
 | |
|   setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
 | |
|   ignored by non UNIX sockets.
 | |
| 
 | |
| group <group>
 | |
|   Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
 | |
|   also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
 | |
|   that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
 | |
|   "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
 | |
|   setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
 | |
| 
 | |
| id <id>
 | |
|   Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
 | |
|   sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
 | |
|   must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
 | |
|   option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
 | |
| 
 | |
| interface <interface>
 | |
|   Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
 | |
|   received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
 | |
|   currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
 | |
|   interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
 | |
|   frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
 | |
|   that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
 | |
|   is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
 | |
|   uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
 | |
|   even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
 | |
|   This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
 | |
|   client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
 | |
|   interfaces.
 | |
| 
 | |
| level <level>
 | |
|   This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
 | |
|   the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
 | |
|   sockets. <level> can be one of :
 | |
|   - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
 | |
|     read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
 | |
|     is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
 | |
|   - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
 | |
|     be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
 | |
|     counters).
 | |
|   - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
 | |
|     all counters).
 | |
| 
 | |
| severity-output <format>
 | |
|   This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
 | |
|   level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
 | |
|   level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
 | |
|   rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
 | |
|   (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
 | |
|   prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
 | |
|   - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
 | |
|   - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
 | |
|   - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
 | |
|     rfc5424 convention.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxconn <maxconn>
 | |
|   Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
 | |
|   connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
 | |
|   released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
 | |
|   maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
 | |
|   value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
 | |
|   limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
 | |
|   eat all memory.
 | |
| 
 | |
| mode <mode>
 | |
|   Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
 | |
|   can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
 | |
|   Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
 | |
|   UNIX sockets.
 | |
| 
 | |
| mss <maxseg>
 | |
|   Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
 | |
|   connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
 | |
|   ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
 | |
|   relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
 | |
|   was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
 | |
|   operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
 | |
|   effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
 | |
|   over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
 | |
|   positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
 | |
|   indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
 | |
|   outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
 | |
| 
 | |
| name <name>
 | |
|   Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
 | |
|   page.
 | |
| 
 | |
| namespace <name>
 | |
|   On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
 | |
|   belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
 | |
|   a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
 | |
|   system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
 | |
| 
 | |
| nice <nice>
 | |
|   Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
 | |
|   in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
 | |
|   means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
 | |
|   their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
 | |
|   connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
 | |
|   only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
 | |
|   Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
 | |
|   and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
 | |
|   processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
 | |
|   it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
 | |
|   one for an RDP socket.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-ca-names
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
 | |
|   Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-sslv3
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
 | |
|   SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
 | |
|   be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
 | |
|   global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
 | |
|   "ssl-max-ver" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tls-tickets
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
 | |
|   extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
 | |
|   session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
 | |
|   available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
 | |
|   The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
 | |
|   Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
 | |
|   are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tlsv10
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
 | |
|   when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
 | |
|   cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
 | |
|   available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
 | |
|   and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tlsv11
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
 | |
|   when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
 | |
|   cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
 | |
|   available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
 | |
|   and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tlsv12
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
 | |
|   when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
 | |
|   cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
 | |
|   available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
 | |
|   and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tlsv13
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
 | |
|   when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
 | |
|   cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
 | |
|   available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
 | |
|   and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
| npn <protocols>
 | |
|   This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
 | |
|   as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
 | |
|   list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
 | |
|   This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
 | |
|   enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
 | |
|   replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
 | |
|   only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
 | |
|   version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
 | |
|   at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
 | |
|   though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
 | |
| 
 | |
| prefer-client-ciphers
 | |
|   Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
 | |
|   the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
 | |
|   global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
 | |
|   Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
 | |
|   (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
 | |
|   the client cipher list.
 | |
| 
 | |
| process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
 | |
|   This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
 | |
|   allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
 | |
|   not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
 | |
|   between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
 | |
|   on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
 | |
|   run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
 | |
|   or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
 | |
|   set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
 | |
|   connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
 | |
|   and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
 | |
|   configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
 | |
|   case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
 | |
|   <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
 | |
| 
 | |
|       all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
 | |
|   case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
 | |
|   this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
 | |
|   socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
 | |
|   the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
 | |
|   can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
 | |
|   smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
 | |
|   for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
 | |
| 
 | |
| proto <name>
 | |
|   Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
 | |
|   must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
 | |
|   be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
 | |
|   in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
 | |
|   the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
 | |
|   subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
 | |
|   some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
 | |
|   also reported (flag=HTX).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
 | |
|   a bind line :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     h2   : mode=HTTP  side=FE|BE  mux=H2    flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
 | |
|     h1   : mode=HTTP  side=FE|BE  mux=H1    flags=HTX|NO_UPG
 | |
|     none : mode=TCP   side=FE|BE  mux=PASS  flags=NO_UPG
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
 | |
|   protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
 | |
|   instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
 | |
|   h2" on the bind line.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
 | |
|   certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
 | |
|   appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
 | |
|   to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
 | |
|   to enable it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
 | |
|   This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
 | |
|   from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
 | |
|   ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
 | |
|   versions. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
 | |
|   This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
 | |
|   instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
 | |
|   is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
 | |
|   See also "ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| strict-sni
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
 | |
|   SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
 | |
|   a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
 | |
|   See the "crt" option for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-ut <delay>
 | |
|   Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
 | |
|   listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
 | |
|   allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
 | |
|   receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
 | |
|   useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
 | |
|   remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
 | |
|   timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
 | |
|   important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
 | |
|   resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
 | |
|   argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
 | |
|   for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tfo
 | |
|   Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
 | |
|   enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
 | |
|   support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
 | |
|   during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
 | |
|   round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
 | |
|   that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
 | |
|   possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
 | |
|   packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
 | |
|   is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
 | |
|   need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
 | |
|   TCP_FASTOPEN.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
 | |
|   Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
 | |
|   or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
 | |
|   with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
 | |
|   The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
 | |
|   aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
 | |
|   build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
 | |
|   the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
 | |
|   penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
 | |
|   appending new key to the file and reloading the process.  Keys must be
 | |
|   periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
 | |
|   compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
 | |
|   storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
 | |
|   Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
 | |
| 
 | |
| transparent
 | |
|   Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
 | |
|   indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
 | |
|   local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
 | |
|   intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
 | |
|   requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
 | |
|   default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
 | |
|   This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
 | |
|   This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
 | |
|   kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
 | |
|   so check for support with your vendor.
 | |
| 
 | |
| v4v6
 | |
|   Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
 | |
|   including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
 | |
|   and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
 | |
|   on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
 | |
|   sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
 | |
| 
 | |
| v6only
 | |
|   Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
 | |
|   including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
 | |
|   when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
 | |
|   system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
 | |
|   has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
 | |
| 
 | |
| uid <uid>
 | |
|   Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
 | |
|   be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
 | |
|   some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
 | |
|   setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
 | |
|   setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
 | |
| 
 | |
| user <user>
 | |
|   Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
 | |
|   be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
 | |
|   some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
 | |
|   setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
 | |
|   ignored by non UNIX sockets.
 | |
| 
 | |
| verify [none|optional|required]
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
 | |
|   to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
 | |
|   cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
 | |
|   certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
 | |
|   handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
 | |
|   certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
 | |
|   'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
 | |
|   is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
 | |
|   matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 5.2. Server and default-server options
 | |
| ------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
 | |
| which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
 | |
| arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
 | |
| settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
 | |
| after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
 | |
| Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
 | |
| address if they are used:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
 | |
|   default-server [settings ...]
 | |
| 
 | |
| Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
 | |
| keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
 | |
| 
 | |
| The currently supported settings are the following ones.
 | |
| 
 | |
| addr <ipv4|ipv6>
 | |
|   Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
 | |
|   to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
 | |
|   desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
 | |
|   complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
 | |
|   This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
 | |
|   "port" parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
| agent-check
 | |
|   Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
 | |
|   health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
 | |
|   to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
 | |
|   terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
 | |
|   words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
 | |
|     Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
 | |
|     weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
 | |
|     weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
 | |
|     effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
 | |
|     in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
 | |
|     connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
 | |
|     balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
 | |
|     total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
 | |
|     READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
 | |
|     DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
 | |
|     that are accepted via persistence.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
 | |
|     MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
 | |
|     checks will be stopped.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
 | |
|     description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
 | |
|     operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
 | |
|     page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
 | |
|     expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
 | |
|     but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
 | |
|     or port not responding).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
 | |
|     also report that the service is accessible.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
 | |
|   example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
 | |
|   relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
 | |
|   agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
 | |
|   allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
 | |
|   it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
 | |
|   so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
 | |
|   agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
 | |
|   operations again.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
 | |
|   is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
 | |
|   parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
 | |
|   reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
 | |
|   server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
 | |
|   force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
 | |
|   and "no-agent-check" parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
| agent-send <string>
 | |
|   If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
 | |
|   to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
 | |
|   the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
 | |
|   different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
 | |
|   you want to terminate your request with a newline.
 | |
| 
 | |
| agent-inter <delay>
 | |
|   The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
 | |
|   to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
 | |
|   other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
 | |
|   parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
 | |
|   not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
 | |
|   hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
 | |
|   are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
 | |
|   add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
 | |
|   global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
 | |
|   of backends use the same servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
| agent-addr <addr>
 | |
|   The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
 | |
|   managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
 | |
|   make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
 | |
|   hostname, it will be resolved.
 | |
| 
 | |
| agent-port <port>
 | |
|   The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
| allow-0rtt
 | |
|   Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
 | |
|   Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
 | |
|   if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| alpn <protocols>
 | |
|   This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
 | |
|   list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
 | |
|   delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
 | |
|   quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
 | |
|   extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
 | |
|   initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
 | |
|   Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
 | |
|   now obsolete NPN extension.
 | |
|   If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
 | |
|   be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
 | |
| 
 | |
|        server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
 | |
| 
 | |
| backup
 | |
|   When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
 | |
|   balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
 | |
|   with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
 | |
|   though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
 | |
|   the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
 | |
|   "allbackups" options.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ca-file <cafile>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
 | |
|   server's certificate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| check
 | |
|   This option enables health checks on a server:
 | |
|     - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
 | |
|       considered available.
 | |
|     - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
 | |
|       available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
 | |
|       transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
 | |
|       "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
 | |
|       as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
 | |
|       set.
 | |
|     - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
 | |
|       application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
 | |
|       transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
 | |
|       exchanges succeed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
 | |
|   configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
 | |
|   proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
 | |
|   address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
 | |
|   server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
 | |
|   parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
 | |
|   connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
 | |
|   health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
 | |
|   defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
 | |
|   "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
 | |
|   failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
 | |
|   available.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
 | |
|   httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
 | |
|   "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|       # simple tcp check
 | |
|       backend foo
 | |
|         server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
 | |
|       # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
 | |
|       backend foo
 | |
|         server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
 | |
|       # simple tcp check is enough for check success
 | |
|       backend foo
 | |
|         option tcp-check
 | |
|         tcp-check connect
 | |
|         server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
 | |
| 
 | |
| check-send-proxy
 | |
|   This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
 | |
|   checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
 | |
|   normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
 | |
|   if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
 | |
|   directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
 | |
|   "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
 | |
|   protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
 | |
| 
 | |
| check-alpn <protocols>
 | |
|   Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
 | |
|   a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
 | |
|   (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
| check-proto <name>
 | |
|   Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
 | |
|   connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
 | |
|   HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
 | |
|   protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
 | |
|   reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
 | |
|   subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
 | |
|   some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
 | |
|   also reported (flag=HTX).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
 | |
|   directive on a server line:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     h2   : mode=HTTP  side=FE|BE  mux=H2    flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
 | |
|     fcgi : mode=HTTP  side=BE     mux=FCGI  flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
 | |
|     h1   : mode=HTTP  side=FE|BE  mux=H1    flags=HTX|NO_UPG
 | |
|     none : mode=TCP   side=FE|BE  mux=PASS  flags=NO_UPG
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
 | |
|   protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
 | |
|   If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
 | |
| 
 | |
| check-sni <sni>
 | |
|   This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
 | |
|   over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
 | |
|   set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
 | |
| 
 | |
| check-ssl
 | |
|   This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
 | |
|   whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
 | |
|   used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
 | |
|   checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
 | |
|   inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
 | |
|   check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
 | |
|   common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
 | |
|   All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
 | |
|   See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
 | |
|   this option.
 | |
| 
 | |
| check-via-socks4
 | |
|   This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
 | |
|   default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
 | |
|   for normal traffic.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ciphers <ciphers>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
 | |
|   option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
 | |
|   negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
 | |
|   string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
 | |
|   information and recommendations see e.g.
 | |
|   (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
 | |
|   (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
 | |
|   cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
 | |
|   OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
 | |
|   describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
 | |
|   1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
 | |
|   "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
 | |
|   For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
 | |
|   keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| cookie <value>
 | |
|   The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
 | |
|   <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
 | |
|   operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
 | |
|   cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
 | |
|   sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
 | |
|   the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
 | |
|   backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
 | |
| 
 | |
| crl-file <crlfile>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
 | |
|   to verify server's certificate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| crt <cert>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
 | |
|   It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
 | |
|   associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
 | |
|   files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
 | |
|   certificate request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
 | |
|   at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
 | |
|   option is set accordingly).
 | |
| 
 | |
| disabled
 | |
|   The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
 | |
|   that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
 | |
|   ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
 | |
|   new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
 | |
|   possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
 | |
|   See also "enabled" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| enabled
 | |
|   This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| error-limit <count>
 | |
|   If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
 | |
|   number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
 | |
|   option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
 | |
| 
 | |
| fall <count>
 | |
|   The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
 | |
|   <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
 | |
|   unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-sslv3
 | |
|   This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
 | |
|   high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-tlsv10
 | |
|   This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-tlsv11
 | |
|   This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-tlsv12
 | |
|   This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| force-tlsv13
 | |
|   This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| id <value>
 | |
|   Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
 | |
|   the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
 | |
|   assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
 | |
| 
 | |
| init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
 | |
|   Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
 | |
|   if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
 | |
|   turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
 | |
|   method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
 | |
|   finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
 | |
|   the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
 | |
|   "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
 | |
|   depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
 | |
|   specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
 | |
|   address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
 | |
|   startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
 | |
|   (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
 | |
|   server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
 | |
|   server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
 | |
|   message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
 | |
|   IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
 | |
|   instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
 | |
|   previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
 | |
|   the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
 | |
|   historic behavior.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|       defaults
 | |
|           # never fail on address resolution
 | |
|           default-server init-addr last,libc,none
 | |
| 
 | |
| inter <delay>
 | |
| fastinter <delay>
 | |
| downinter <delay>
 | |
|   The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
 | |
|   to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
 | |
|   It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
 | |
|   between checks depending on the server state :
 | |
| 
 | |
|              Server state                   |         Interval used
 | |
|     ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
 | |
|      UP 100% (non-transitional)             | "inter"
 | |
|     ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
 | |
|      Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
 | |
|      Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
 | |
|      or yet unchecked.                      |
 | |
|     ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
 | |
|      DOWN 100% (non-transitional)           | "downinter" if set,
 | |
|                                             | "inter" otherwise.
 | |
|     ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
 | |
|   other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
 | |
|   serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
 | |
|   not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
 | |
|   hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
 | |
|   are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
 | |
|   add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
 | |
|   global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
 | |
|   of backends use the same servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| log-proto <logproto>
 | |
|   The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
 | |
|   a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
 | |
|   and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
 | |
|   and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxconn <maxconn>
 | |
|   The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
 | |
|   connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
 | |
|   concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
 | |
|   waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
 | |
|   save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
 | |
|   parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
 | |
|   which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
 | |
|   the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
 | |
|   of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
 | |
|   single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
 | |
|   of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
 | |
|   than 50 concurrent requests.
 | |
| 
 | |
| maxqueue <maxqueue>
 | |
|   The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
 | |
|   will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
 | |
|   requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
 | |
|   waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
 | |
|   quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
 | |
|   balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
 | |
|   add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
 | |
|   to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
 | |
|   when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
 | |
|   means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
 | |
|   and "balance leastconn".
 | |
| 
 | |
| max-reuse <count>
 | |
|   The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
 | |
|   should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
 | |
|   new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
 | |
|   limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
 | |
|   This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
 | |
|   resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
 | |
|   layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
 | |
|   enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| minconn <minconn>
 | |
|   When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
 | |
|   limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
 | |
|   <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
 | |
|   the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
 | |
|   concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
 | |
|   server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
 | |
|   overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
 | |
|   and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| namespace <name>
 | |
|   On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
 | |
|   belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
 | |
|   a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
 | |
|   system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-agent-check
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-backup
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "backup" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-check
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "check" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-check-ssl
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-send-proxy
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-send-proxy-v2
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-ssl
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "ssl" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
 | |
|   however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
 | |
|   runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-ssl-reuse
 | |
|   This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
 | |
|   new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
 | |
|   and for paranoid users.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-sslv3
 | |
|   This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
 | |
|   using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Supported in default-server: No
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tls-tickets
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
 | |
|   disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
 | |
|   extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
 | |
|   session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
 | |
|   is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
 | |
|   The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
 | |
|   Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
 | |
|   are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
 | |
|   See also "tls-tickets".
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tlsv10
 | |
|   This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
 | |
|   using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
 | |
|   often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
 | |
|   option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
 | |
|   Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Supported in default-server: No
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tlsv11
 | |
|   This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
 | |
|   using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
 | |
|   often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
 | |
|   option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
 | |
|   Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Supported in default-server: No
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tlsv12
 | |
|   This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
 | |
|   using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
 | |
|   often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
 | |
|   option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
 | |
|   Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Supported in default-server: No
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tlsv13
 | |
|   This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
 | |
|   the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
 | |
|   using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
 | |
|   often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
 | |
|   option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
 | |
|   Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Supported in default-server: No
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-verifyhost
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| no-tfo
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "tfo" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| non-stick
 | |
|   Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
 | |
|   This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
 | |
|   stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| npn <protocols>
 | |
|   This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
 | |
|   as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
 | |
|   list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
 | |
|   This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
 | |
|   enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
 | |
|   replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
 | |
|   only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
 | |
| 
 | |
| observe <mode>
 | |
|   This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
 | |
|   the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
 | |
|   requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
 | |
|   "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
 | |
|   significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
 | |
|   received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
 | |
|   headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
 | |
| 
 | |
| on-error <mode>
 | |
|   Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
 | |
|   Currently, four modes are available:
 | |
|   - fastinter: force fastinter
 | |
|   - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
 | |
|   - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
 | |
|     check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
 | |
|   - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
 | |
| 
 | |
| on-marked-down <action>
 | |
|   Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
 | |
|   Currently one action is available:
 | |
|   - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
 | |
|     all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
 | |
|     goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
 | |
|     than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
 | |
|     to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
 | |
|     might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
 | |
|     existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
 | |
|     a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Actions are disabled by default
 | |
| 
 | |
| on-marked-up <action>
 | |
|   Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
 | |
|   Currently one action is available:
 | |
|   - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
 | |
|     done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
 | |
|     (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
 | |
|     an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
 | |
|     with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
 | |
|     than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
 | |
|     with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
 | |
|     with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Actions are disabled by default
 | |
| 
 | |
| pool-low-conn <max>
 | |
|   Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
 | |
|   which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
 | |
|   can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
 | |
|   fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
 | |
|   all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
 | |
|   them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
 | |
|   seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
 | |
|   times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
 | |
|   at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
 | |
|   to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
 | |
|   applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
 | |
|   be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
 | |
|   this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
 | |
|   connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
 | |
| 
 | |
| pool-max-conn <max>
 | |
|   Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
 | |
|   connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
 | |
|   connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
 | |
|   client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
 | |
|   usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
 | |
|   according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
 | |
| 
 | |
| pool-purge-delay <delay>
 | |
|   Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
 | |
|   of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
 | |
|   The default is 5s.
 | |
| 
 | |
| port <port>
 | |
|   Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
 | |
|   send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
 | |
|   desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
 | |
|   tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
 | |
|   common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
 | |
|   ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
 | |
| 
 | |
| proto <name>
 | |
|   Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
 | |
|   server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
 | |
|   must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
 | |
|   reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
 | |
|   (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
 | |
|   subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
 | |
|   some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
 | |
|   also reported (flag=HTX).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
 | |
|   a server line :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     h2   : mode=HTTP  side=FE|BE  mux=H2    flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
 | |
|     fcgi : mode=HTTP  side=BE     mux=FCGI  flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
 | |
|     h1   : mode=HTTP  side=FE|BE  mux=H1    flags=HTX|NO_UPG
 | |
|     none : mode=TCP   side=FE|BE  mux=PASS  flags=NO_UPG
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
 | |
|   protocol for all connections established to this server.
 | |
| 
 | |
| redir <prefix>
 | |
|   The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
 | |
|   requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
 | |
|   forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
 | |
|   the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
 | |
|   requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
 | |
|   that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
 | |
|   will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
 | |
|   the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
 | |
|   mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
 | |
|   requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
 | |
|   users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
 | |
|   increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
 | |
|   connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
 | |
|   loop between the client and HAProxy!
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :  server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
 | |
| 
 | |
| rise <count>
 | |
|   The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
 | |
|   after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
 | |
|   if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
| resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
 | |
|   Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
 | |
|   server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Available options:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * allow-dup-ip
 | |
|     By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
 | |
|     resolution at runtime is in operation.
 | |
|     That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
 | |
|     backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
 | |
|     For such case, simply enable this option.
 | |
|     This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * ignore-weight
 | |
|     Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record.  This is useful when
 | |
|     you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
 | |
|     using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   * prevent-dup-ip
 | |
|     Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
 | |
|     an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
 | |
|     same fqdn.
 | |
|     This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     backend b_myapp
 | |
|       default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
 | |
|       server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
 | |
|       server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
 | |
| 
 | |
|   With the option allow-dup-ip set:
 | |
|   * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
 | |
|     it
 | |
|   * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
 | |
|     different address
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Default value: not set
 | |
| 
 | |
| resolve-prefer <family>
 | |
|   When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
 | |
|   different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
 | |
|   from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
 | |
|   Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Default value: ipv6
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
 | |
| 
 | |
| resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
 | |
|   This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
 | |
|   useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
 | |
|   availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
 | |
|   different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
 | |
|   this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
 | |
|   configured network, another address is selected.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
 | |
| 
 | |
| resolvers <id>
 | |
|   Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
 | |
|   hostname.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also section 5.3
 | |
| 
 | |
| send-proxy
 | |
|   The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
 | |
|   connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
 | |
|   end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
 | |
|   know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
 | |
|   upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
 | |
|   "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
 | |
|   TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
 | |
|   Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
 | |
|   fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
 | |
|   "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
 | |
|   aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
 | |
|   protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
 | |
|   explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
 | |
|   "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
 | |
|   See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
 | |
|   "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| send-proxy-v2
 | |
|   The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
 | |
|   over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
 | |
|   the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
 | |
|   that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
 | |
|   whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
 | |
|   have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
 | |
|   of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
 | |
|   this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
 | |
|   The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
 | |
|   version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - ssl       : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
 | |
|   - cert-cn   : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
 | |
|   - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
 | |
|   - cert-sig  : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
 | |
|   - cert-key  : Key algorithm of the used certificate
 | |
|   - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
 | |
|                 connection is supported).
 | |
|   - crc32c    : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
 | |
|   - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
 | |
|                 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
 | |
|                 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
 | |
|                 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
 | |
|                 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
 | |
|                 within a Keep-Alive connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
| send-proxy-v2-ssl
 | |
|   The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
 | |
|   2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
 | |
|   the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
 | |
|   that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
 | |
|   whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
 | |
|   of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
 | |
|   must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
 | |
|   See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
 | |
|   "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
 | |
|   The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
 | |
|   2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
 | |
|   the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
 | |
|   that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
 | |
|   whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
 | |
|   of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
 | |
|   the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
 | |
|   setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
 | |
|   protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
 | |
|   the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
 | |
|   The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
 | |
|   indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
 | |
|   full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
 | |
|   in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
 | |
|   linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
 | |
|   parameters :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
 | |
|     to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
 | |
|     grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
 | |
|     health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
 | |
|     is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
 | |
|   trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
 | |
|   seen as failed.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sni <expression>
 | |
|   The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
 | |
|   string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
 | |
|   the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
 | |
|   a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
 | |
|   expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
 | |
|   "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
 | |
|   name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
 | |
|   "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
 | |
|   checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
| source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
 | |
| source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
 | |
| source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
 | |
|   The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
 | |
|   connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
 | |
|   as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
 | |
|   referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
 | |
|   source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
 | |
|   dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
 | |
|   source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
 | |
|   several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
 | |
|   total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
 | |
|   server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
 | |
|   specifying the source address without port(s).
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl
 | |
|   This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
 | |
|   is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
 | |
|   connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
 | |
|   the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
 | |
|   checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
 | |
|   "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
 | |
|   See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
 | |
|   SSL health checks.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
 | |
|   This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
 | |
|   with the server. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
 | |
|   This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
 | |
|   with the server. This option is also available on global statement
 | |
|   "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl-reuse
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| stick
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| socks4 <addr>:<port>
 | |
|   This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
 | |
|   server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
 | |
|   default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tcp-ut <delay>
 | |
|   Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
 | |
|   option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
 | |
|   configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
 | |
|   acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
 | |
|   long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
 | |
|   terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
 | |
|   must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
 | |
|   detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
 | |
|   associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
 | |
|   case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
 | |
|   too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
 | |
|   argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
 | |
|   regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tfo
 | |
|   This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
 | |
|   systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
 | |
|   See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
 | |
|   Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
 | |
|   "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
 | |
|   won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
 | |
| 
 | |
| track [<proxy>/]<server>
 | |
|   This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
 | |
|   another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
 | |
|   server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
 | |
|   enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
 | |
|   used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
 | |
| 
 | |
| tls-tickets
 | |
|   This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
 | |
|   setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
 | |
|   default value.
 | |
|   The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
 | |
|   Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
 | |
|   are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
 | |
|   It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
 | |
|   "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| verify [none|required]
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
 | |
|   to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
 | |
|   certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
 | |
|   optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
 | |
|   the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
 | |
|   the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
 | |
|   host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
 | |
|   certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
 | |
|   to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
 | |
|   critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
 | |
|   to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
 | |
|   attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
 | |
|   the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
 | |
| 
 | |
| verifyhost <hostname>
 | |
|   This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
 | |
|   only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
 | |
|   a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
 | |
|   SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
 | |
|   way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
 | |
|   also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
 | |
|   of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
 | |
|   handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
 | |
|   include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
 | |
| 
 | |
| weight <weight>
 | |
|   The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
 | |
|   other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
 | |
|   relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
 | |
|   load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
 | |
|   means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
 | |
|   persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
 | |
|   according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
 | |
|   can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
 | |
|   room above and below for later adjustments.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 5.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
 | |
| -------------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
 | |
| using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
 | |
| configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
 | |
| This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
 | |
| can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
 | |
| workload.
 | |
| This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
 | |
| resolution at run time.
 | |
| Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
 | |
| carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 5.3.1. Global overview
 | |
| ----------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
 | |
| different steps of the process life:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
 | |
|      host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
 | |
|      resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
 | |
|      requiring DNS resolutions.
 | |
| 
 | |
| A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
 | |
|   - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
 | |
|     because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
 | |
|     resolution to know this new IP.
 | |
| 
 | |
| When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
 | |
| HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
 | |
| SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
 | |
| from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
 | |
| will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
 | |
| will automatically do the same.
 | |
| 
 | |
| A few things important to notice:
 | |
|   - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
 | |
|     first valid response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
 | |
|     servers return an error.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 5.3.2. The resolvers section
 | |
| ----------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
 | |
| HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
 | |
| contain many name servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
 | |
| uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
 | |
| is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
 | |
| answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
 | |
| 
 | |
| When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
 | |
| used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
 | |
|      switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
 | |
|      errors are also excluded.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
 | |
|      retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
 | |
|      response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
 | |
|      the error.
 | |
| 
 | |
| For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
 | |
| following scenarios are possible:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
 | |
|     ignored
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
 | |
|     applied
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
 | |
|     HAProxy retries the query with a new type
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
 | |
|     retries the query with a new type
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
 | |
|     same query type
 | |
| 
 | |
| As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
 | |
| a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
 | |
| <hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| resolvers <resolvers id>
 | |
|   Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
 | |
| 
 | |
| A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
 | |
| 
 | |
| accepted_payload_size <nb>
 | |
|   Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
 | |
|   name servers configured in this resolvers section.
 | |
|   <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
 | |
|        by RFC 6891)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
 | |
|         4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
 | |
|         that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
 | |
|         since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
 | |
|         nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
 | |
|         to the max: 65535.
 | |
| 
 | |
| nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
 | |
|   Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
 | |
|   By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
 | |
|   IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
 | |
|   the UDP protocol will be used.  If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
 | |
|   the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
 | |
|   "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
 | |
|   resolving will be considered.  Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
 | |
|   pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
 | |
|   every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
 | |
|   concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
 | |
| 
 | |
| parse-resolv-conf
 | |
|   Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
 | |
|   list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
 | |
|   placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
| hold <status> <period>
 | |
|   Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
 | |
|   on last resolution <status>
 | |
|     <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
 | |
|                "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
 | |
|     <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
 | |
|                answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
 | |
|                <period> is in milliseconds by default.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
 | |
| 
 | |
| resolve_retries <nb>
 | |
|   Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
 | |
|   giving up.
 | |
|   Default value: 3
 | |
| 
 | |
|   A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
 | |
|   type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
 | |
|   type.
 | |
| 
 | |
| timeout <event> <time>
 | |
|   Defines timeouts related to name resolution
 | |
|      <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
 | |
|                events available are:
 | |
|                - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
 | |
|                            other time applied.
 | |
|                            Default value: 1s
 | |
|                - retry   : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
 | |
|                            have been received.
 | |
|                            Default value: 1s
 | |
|      <time>  : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
 | |
|                <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|    resolvers mydns
 | |
|      nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
 | |
|      nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
 | |
|      nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
 | |
|      parse-resolv-conf
 | |
|      resolve_retries       3
 | |
|      timeout resolve       1s
 | |
|      timeout retry         1s
 | |
|      hold other           30s
 | |
|      hold refused         30s
 | |
|      hold nx              30s
 | |
|      hold timeout         30s
 | |
|      hold valid           10s
 | |
|      hold obsolete        30s
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 6. Cache
 | |
| ---------
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
 | |
| (favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
 | |
| RAM.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
 | |
| this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
 | |
| 
 | |
| If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
 | |
| independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
 | |
| when we try to allocate a new one.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
 | |
| 
 | |
| It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
 | |
| "show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
 | |
| for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
| When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
 | |
| replaced by "<CACHE>".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 6.1. Limitation
 | |
| ----------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
 | |
| 
 | |
| - If the response is not a 200
 | |
| - If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
 | |
|   disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
 | |
|   accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
 | |
| - If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
 | |
| - If the response is not cacheable
 | |
| - If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
 | |
|   Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
 | |
|   headers)
 | |
| - If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
 | |
|   entries with the same primary key as the current response
 | |
| - If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
 | |
|   mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
 | |
|   while varying on the accept-encoding client header
 | |
| 
 | |
| - If the request is not a GET
 | |
| - If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
 | |
| - If the request contains an Authorization header
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 6.2. Setup
 | |
| -----------
 | |
| 
 | |
| To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
 | |
| the corresponding http-request and response actions.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 6.2.1. Cache section
 | |
| ---------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| cache <name>
 | |
|   Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
 | |
|   size of cache is mandatory.
 | |
| 
 | |
| total-max-size <megabytes>
 | |
|   Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
 | |
|   blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
 | |
| 
 | |
| max-object-size <bytes>
 | |
|   Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
 | |
|   an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
 | |
|   All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
 | |
| 
 | |
| max-age <seconds>
 | |
|   Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
 | |
|   value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
 | |
|   Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
 | |
|   seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
 | |
|   default.
 | |
| 
 | |
| process-vary <on/off>
 | |
|   Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
 | |
|   containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
 | |
|   a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
 | |
|   (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
 | |
|   for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
 | |
| 
 | |
| max-secondary-entries <number>
 | |
|   Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
 | |
|   key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
 | |
|   and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 6.2.2. Proxy section
 | |
| ---------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
|   Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
 | |
|   mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
 | |
|   use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
 | |
|   after this one.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
|   Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
 | |
|   is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
 | |
|   to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
 | |
|   is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     backend bck1
 | |
|       mode http
 | |
| 
 | |
|       http-request cache-use foobar
 | |
|       http-response cache-store foobar
 | |
|       server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
 | |
| 
 | |
|     cache foobar
 | |
|       total-max-size 4
 | |
|       max-age 240
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7. Using ACLs and fetching samples
 | |
| ----------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
 | |
| client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
 | |
| The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
 | |
| these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
 | |
| but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
 | |
| data called patterns.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.1. ACL basics
 | |
| ---------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
 | |
| content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
 | |
| from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
 | |
| simple :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
 | |
|   - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
 | |
|   - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
 | |
|   - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
 | |
| 
 | |
| The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
 | |
| adding a header.
 | |
| 
 | |
| In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
 | |
| 
 | |
|    acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
 | |
| 
 | |
| This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
 | |
| Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
 | |
| and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
 | |
| an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
 | |
| conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
 | |
| as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
 | |
| are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
 | |
| '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
 | |
| which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
 | |
| performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
 | |
| specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
 | |
| this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
 | |
| methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
 | |
| ones supporting a conversion.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
 | |
|   - boolean
 | |
|   - integer (signed or unsigned)
 | |
|   - IPv4 or IPv6 address
 | |
|   - string
 | |
|   - data block
 | |
| 
 | |
| Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
 | |
| converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
 | |
| would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
 | |
| The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
 | |
| which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
 | |
| keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
 | |
| fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
 | |
| which are summarized in the table below :
 | |
| 
 | |
|    +---------------------+-----------------+
 | |
|    | Sample or converter | Default         |
 | |
|    |    output type      | matching method |
 | |
|    +---------------------+-----------------+
 | |
|    | boolean             | bool            |
 | |
|    +---------------------+-----------------+
 | |
|    | integer             | int             |
 | |
|    +---------------------+-----------------+
 | |
|    | ip                  | ip              |
 | |
|    +---------------------+-----------------+
 | |
|    | string              | str             |
 | |
|    +---------------------+-----------------+
 | |
|    | binary              | none, use "-m"  |
 | |
|    +---------------------+-----------------+
 | |
| 
 | |
| Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
 | |
| matching method, see below.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
 | |
|   - boolean
 | |
|   - integer or integer range
 | |
|   - IP address / network
 | |
|   - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
 | |
|   - regular expression
 | |
|   - hex block
 | |
| 
 | |
| The following ACL flags are currently supported :
 | |
| 
 | |
|    -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
 | |
|    -f : load patterns from a file.
 | |
|    -m : use a specific pattern matching method
 | |
|    -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
 | |
|    -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
 | |
|    -u : force the unique id of the ACL
 | |
|    -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
 | |
| read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
 | |
| if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
 | |
| lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
 | |
| will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
 | |
| beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
 | |
| a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
 | |
| lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
 | |
| exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
 | |
| parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
 | |
| ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
 | |
| a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
 | |
| check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
 | |
| socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
 | |
| file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
 | |
| loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
 | |
| 
 | |
| In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
 | |
| the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
 | |
| case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
 | |
| as well.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
 | |
| sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
 | |
| do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
 | |
| methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
 | |
| is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
 | |
| obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
 | |
| followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
 | |
| default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
 | |
| that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
 | |
| string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
 | |
| By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
 | |
| string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
 | |
| resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
 | |
| server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
 | |
| waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
 | |
| flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
 | |
| function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
 | |
| 
 | |
| There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
 | |
| sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
 | |
| be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
 | |
|               but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
 | |
|               to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
 | |
|               particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
 | |
|               as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
 | |
|               comparing them to anything nor counting them.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "bool"  : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
 | |
|               which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
 | |
|               Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "int"   : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
 | |
|               boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "ip"    : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
 | |
|               with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "bin"   : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
 | |
|               binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "len"   : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
 | |
|               binary or string samples.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "str"   : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
 | |
|               used with binary or string samples.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "sub"   : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
 | |
|               the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
 | |
|               string samples.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "reg"   : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
 | |
|               expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "beg"   : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
 | |
|               string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "end"   : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
 | |
|               string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "dir"   : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
 | |
|               contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
 | |
|               This may be used with binary or string samples.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "dom"   : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
 | |
|               exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
 | |
|               used with binary or string samples.
 | |
| 
 | |
| For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
 | |
| request, it is possible to do :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
 | |
| 
 | |
| In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
 | |
| buffer, one would use the following acl :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
 | |
| 
 | |
| On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
 | |
| possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
 | |
| 
 | |
| All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
 | |
| criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
 | |
| method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
 | |
| to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
 | |
| criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
 | |
| the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
 | |
| 
 | |
| If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
 | |
| the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
 | |
| For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     acl short_form  hdr_beg(host)        www.
 | |
|     acl alternate1  hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
 | |
|     acl alternate2  hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
 | |
|     acl alternate3  hdr(host)     -m beg www.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
 | |
| types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
 | |
| combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
 | |
| brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
 | |
| default without "-m".
 | |
| 
 | |
|                            +-------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|                            |                Input sample type                |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     |     pattern type     | boolean | integer |   ip    | string  | binary  |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | none (presence only) |  found  |  found  |  found  |  found  |  found  |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | none (boolean value) |>  bool <|   bool  |         |   bool  |         |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | integer (value)      |   int   |>  int  <|   int   |   int   |         |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | integer (length)     |   len   |   len   |   len   |   len   |   len   |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | IP address           |         |         |>   ip  <|    ip   |    ip   |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | exact string         |   str   |   str   |   str   |>  str  <|   str   |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | prefix               |   beg   |   beg   |   beg   |   beg   |   beg   |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | suffix               |   end   |   end   |   end   |   end   |   end   |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | substring            |   sub   |   sub   |   sub   |   sub   |   sub   |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | subdir               |   dir   |   dir   |   dir   |   dir   |   dir   |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | domain               |   dom   |   dom   |   dom   |   dom   |   dom   |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | regex                |   reg   |   reg   |   reg   |   reg   |   reg   |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
|     | hex block            |         |         |         |   bin   |   bin   |
 | |
|     +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.1.1. Matching booleans
 | |
| ------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
 | |
| Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
 | |
| When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
 | |
| that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
 | |
| return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
 | |
| "false" and all other values are converted to "true".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.1.2. Matching integers
 | |
| ------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
 | |
| enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
 | |
| to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
 | |
| matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
 | |
| lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
 | |
| 
 | |
| For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
 | |
| unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
 | |
| representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
 | |
| 
 | |
| As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
 | |
| two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
 | |
| instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
 | |
| ranges and operators.
 | |
| 
 | |
| For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
 | |
| operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
 | |
| Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
 | |
| of values.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Available operators for integer matching are :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
 | |
|   ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
 | |
|   gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
 | |
|   le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
 | |
|   lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
 | |
| 
 | |
| For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
 | |
| 
 | |
| This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.1.3. Matching strings
 | |
| -----------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
 | |
| different forms :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - exact match     (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
 | |
|     patterns;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
 | |
|     extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - prefix match    (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
 | |
|     the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - suffix match    (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
 | |
|     extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - subdir match    (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
 | |
|     string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
 | |
|     matches.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - domain match    (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
 | |
|     string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
 | |
|     matches.
 | |
| 
 | |
| String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
 | |
| exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
 | |
| characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
 | |
| string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
 | |
| to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
 | |
| before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
 | |
| 
 | |
| Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
 | |
| (0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
 | |
| Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Example:
 | |
|     # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
 | |
|     acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
 | |
| ---------------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
 | |
| they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
 | |
| possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
 | |
| passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
 | |
| the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
 | |
| the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
 | |
| match the string "--".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
 | |
| -------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
 | |
| not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
 | |
| a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
 | |
| to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
 | |
| digits may be used upper or lower case.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Example :
 | |
|     # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
 | |
|     acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
 | |
| ---------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
 | |
| netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
 | |
| within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
 | |
| host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
 | |
| difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
 | |
| at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
 | |
| does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
 | |
| parsed.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
 | |
| abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     +------------------+------------------+------------------+
 | |
|     |   Example 1      |     Example 2    |     Example 3    |
 | |
|     +------------------+------------------+------------------+
 | |
|     |  192.168.0.1     |   10.0.0.12      |   127.0.0.1      |
 | |
|     |  192.168.1       |   10.12          |   127.1          |
 | |
|     |  192.168.0.1/22  |   10.0.0.12/8    |   127.0.0.1/8    |
 | |
|     |  192.168.1/22    |   10.12/8        |   127.1/8        |
 | |
|     +------------------+------------------+------------------+
 | |
| 
 | |
| Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
 | |
| 192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
 | |
| 
 | |
| IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
 | |
| Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
 | |
| trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
 | |
| IPv6 patterns.
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
 | |
| following situations :
 | |
|   - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
 | |
|     in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
 | |
|   - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
 | |
|     in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
 | |
|   - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
 | |
|     using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
 | |
|     ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
 | |
|   - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
 | |
|     converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
 | |
|     applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
 | |
| ----------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
 | |
| combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - AND (implicit)
 | |
|   - OR  (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
 | |
|   - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
 | |
| 
 | |
| A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
 | |
| 
 | |
|    [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln  { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
 | |
| 
 | |
| Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
 | |
| indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
 | |
| 
 | |
| For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
 | |
| "OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
 | |
| requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
 | |
| is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
 | |
| 
 | |
|    acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
 | |
|    http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
 | |
|    http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
 | |
|    http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
 | |
| 
 | |
| To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
 | |
| and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
 | |
| 
 | |
|    acl url_static  path_beg         /static /images /img /css
 | |
|    acl url_static  path_end         .gif .png .jpg .css .js
 | |
|    acl host_www    hdr_beg(host) -i www
 | |
|    acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
 | |
| 
 | |
|    # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
 | |
|    # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
 | |
|    use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
 | |
|    use_backend www    if host_www
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
 | |
| expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
 | |
| be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
 | |
| the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
 | |
| 
 | |
|    The following rule :
 | |
| 
 | |
|        acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
 | |
|        http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
 | |
| 
 | |
|    Can also be written that way :
 | |
| 
 | |
|        http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
 | |
| to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
 | |
| simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
 | |
| sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
 | |
| good use is the following :
 | |
| 
 | |
|    With named ACLs :
 | |
| 
 | |
|         acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
 | |
|         acl site_dead nbsrv(static)  lt 2
 | |
|         monitor fail  if site_dead
 | |
| 
 | |
|    With anonymous ACLs :
 | |
| 
 | |
|         monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
 | |
| 
 | |
| See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
 | |
| keywords.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.3. Fetching samples
 | |
| ---------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
 | |
| against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
 | |
| sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
 | |
| ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
 | |
| of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
 | |
| available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
 | |
| 
 | |
| This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
 | |
| Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
 | |
| compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
 | |
| deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
 | |
| matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
 | |
| method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
 | |
| indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
 | |
| when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
 | |
| mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
 | |
| the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
 | |
| ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
 | |
| multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
 | |
| when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
 | |
| incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
 | |
| are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
 | |
| is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
 | |
| all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
 | |
|    - name
 | |
|    - name(arg1)
 | |
|    - name(arg1,arg2)
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.3.1. Converters
 | |
| -----------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
 | |
| of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
 | |
| is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
 | |
| was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
 | |
| has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
 | |
| unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
 | |
| 
 | |
| These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
 | |
| sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
 | |
| the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
 | |
| support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
 | |
| 
 | |
| A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
 | |
| support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
 | |
| supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
 | |
| (add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
 | |
| bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
 | |
| 
 | |
| 51d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
 | |
|   Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
 | |
|   separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
 | |
|   The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
 | |
|   converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
 | |
|   property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
 | |
|     # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
 | |
|     # User-Agent passed to the converter.
 | |
|     frontend http-in
 | |
|       bind *:8081
 | |
|       default_backend servers
 | |
|       http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
 | |
|         %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| add(<value>)
 | |
|   Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
 | |
|   result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
 | |
|   name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
 | |
|   scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
 | |
|   Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
 | |
|   AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
 | |
|   need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
 | |
|   If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
 | |
|   The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
 | |
|   converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
 | |
|       aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| and(<value>)
 | |
|   Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
 | |
|   integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
 | |
|   numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
 | |
|   indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| b64dec
 | |
|   Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
 | |
|   representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
 | |
|   For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
 | |
|   see "ub64dec".
 | |
| 
 | |
| base64
 | |
|   Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
 | |
|   transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
 | |
|   an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
 | |
|   Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool
 | |
|   Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
 | |
|   non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
 | |
|   used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
 | |
|   presence of a flag).
 | |
| 
 | |
| bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
 | |
|   Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
 | |
|   sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
 | |
|   optionally truncated at the given length.
 | |
| 
 | |
| concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
 | |
|   Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
 | |
|   a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
 | |
|   immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
 | |
|   second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
 | |
|   contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
 | |
|   <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
 | |
|   omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
 | |
|   appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
 | |
|   allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
 | |
|   variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
 | |
|   other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
 | |
|   parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
 | |
|   backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
 | |
|   level parser. See examples below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
 | |
|     tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn)  ssl_c_s_dn
 | |
|     tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
 | |
|     tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
 | |
|     http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| cpl
 | |
|   Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
 | |
|   (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| crc32([<avalanche>])
 | |
|   Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
 | |
|   hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
 | |
|   function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
 | |
|   converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
 | |
|   balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
 | |
|   provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
 | |
|   computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
 | |
|   found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
 | |
|   but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
 | |
|   not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
 | |
|   also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
| crc32c([<avalanche>])
 | |
|   Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
 | |
|   hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
 | |
|   function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
 | |
|   converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
 | |
|   It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
 | |
|   computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
 | |
|   not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
 | |
|   also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
| cut_crlf
 | |
|   Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
 | |
|   return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
 | |
|   updated.
 | |
| 
 | |
| da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
 | |
|   Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
 | |
|   input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
 | |
|   enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
 | |
|   keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
 | |
|   ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
 | |
|   configuration language.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     frontend www
 | |
|       bind *:8881
 | |
|       default_backend servers
 | |
|       http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
 | |
|   This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
 | |
|   and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
 | |
|   such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
 | |
|   checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
 | |
|   the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
 | |
|   command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
 | |
|   outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
 | |
|   the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
 | |
|   it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
 | |
|   printable sample types.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
 | |
| 
 | |
| digest(<algorithm>)
 | |
|   Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
 | |
|   sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
 | |
|   compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
 | |
| 
 | |
| div(<value>)
 | |
|   Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
 | |
|   result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
 | |
|   integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
 | |
|   variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
 | |
|   scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| djb2([<avalanche>])
 | |
|   Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
 | |
|   hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
 | |
|   function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
 | |
|   converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
 | |
|   balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
 | |
|   mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
 | |
|   collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
 | |
|   32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
 | |
|   and the "hash-type" directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
| even
 | |
|   Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
 | |
|   otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
 | |
| 
 | |
| field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
 | |
|   Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
 | |
|   (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
 | |
|   from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
 | |
|   formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
 | |
|   extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
 | |
|   fields.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|       str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_)    # f5
 | |
|       str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0)  # f2_f3__f5
 | |
|       str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2)  # f2_f3
 | |
|       str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
 | |
|       str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
 | |
| 
 | |
| fix_is_valid
 | |
|   Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
 | |
|   Information eXchange):
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
 | |
|     numeric
 | |
|   - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
 | |
|   - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
 | |
|   - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
 | |
|   - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
 | |
|     checksum
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
 | |
|   the server can be parsed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
 | |
|   message, false if not.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also the fix_tag_value converter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|       tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
 | |
|       tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
 | |
| 
 | |
| fix_tag_value(<tag>)
 | |
|   Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
 | |
|   from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
 | |
|   desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
 | |
|   are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
 | |
|   MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
 | |
|   added.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
 | |
|   the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
 | |
|   converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
 | |
|   fix_is_valid converter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also the fix_is_valid converter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|       tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
 | |
|       tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
 | |
|       # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
 | |
|       tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
 | |
|       tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
 | |
| 
 | |
| hex
 | |
|   Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
 | |
|   input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
 | |
|   in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
 | |
|   header).
 | |
| 
 | |
| hex2i
 | |
|   Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
 | |
|   integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
| htonl
 | |
|   Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
 | |
|   network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
 | |
|   this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
 | |
|   unsigned 32-bit integer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
 | |
|   Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
 | |
|   key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
 | |
|   registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
 | |
|   be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
 | |
|   compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
 | |
|   Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
 | |
|   representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
 | |
|   an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
 | |
|   conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
 | |
|   Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
 | |
|   Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
 | |
|   If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
 | |
|   "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
 | |
|   microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
 | |
|   input timestamp.
 | |
| 
 | |
| iif(<true>,<false>)
 | |
|   Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
 | |
|   string otherwise.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| in_table(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
 | |
|   the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
 | |
|   or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
 | |
| 
 | |
| ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
 | |
|   Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
 | |
|   This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
 | |
|   table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
 | |
|   dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
 | |
|   be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
 | |
|   If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
 | |
|   compatibility reasons.
 | |
| 
 | |
| json([<input-code>])
 | |
|   Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
 | |
|   JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
 | |
|   <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
 | |
|   "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
 | |
|   of errors:
 | |
|    - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
 | |
|      bytes, ...)
 | |
|    - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
 | |
|    - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
 | |
|   character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
 | |
|   only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
 | |
|   in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
 | |
|   "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
 | |
|   are :
 | |
|    - "ascii"  : never fails;
 | |
|    - "utf8"   : fails on any detected errors;
 | |
|    - "utf8s"  : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
 | |
|    - "utf8p"  : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
 | |
|                 error;
 | |
|    - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
 | |
|                 characters corresponding to the other errors.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
 | |
|   logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|      capture request header Host len 15
 | |
|      capture request header user-agent len 150
 | |
|      log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
 | |
|      GET / HTTP/1.0
 | |
|      User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Output log:
 | |
|      {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
 | |
| 
 | |
| json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
 | |
|   The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
 | |
|   number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
 | |
|   specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
 | |
|   Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
 | |
|   https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|      # get a integer value from the request body
 | |
|      # "{"integer":4}" => 5
 | |
|      http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # get a key with '.' in the name
 | |
|      # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
 | |
|      http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
 | |
|      http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
 | |
|      http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
 | |
| 
 | |
| language(<value>[,<default>])
 | |
|   Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
 | |
|   "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
 | |
|   q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
 | |
|   belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
 | |
|   argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
 | |
|   given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
 | |
|   names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
 | |
|   list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
 | |
|   The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
 | |
|   provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
 | |
|   ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
 | |
|   multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
 | |
|     # given language based on the request :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
 | |
|     acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
 | |
|     acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
 | |
|     use_backend spanish if es
 | |
|     use_backend french  if fr
 | |
|     use_backend english if en
 | |
|     default_backend choose_your_language
 | |
| 
 | |
| length
 | |
|   Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
 | |
|   sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
 | |
|   type. The result is of type integer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| lower
 | |
|   Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
 | |
|   sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
 | |
|   type. The result is of type string.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
 | |
|   Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
 | |
|   representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
 | |
|   string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
 | |
|   in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
 | |
|   (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
 | |
|   by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
 | |
|       # e.g.  20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
 | |
|       log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
 | |
| 
 | |
| ltrim(<chars>)
 | |
|   Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
 | |
|   representation of the input sample.
 | |
| 
 | |
| map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
 | |
| map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
 | |
| map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
 | |
|   Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
 | |
|   and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
 | |
|   input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
 | |
|   <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
 | |
|   acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
 | |
|   defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
 | |
|   "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
 | |
|   string to another string.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
 | |
|   strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
 | |
|   Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
 | |
|   input type, match type and output type.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
|     str      | str          | map_str         | map_str_int     | map_str_ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
|     str      | beg          | map_beg         | map_beg_int     | map_end_ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
|     str      | sub          | map_sub         | map_sub_int     | map_sub_ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
|     str      | dir          | map_dir         | map_dir_int     | map_dir_ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
|     str      | dom          | map_dom         | map_dom_int     | map_dom_ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
|     str      | end          | map_end         | map_end_int     | map_end_ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
|     str      | reg          | map_reg         | map_reg_int     | map_reg_ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
|     str      | reg          | map_regm        | map_reg_int     | map_reg_ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
|     int      | int          | map_int         | map_int_int     | map_int_ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
|     ip       | ip           | map_ip          | map_ip_int      | map_ip_ip
 | |
|   -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
 | |
|   expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
 | |
|   the corresponding match text.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
 | |
|   ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
 | |
|   is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
 | |
|   is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
 | |
|   trailing spaces/tabs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # this is a comment and is ignored
 | |
|         2.22.246.0/23    United Kingdom      \n
 | |
|      <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
 | |
|       |       |       |         |        `- trailing spaces ignored
 | |
|       |       |       |         `---------- value
 | |
|       |       |       `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
 | |
|       |       `---------------------------- key
 | |
|       `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
 | |
| 
 | |
| mod(<value>)
 | |
|   Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
 | |
|   remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
 | |
|   <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
 | |
|   starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
 | |
|   Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
 | |
|   <packettype>.
 | |
|   <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
 | |
|   value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
 | |
|   from.
 | |
|   Supported string and integers can be found here:
 | |
|   https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
 | |
|   https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
 | |
|   (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
 | |
|   <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
 | |
|   https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
 | |
|                     will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
 | |
|                     OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
 | |
|                     packets only):
 | |
|                        17: Session Expiry Interval
 | |
|                        33: Receive Maximum
 | |
|                        39: Maximum Packet Size
 | |
|                        34: Topic Alias Maximum
 | |
|                        25: Request Response Information
 | |
|                        23: Request Problem Information
 | |
|                        21: Authentication Method
 | |
|                        22: Authentication Data
 | |
|                        18: Will Delay Interval
 | |
|                         1: Payload Format Indicator
 | |
|                         2: Message Expiry Interval
 | |
|                         3: Content Type
 | |
|                         8: Response Topic
 | |
|                         9: Correlation Data
 | |
|                     Not supported yet:
 | |
|                        38: User Property
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
 | |
|                     OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
 | |
|                     packets only):
 | |
|                        17: Session Expiry Interval
 | |
|                        33: Receive Maximum
 | |
|                        36: Maximum QoS
 | |
|                        37: Retain Available
 | |
|                        39: Maximum Packet Size
 | |
|                        18: Assigned Client Identifier
 | |
|                        34: Topic Alias Maximum
 | |
|                        31: Reason String
 | |
|                        40; Wildcard Subscription Available
 | |
|                        41: Subscription Identifiers Available
 | |
|                        42: Shared Subscription Available
 | |
|                        19: Server Keep Alive
 | |
|                        26: Response Information
 | |
|                        28: Server Reference
 | |
|                        21: Authentication Method
 | |
|                        22: Authentication Data
 | |
|                     Not supported yet:
 | |
|                        38: User Property
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
 | |
|   the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
 | |
|   CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
 | |
|   client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|       acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
 | |
|       tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
 | |
|               req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
 | |
|               if data_in_buffer
 | |
|       # do the same as above
 | |
|       tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
 | |
|               req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
 | |
|               if data_in_buffer
 | |
| 
 | |
| mqtt_is_valid
 | |
|   Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
 | |
|   the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
 | |
|   CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
 | |
|   client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|       acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
 | |
|       tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
 | |
| 
 | |
| mul(<value>)
 | |
|   Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
 | |
|   the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
 | |
|   value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
 | |
|   <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
 | |
|   starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| nbsrv
 | |
|   Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
 | |
|   returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
 | |
|   where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
 | |
|   map lookup.
 | |
| 
 | |
| neg
 | |
|   Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
 | |
|   and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
 | |
|   is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
 | |
|   constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
 | |
| 
 | |
| not
 | |
|   Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
 | |
|   non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
 | |
|   used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
 | |
|   absence of a flag).
 | |
| 
 | |
| odd
 | |
|   Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
 | |
|   otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
 | |
| 
 | |
| or(<value>)
 | |
|   Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
 | |
|   integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
 | |
|   numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
 | |
|   indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
 | |
|   This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
 | |
|   sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
 | |
|   number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
 | |
|   if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
 | |
|   The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
 | |
|   "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
 | |
|   "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
 | |
|   "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
 | |
|   type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
 | |
|   More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
 | |
|   https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
 | |
| 
 | |
| regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
 | |
|   Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
 | |
|   operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
 | |
|   default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
 | |
|   largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
 | |
|   string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
 | |
|   the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
 | |
|   regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
 | |
|   string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
 | |
|   both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
 | |
|   The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
 | |
|   of characters with other ones.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
 | |
|   improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
 | |
|   with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
 | |
|   level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
 | |
|   second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
 | |
|   outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples:
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
 | |
|      # input:  x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
 | |
|      # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
 | |
|      http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
 | |
|      http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # capture groups and backreferences
 | |
|      # both lines do the same.
 | |
|      http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
 | |
|      http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture-req(<id>)
 | |
|   Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
 | |
|   is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
 | |
|             "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
 | |
|             "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture-res(<id>)
 | |
|   Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
 | |
|   is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
 | |
|             "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
 | |
|             "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
 | |
| 
 | |
| rtrim(<chars>)
 | |
|   Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
 | |
|   of the input sample.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sdbm([<avalanche>])
 | |
|   Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
 | |
|   hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
 | |
|   function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
 | |
|   converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
 | |
|   balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
 | |
|   mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
 | |
|   collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
 | |
|   32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
 | |
|   and the "hash-type" directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
| secure_memcmp(<var>)
 | |
|   Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
 | |
|   as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
 | |
|   match.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
 | |
|   performed in constant time.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
 | |
|   compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
| 
 | |
|      http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
 | |
|      # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
 | |
|      # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
 | |
|      acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
 | |
| 
 | |
| set-var(<var>)
 | |
|   Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
 | |
|   as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
 | |
|   the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
 | |
|              response),
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing,
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing.
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sha1
 | |
|   Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
 | |
|   sample with length of 20 bytes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sha2([<bits>])
 | |
|   Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
 | |
|   is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
 | |
|   SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
 | |
|   compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_queue
 | |
|   Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
 | |
|   format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
 | |
|   in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
 | |
|   cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
 | |
|   persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
 | |
| 
 | |
| strcmp(<var>)
 | |
|   Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
 | |
|   the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
 | |
|   are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
 | |
|   smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
 | |
|   than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
 | |
|   shorter).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
 | |
|   strings in constant time.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
| 
 | |
|      http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
 | |
|      # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
 | |
|      acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| sub(<value>)
 | |
|   Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
 | |
|   the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
 | |
|   a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
 | |
|   or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
 | |
|   its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
 | |
|              response),
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing,
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing.
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
 | |
|   bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
 | |
|   in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
 | |
|   sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
 | |
|   bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
 | |
|   in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
 | |
|   sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_conn_cnt(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
 | |
|   connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
 | |
|   also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_conn_cur(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
 | |
|   tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
 | |
|   See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_conn_rate(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
 | |
|   rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
 | |
|   sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_gpt0(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
 | |
|   general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
 | |
|   See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_gpc0(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
 | |
|   general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
 | |
|   table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
 | |
|   counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
 | |
|   with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
 | |
|   sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_gpc1(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
 | |
|   general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
 | |
|   table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
 | |
|   counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
 | |
|   with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
 | |
|   sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
 | |
|   errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
 | |
|   sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_http_err_rate(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
 | |
|   input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
 | |
|   period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
 | |
|   keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
 | |
|   failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
 | |
|   the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
 | |
|   input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
 | |
|   period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
 | |
|   keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
 | |
|   requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
 | |
|   the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_http_req_rate(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
 | |
|   input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
 | |
|   period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
 | |
|   keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_kbytes_in(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
 | |
|   to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
 | |
|   measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
 | |
|   which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
 | |
|   keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_kbytes_out(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
 | |
|   to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
 | |
|   measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
 | |
|   which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
 | |
|   keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_server_id(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
 | |
|   the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
 | |
|   sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
 | |
|   zero means that no server is associated with this key.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_sess_cnt(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
 | |
|   sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
 | |
|   a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
 | |
|   "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
 | |
|   keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_sess_rate(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
 | |
|   rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
 | |
|   session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
 | |
|   "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
 | |
|   keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_trackers(<table>)
 | |
|   Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
 | |
|   the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
 | |
|   is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
 | |
|   connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
 | |
|   table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
 | |
|   information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
 | |
|   returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
 | |
|   layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
 | |
|   connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
 | |
|   sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ub64dec
 | |
|   This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
 | |
|   encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
 | |
|   It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     # Decoding a JWT payload:
 | |
|     http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
 | |
| 
 | |
| ub64enc
 | |
|   This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
 | |
| 
 | |
| upper
 | |
|   Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
 | |
|   sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
 | |
|   type. The result is of type string.
 | |
| 
 | |
| url_dec([<in_form>])
 | |
|   Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
 | |
|   as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
 | |
|   argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
 | |
|   be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
 | |
|   space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
 | |
|   a query string ('?').
 | |
| 
 | |
| url_enc([<enc_type>])
 | |
|   Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
 | |
|   The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
 | |
|   is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
 | |
|   optional argument is here for future changes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
 | |
|   This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
 | |
|   sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
 | |
|   (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
 | |
|   field is present.
 | |
|   The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
 | |
|   "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
 | |
|   "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
 | |
|   "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
 | |
|   type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
 | |
|   More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
 | |
|   https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|     // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
 | |
|     // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
 | |
| 
 | |
|     message Point {
 | |
|       int32 latitude = 1;
 | |
|       int32 longitude = 2;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     message PPoint {
 | |
|       Point point = 59;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     message Rectangle {
 | |
|       // One corner of the rectangle.
 | |
|       PPoint lo = 48;
 | |
|       // The other corner of the rectangle.
 | |
|       PPoint hi = 49;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
 | |
|   protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
 | |
|   extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
 | |
|     req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
 | |
|     req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
 | |
|     req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
 | |
| 
 | |
|   We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
 | |
|   messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
 | |
|   could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
 | |
|     req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
 | |
|     req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
 | |
|   "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
 | |
|   interpret the previous binary sample.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| unset-var(<var>)
 | |
|   Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
 | |
|   starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
 | |
|              response),
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing,
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing.
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| utime(<format>[,<offset>])
 | |
|   Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
 | |
|   representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
 | |
|   string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
 | |
|   in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
 | |
|   (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
 | |
|   by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
| 
 | |
|       # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
 | |
|       # e.g.  20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
 | |
|       log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
 | |
| 
 | |
| word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
 | |
|   Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
 | |
|   the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
 | |
|   Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
 | |
|   Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
 | |
|   Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
 | |
|   Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|       str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_)    # f5
 | |
|       str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0)  # f2_f3__f5
 | |
|       str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2)  # f3__f5
 | |
|       str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
 | |
|       str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
 | |
|       str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/)    # f1
 | |
| 
 | |
| wt6([<avalanche>])
 | |
|   Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
 | |
|   hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
 | |
|   function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
 | |
|   converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
 | |
|   balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
 | |
|   mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
 | |
|   collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
 | |
|   32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
 | |
|   and the "hash-type" directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
| xor(<value>)
 | |
|   Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
 | |
|   of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
 | |
|   <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
 | |
|   starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
 | |
|              response),
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing,
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing.
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| xxh3([<seed>])
 | |
|   Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
 | |
|   64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
 | |
|   defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
 | |
|   This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
 | |
|   URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
 | |
|   with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
 | |
|   considered as cryptographically secure.
 | |
| 
 | |
| xxh32([<seed>])
 | |
|   Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
 | |
|   variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
 | |
|   to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
 | |
|   is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
 | |
|   URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
 | |
|   collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
 | |
|   as cryptographically secure.
 | |
| 
 | |
| xxh64([<seed>])
 | |
|   Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
 | |
|   variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
 | |
|   to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
 | |
|   is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
 | |
|   URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
 | |
|   collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
 | |
|   as cryptographically secure.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
 | |
| --------------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
 | |
| not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
 | |
| "monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
 | |
| The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
 | |
| 
 | |
| always_false : boolean
 | |
|   Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
 | |
|   temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
 | |
| 
 | |
| always_true : boolean
 | |
|   Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
 | |
|   temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
 | |
| 
 | |
| avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
 | |
|   divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
 | |
|   backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
 | |
|   the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
 | |
|   time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
 | |
|   ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
 | |
|   a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
 | |
|   they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
 | |
|   the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
 | |
|   server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
 | |
|   the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
 | |
|   back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
 | |
|   if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
 | |
|   sample fetches.
 | |
| 
 | |
| be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
 | |
|   Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
 | |
|   possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
 | |
|   specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
 | |
|   backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
 | |
|   See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
 | |
| 
 | |
| be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
 | |
|   across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
 | |
|   servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
 | |
|   backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
 | |
|   to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
 | |
|   nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
 | |
|   criteria.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
 | |
|   (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
 | |
|   case the value returned will be -1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
 | |
|   backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
 | |
|   switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
 | |
|   high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
 | |
|   online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
 | |
|   log-format directive.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
 | |
|         backend dynamic
 | |
|             mode http
 | |
|             acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
 | |
|             redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
 | |
| 
 | |
| bin(<hex>) : bin
 | |
|   Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
 | |
|   of the string.
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool(<bool>) : bool
 | |
|   Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
 | |
|   'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
 | |
| 
 | |
| connslots([<backend>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
 | |
|   still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
 | |
|   connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
 | |
|   used with ACLs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
 | |
|   still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
 | |
|   usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
 | |
|   available server queue slots.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
 | |
|   useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
 | |
|   multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
 | |
|   you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
 | |
|   available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
 | |
|   actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
 | |
|   available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
 | |
|   of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
 | |
|   then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
 | |
|   will be -1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| cpu_calls : integer
 | |
|   Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
 | |
|   request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
 | |
|   the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
 | |
|   low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
 | |
|   high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
 | |
|   is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| cpu_ns_avg : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
 | |
|   processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
 | |
|   request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
 | |
|   indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
 | |
|   each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
 | |
|   automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
 | |
|   and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
 | |
|   like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
 | |
|   affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
 | |
|   faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
 | |
|   Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
 | |
| 
 | |
| cpu_ns_tot : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
 | |
|   processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
 | |
|   request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
 | |
|   indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
 | |
|   each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
 | |
|   automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
 | |
|   induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
 | |
|   response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
 | |
|   heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
 | |
|   logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
 | |
|   to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
 | |
|   high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
 | |
|   this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
| date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
 | |
|   returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
 | |
|   as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
 | |
|   It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
 | |
|   "ms" for  milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
 | |
|   If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
 | |
|   milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
 | |
|   It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
 | |
|      http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
 | |
|      # millisecond granularity
 | |
|      http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| date_us : integer
 | |
|   Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
 | |
|   date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
 | |
|   from the same timeval structure.
 | |
| 
 | |
| distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
 | |
|   Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
 | |
|   of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
 | |
|   match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
 | |
|   used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
 | |
|   HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
 | |
|   list of supported tokens.
 | |
| 
 | |
| distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
 | |
|   Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
 | |
|   #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
 | |
|   any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
 | |
|   can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
 | |
|   file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
 | |
|   Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
 | |
|   contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
 | |
|   Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
 | |
|   supported tokens.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|       # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
 | |
|       tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
 | |
|       tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
 | |
|       # send large files to the big farm
 | |
|       use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
 | |
| 
 | |
| env(<name>) : string
 | |
|   Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
 | |
|   reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
 | |
|   process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
 | |
|   server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
 | |
|   certain way.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|       # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
 | |
|       http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
 | |
| 
 | |
|       # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
 | |
|       http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
 | |
| 
 | |
| fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
 | |
|   possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
 | |
|   specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
 | |
|   frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
 | |
|   use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
 | |
|   full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
 | |
|   statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
 | |
|   "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
 | |
|   second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
 | |
|   situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
 | |
|   frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
 | |
|   limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
 | |
|   abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
 | |
|   layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
 | |
|   down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
 | |
|   a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
 | |
|   in frontends.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
 | |
|         # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
 | |
|         # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
 | |
|         # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
 | |
|         frontend mail
 | |
|             bind :25
 | |
|             mode tcp
 | |
|             maxconn 100
 | |
|             acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
 | |
|             tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
 | |
|             tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
 | |
|             tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
 | |
| 
 | |
| hostname : string
 | |
|   Returns the system hostname.
 | |
| 
 | |
| int(<integer>) : signed integer
 | |
|   Returns a signed integer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
 | |
|   Returns an ipv4.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
 | |
|   Returns an ipv6.
 | |
| 
 | |
| lat_ns_avg : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
 | |
|   handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
 | |
|   number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
 | |
|   keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
 | |
|   request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
 | |
|   indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
 | |
|   the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
 | |
|   "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
 | |
|   once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
 | |
|   the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
 | |
|   latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
 | |
|   requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
 | |
|   processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
 | |
|   be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
 | |
|   exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
 | |
| 
 | |
| lat_ns_tot : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
 | |
|   handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
 | |
|   number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
 | |
|   keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
 | |
|   request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
 | |
|   indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
 | |
|   the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
 | |
|   "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
 | |
|   once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
 | |
|   the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
 | |
|   latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
 | |
|   requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
 | |
|   processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
 | |
|   be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
 | |
|   may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
 | |
|   almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
 | |
|   continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
 | |
|   may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
 | |
|   processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
 | |
|   lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
 | |
| 
 | |
| meth(<method>) : method
 | |
|   Returns a method.
 | |
| 
 | |
| nbproc : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
 | |
|   started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
 | |
|   and debugging purposes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
 | |
|   either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
 | |
|   ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
 | |
|   switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
 | |
|   to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
 | |
|   "monitor fail".
 | |
| 
 | |
| prio_class : integer
 | |
|   Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
 | |
|   for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
 | |
|   set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
 | |
| 
 | |
| prio_offset : integer
 | |
|   Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
 | |
|   connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
 | |
|   "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
 | |
|   set-priority-offset".
 | |
| 
 | |
| proc : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
 | |
|   the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
 | |
|   debugging purposes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| queue([<backend>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
 | |
|   including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
 | |
|   specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
 | |
|   one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
 | |
|   can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
 | |
|   indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
 | |
|   possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
 | |
|   also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
 | |
| 
 | |
| rand([<range>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
 | |
|   starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
 | |
|   gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
 | |
|   needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
 | |
|   purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| uuid([<version>]) : string
 | |
|   Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
 | |
|   specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
 | |
|   Currently, only version 4 is supported.
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
 | |
|   connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
 | |
|   evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
 | |
|   current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
 | |
|   full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
 | |
|   connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
 | |
|   "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
 | |
|   on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
 | |
|   The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
 | |
|   server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
 | |
|   farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
 | |
|   number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
 | |
|   "srv_conn" fetch methods.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
 | |
|   does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
 | |
|   DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
 | |
|   looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
 | |
|   an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
 | |
|   availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
 | |
|   using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
 | |
|   the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
 | |
|   pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
 | |
|   server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
 | |
|   with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
 | |
|   is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
 | |
|   fetch methods.
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
 | |
|   designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
 | |
|   omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
 | |
|   used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
 | |
|   alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
 | |
|   rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
 | |
|   overloading servers).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         # Redirect to a separate back
 | |
|         acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
 | |
|         acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
 | |
|         use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
 | |
|   is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
 | |
|   "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
 | |
|   <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
 | |
|   backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
 | |
|   weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
 | |
|   backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
 | |
| 
 | |
| stopping : boolean
 | |
|   Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
 | |
|   can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
 | |
|   certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
 | |
| 
 | |
| str(<string>) : string
 | |
|   Returns a string.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_avl([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
 | |
|   stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
 | |
| 
 | |
| table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
 | |
|   stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
 | |
|   table_avl for other entry counting methods.
 | |
| 
 | |
| thread : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
 | |
|   the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
 | |
|   and debugging purposes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| var(<var-name>) : undefined
 | |
|   Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
 | |
|   sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
 | |
|   about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
 | |
|     "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
 | |
|     "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
 | |
|     "txn"  : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
 | |
|              response),
 | |
|     "req"  : the variable is shared only during request processing,
 | |
|     "res"  : the variable is shared only during response processing.
 | |
|   This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
 | |
|   contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
 | |
| ----------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
 | |
| closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
 | |
| methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
 | |
| sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
 | |
| TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
 | |
| the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
 | |
| counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
 | |
| "sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
 | |
| used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
 | |
| can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
 | |
| Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
 | |
| table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
 | |
| tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
 | |
| currently being tracked.
 | |
| 
 | |
| bc_dst : ip
 | |
|   This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
 | |
|   which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
 | |
|   on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.  On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
 | |
|   IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
 | |
| 
 | |
| bc_dst_port : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
 | |
|   connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
 | |
| 
 | |
| bc_http_major : integer
 | |
|   Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
 | |
|   for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
 | |
|   encoding and not the version present in the request header.
 | |
| 
 | |
| bc_src : ip
 | |
|   This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
 | |
|   the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
 | |
|   IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
 | |
|   equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
 | |
| 
 | |
| bc_src_port : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
 | |
|   connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
 | |
| 
 | |
| be_id : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
 | |
|   frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
 | |
|   also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| be_name : string
 | |
|   Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
 | |
|   frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
 | |
|   also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| be_server_timeout : integer
 | |
|   Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
 | |
|   current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
 | |
|   also the "cur_server_timeout".
 | |
| 
 | |
| be_tunnel_timeout : integer
 | |
|   Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
 | |
|   current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
 | |
|   also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
 | |
| 
 | |
| cur_server_timeout : integer
 | |
|   Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
 | |
|   In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
 | |
|   "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
 | |
| 
 | |
| cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
 | |
|   Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
 | |
|   In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
 | |
|   "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
 | |
| 
 | |
| dst : ip
 | |
|   This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
 | |
|   which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
 | |
|   in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
 | |
|   On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
 | |
|   RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
 | |
|   redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
 | |
|   before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
 | |
|   destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
 | |
|   is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
 | |
|   what is believed to be the source and the destination.
 | |
| 
 | |
| dst_conn : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
 | |
|   connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
 | |
|   normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
 | |
|   servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
 | |
|   page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
 | |
|   when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
 | |
|   different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
 | |
|   "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
 | |
| 
 | |
| dst_is_local : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
 | |
|   to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
 | |
|   that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
 | |
|   certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
 | |
|   targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
 | |
|   be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
 | |
|   Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
 | |
|   it only once per connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
| dst_port : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
 | |
|   connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
 | |
|   This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
 | |
|   ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
 | |
|   a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
 | |
|   an HTTP header.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_http_major : integer
 | |
|   Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
 | |
|   for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
 | |
|   encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_pp_authority : string
 | |
|   Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
 | |
|   if any.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_pp_unique_id : string
 | |
|   Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
 | |
|   if any.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
 | |
|   header.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
 | |
|   connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
 | |
|   can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
 | |
|   connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
 | |
|   operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
 | |
|   2.4, the sample fetch fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
 | |
|   client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
 | |
|   <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
 | |
|   server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
 | |
|   operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
 | |
|   2.4, the sample fetch fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_unacked : integer
 | |
|   Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
 | |
|   If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
 | |
|   if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
 | |
|   before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_sacked : integer
 | |
|   Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
 | |
|   If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
 | |
|   if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
 | |
|   before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_retrans : integer
 | |
|   Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
 | |
|   connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
 | |
|   not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
 | |
|   Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_fackets : integer
 | |
|   Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
 | |
|   connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
 | |
|   not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
 | |
|   Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_lost : integer
 | |
|   Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
 | |
|   connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
 | |
|   not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
 | |
|   Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fc_reordering : integer
 | |
|   Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
 | |
|   connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
 | |
|   not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
 | |
|   Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fe_defbe : string
 | |
|   Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
 | |
|   used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fe_id : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
 | |
|   backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
 | |
|   coming via a same frontend to the same server.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fe_name : string
 | |
|   Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
 | |
|   backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
 | |
|   coming via a same frontend to the same server.
 | |
| 
 | |
| fe_client_timeout : integer
 | |
|   Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
 | |
|   current frontend.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
 | |
|   counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
 | |
|   table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
 | |
|   counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
 | |
|   table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
 | |
|   counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
 | |
|   stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
 | |
|   typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
 | |
|   when a first ACL was verified :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
 | |
|         # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
 | |
|         acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
 | |
|         acl kill  sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
 | |
|         acl save  sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
 | |
|         tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
 | |
|         tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
 | |
|   counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
 | |
|   stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
 | |
|   typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
 | |
|   when a first ACL was verified.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
 | |
|   counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
 | |
|   tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
 | |
|   begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
 | |
|   measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
 | |
|   See also src_conn_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
 | |
|   currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
 | |
|   currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
 | |
|   currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
 | |
|   associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
 | |
|   which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
 | |
|   src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
 | |
|   that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
 | |
|   be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
 | |
|   associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
 | |
|   which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
 | |
|   src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
 | |
|   that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
 | |
|   be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
 | |
|   counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
 | |
|   See also src_http_err_cnt.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
 | |
|   measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
 | |
|   includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
 | |
|   src_http_err_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
 | |
|   tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
 | |
|   other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
 | |
|   counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
 | |
|   table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
 | |
|   501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
 | |
|   counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
 | |
|   src_http_req_cnt.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
 | |
|   counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
 | |
|   the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
 | |
|   src_http_req_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
 | |
|   tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
 | |
|   the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
 | |
|   return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
 | |
|   to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
 | |
|         acl kill  sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
 | |
|         tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
 | |
|   tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
 | |
|   the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
 | |
|   return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
 | |
|   to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
 | |
|   counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
 | |
|   integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
 | |
|   counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
 | |
|   integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
 | |
|   into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
 | |
|   connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
 | |
|   more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
 | |
|   backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
 | |
|   with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
 | |
|   measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
 | |
|   session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
 | |
|   rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
 | |
|   connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
 | |
|   performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
 | |
| sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
 | |
| sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
 | |
| sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
 | |
|   the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
 | |
|   to set some values in a header passed to the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
| sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
 | |
| sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
 | |
|   tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
 | |
|   begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
 | |
|   that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
 | |
|   count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
 | |
|   may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
 | |
|   server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
 | |
|   example.
 | |
| 
 | |
| so_id : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
 | |
|   in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
 | |
|   same socket to the same server.
 | |
| 
 | |
| so_name : string
 | |
|   Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
 | |
|   with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
 | |
|   strings instead of integers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src : ip
 | |
|   This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
 | |
|   IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
 | |
|   mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
 | |
|   TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
 | |
|   behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
 | |
|   directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
 | |
|   PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
 | |
|   "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
 | |
|   connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
 | |
|   connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
 | |
|   will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
 | |
|   appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
 | |
|   response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
 | |
|   the source and the destination.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|        # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
 | |
|        http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
 | |
|   in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
 | |
|   in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
 | |
|   not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
 | |
|   the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
 | |
|   amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
 | |
|   not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
 | |
|   connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
 | |
|   designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
 | |
|   found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
 | |
|   second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
 | |
|   was verified :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
 | |
|         # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
 | |
|         acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
 | |
|         acl kill  src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
 | |
|         acl save  src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
 | |
|         tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
 | |
|         tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
 | |
|   connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
 | |
|   designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
 | |
|   found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
 | |
|   second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
 | |
|   was verified.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
 | |
|   incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
 | |
|   the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
 | |
|   See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
 | |
|   current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
 | |
|   stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
 | |
|   zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
 | |
|   address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
 | |
|   measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
 | |
|   the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
 | |
|   incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
 | |
|   the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
 | |
|   See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
 | |
|   incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
 | |
|   the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
 | |
|   See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
 | |
|   incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
 | |
|   the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
 | |
|   See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
 | |
|   associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
 | |
|   stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
 | |
|   which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
 | |
|   sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
 | |
|   that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
 | |
|   be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
 | |
|   associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
 | |
|   stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
 | |
|   which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
 | |
|   sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
 | |
|   that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
 | |
|   be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
 | |
|   source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
 | |
|   stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
 | |
|   See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
 | |
|   returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
 | |
|   address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
 | |
|   measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
 | |
|   includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
 | |
|   not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
 | |
|   incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
 | |
|   the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
 | |
|   status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
 | |
|   If the address is not found, zero is returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
 | |
|   connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
 | |
|   designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
 | |
|   configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
 | |
|   status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
 | |
|   returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
 | |
|   source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
 | |
|   table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
 | |
|   not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
 | |
|   source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
 | |
|   table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
 | |
|   table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
 | |
|   not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
 | |
|   connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
 | |
|   designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
 | |
|   found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
 | |
|   This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
 | |
|   connection when a first ACL was verified :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
 | |
|         acl kill  src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
 | |
|         tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
 | |
|   connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
 | |
|   designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
 | |
|   found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
 | |
|   This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
 | |
|   connection when a first ACL was verified.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_is_local : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
 | |
|   system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
 | |
|   comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
 | |
|   It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
 | |
|   client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
 | |
|   note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
 | |
|   once per connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
 | |
|   source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
 | |
|   stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
 | |
|   returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
 | |
|   values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
 | |
|   address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
 | |
|   measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
 | |
|   test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
 | |
|   terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_port : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
 | |
|   connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
 | |
|   Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
 | |
|   about source ports nowadays.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
 | |
|   connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
 | |
|   designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
 | |
|   they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
 | |
|   is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
 | |
|   address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
 | |
|   measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
 | |
|   session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
 | |
|   address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
 | |
|   Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
 | |
|   address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
 | |
|   This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
 | |
|   the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
 | |
|   expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
 | |
|   can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
 | |
|   source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
 | |
|   actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
 | |
|         # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
 | |
|         # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
 | |
|         listen ssh
 | |
|             bind :22
 | |
|             mode tcp
 | |
|             maxconn 100
 | |
|             stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
 | |
|             tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
 | |
|             server local 127.0.0.1:22
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_id : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
 | |
|   While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
 | |
|   debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| srv_name : string
 | |
|   Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
 | |
|   While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
 | |
|   debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
 | |
| ----------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
 | |
| closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
 | |
| when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
 | |
| usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
 | |
| future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 51d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
 | |
|   Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
 | |
|   separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
 | |
|   The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
 | |
|   request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
 | |
|   property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
 | |
|     # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
 | |
|     # the request.
 | |
|     frontend http-in
 | |
|       bind *:8081
 | |
|       default_backend servers
 | |
|       http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
 | |
|         %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
 | |
|   layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
 | |
|   other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
 | |
|   http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
 | |
|   Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
 | |
|   connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
 | |
|   tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_alpn : string
 | |
|   This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
 | |
|   outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
 | |
|   The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
 | |
|   server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
 | |
|   extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
 | |
|   not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
 | |
|   protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
 | |
|   list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
 | |
|   replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
 | |
|   tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_cipher : string
 | |
|   Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
 | |
|   over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
 | |
|   http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_client_random : binary
 | |
|   Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
 | |
|   was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
 | |
|   sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
 | |
|   It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
 | |
|   layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
 | |
|   session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
 | |
|   ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_npn : string
 | |
|   This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
 | |
|   made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
 | |
|   protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
 | |
|   built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
 | |
|   the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
 | |
|   "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
 | |
|   pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
 | |
|   the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
 | |
|   or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_protocol : string
 | |
|   Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
 | |
|   over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
 | |
|   http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
 | |
|   When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
 | |
|   can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
 | |
|   can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_server_random : binary
 | |
|   Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
 | |
|   was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
 | |
|   sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
 | |
|   It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_session_id : binary
 | |
|   Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
 | |
|   made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
 | |
|   if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
 | |
|   ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_session_key : binary
 | |
|   Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
 | |
|   connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
 | |
|   traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
 | |
|   BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
 | |
|   Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
 | |
|   connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
 | |
|   tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_ca_err : integer
 | |
|   When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
 | |
|   certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
 | |
|   verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
 | |
|   find the exhaustive list of error codes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
 | |
|   When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
 | |
|   verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
 | |
|   returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_chain_der : binary
 | |
|   Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
 | |
|   incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
 | |
|   an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
 | |
|   can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
 | |
|   does not support resumed sessions.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_der : binary
 | |
|   Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
 | |
|   incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
 | |
|   an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_err : integer
 | |
|   When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
 | |
|   0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
 | |
|   to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
 | |
|   codes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
 | |
|   When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
 | |
|   presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
 | |
|   first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
 | |
|   occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
 | |
|   the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
 | |
|   For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
 | |
|   "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
 | |
|   The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
 | |
|   consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
 | |
|   LDAP v3.
 | |
|   If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
 | |
|   and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_key_alg : string
 | |
|   Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
 | |
|   presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_notafter : string
 | |
|   Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
 | |
|   YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_notbefore : string
 | |
|   Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
 | |
|   YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
 | |
|   When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
 | |
|   presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
 | |
|   first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
 | |
|   occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
 | |
|   the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
 | |
|   For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
 | |
|   "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
 | |
|   The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
 | |
|   consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
 | |
|   LDAP v3.
 | |
|   If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
 | |
|   and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_serial : binary
 | |
|   Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
 | |
|   incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
 | |
|   an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_sha1 : binary
 | |
|   Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
 | |
|   the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
 | |
|   used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
 | |
|   Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
 | |
|   server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|      http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_sig_alg : string
 | |
|   Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
 | |
|   the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
 | |
|   layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_used : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
 | |
|   connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_verify : integer
 | |
|   Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
 | |
|   an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
 | |
|   refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
 | |
|   codes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_c_version : integer
 | |
|   Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
 | |
|   incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_f_der : binary
 | |
|   Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
 | |
|   incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
 | |
|   an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
 | |
|   When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
 | |
|   presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
 | |
|   first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
 | |
|   occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
 | |
|   the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
 | |
|   For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
 | |
|   "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
 | |
|   The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
 | |
|   consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
 | |
|   LDAP v3.
 | |
|   If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
 | |
|   and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_f_key_alg : string
 | |
|   Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
 | |
|   presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
 | |
|   SSL/TLS transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_f_notafter : string
 | |
|   Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
 | |
|   YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_f_notbefore : string
 | |
|   Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
 | |
|   YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
 | |
|   When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
 | |
|   presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
 | |
|   first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
 | |
|   occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
 | |
|   the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
 | |
|   For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
 | |
|   "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
 | |
|   The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
 | |
|   consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
 | |
|   LDAP v3.
 | |
|   If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
 | |
|   and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_f_serial : binary
 | |
|   Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
 | |
|   incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
 | |
|   an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_f_sha1 : binary
 | |
|   Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
 | |
|   when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
 | |
|   can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_f_sig_alg : string
 | |
|   Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
 | |
|   the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
 | |
|   layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_f_version : integer
 | |
|   Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
 | |
|   incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
 | |
|   layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
 | |
|   with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
 | |
|         listen http-https
 | |
|             bind :80
 | |
|             bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
 | |
|             http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
 | |
|   Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
 | |
|   connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_alpn : string
 | |
|   This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
 | |
|   incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
 | |
|   HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
 | |
|   the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
 | |
|   extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
 | |
|   not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
 | |
|   protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
 | |
|   list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
 | |
|   replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_cipher : string
 | |
|   Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
 | |
|   over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
 | |
|   Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
 | |
|   value length is according with the value of
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
 | |
|   Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
 | |
|   hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
 | |
|   Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
 | |
|   number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
 | |
|   available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
 | |
|   sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
 | |
|   Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
 | |
|   take in account all the data of the cipher list.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_client_random : binary
 | |
|   Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
 | |
|   was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
 | |
|   sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
 | |
|   Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
 | |
|   front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
|   Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
 | |
|   keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
 | |
|   activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.keylog"
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
 | |
|   Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
 | |
|   front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
|   Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
 | |
|   keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
 | |
|   activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.keylog"
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
 | |
|   Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
 | |
|   front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
|   Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
 | |
|   keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
 | |
|   activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.keylog"
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
 | |
|   Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
 | |
|   front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
|   Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
 | |
|   keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
 | |
|   activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.keylog"
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
 | |
|   Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
 | |
|   front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
|   Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
 | |
|   keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
 | |
|   activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.keylog"
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
 | |
|   SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
 | |
|   Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
 | |
|   certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
 | |
|   from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
 | |
|   current SSL session uses a client certificate.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
 | |
|   it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
 | |
|   wait until the handshake happened.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
 | |
|   This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
 | |
|   in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
 | |
|   true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
 | |
|   that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
 | |
|   haproxy -vv).
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
 | |
|   SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_npn : string
 | |
|   This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
 | |
|   made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
 | |
|   is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
 | |
|   library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
 | |
|   haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
 | |
|   "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
 | |
|   forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
 | |
|   requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_protocol : string
 | |
|   Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
 | |
|   over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
 | |
|   When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
 | |
|   can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
 | |
|   Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
 | |
|   front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
|   Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
 | |
|   keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
 | |
|   activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.keylog"
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
 | |
|   Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
 | |
|   front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
|   Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
 | |
|   keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
 | |
|   activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
 | |
|   "tune.ssl.keylog"
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_server_random : binary
 | |
|   Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
 | |
|   was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
 | |
|   sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_session_id : binary
 | |
|   Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
 | |
|   made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
 | |
|   a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
 | |
|   every few minutes.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_session_key : binary
 | |
|   Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
 | |
|   connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
 | |
|   traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
 | |
|   BoringSSL.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_sni : string
 | |
|   This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
 | |
|   incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
 | |
|   deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
 | |
|   matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
 | |
|   been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
 | |
|   connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
 | |
|   forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
 | |
|   requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
 | |
|   enabled (check haproxy -vv).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
 | |
|     ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
 | |
|   Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
 | |
|   connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_der : binary
 | |
|   Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
 | |
|   outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
 | |
|   an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_chain_der : binary
 | |
|   Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
 | |
|   outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
 | |
|   an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
 | |
|   can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
 | |
|   does not support resumed sessions.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_key_alg : string
 | |
|   Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
 | |
|   presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
 | |
|   SSL/TLS transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_notafter : string
 | |
|   Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
 | |
|   YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_notbefore : string
 | |
|   Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
 | |
|   YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
 | |
|   transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
 | |
|   When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
 | |
|   presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
 | |
|   first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
 | |
|   occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
 | |
|   the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
 | |
|   For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
 | |
|   "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
 | |
|   The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
 | |
|   consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
 | |
|   LDAP v3.
 | |
|   If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
 | |
|   and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
 | |
|   When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
 | |
|   returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
 | |
|   presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
 | |
|   first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
 | |
|   occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
 | |
|   the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
 | |
|   For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
 | |
|   "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
 | |
|   The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
 | |
|   consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
 | |
|   LDAP v3.
 | |
|   If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
 | |
|   and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_serial : binary
 | |
|   Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
 | |
|   outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
 | |
|   an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_sha1 : binary
 | |
|   Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
 | |
|   when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
 | |
|   can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_sig_alg : string
 | |
|   Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
 | |
|   the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
 | |
|   layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ssl_s_version : integer
 | |
|   Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
 | |
|   outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
 | |
| ------------------------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
 | |
| sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
 | |
| only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
 | |
| For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
 | |
| be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
 | |
| can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
 | |
| sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
 | |
| for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
 | |
| content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
 | |
|           only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
 | |
|           HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
 | |
|           these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
 | |
|           one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
 | |
|           all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
 | |
|           sample expression). So be careful.
 | |
| 
 | |
| payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
 | |
|   This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
 | |
|   "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
 | |
|   a response such as in "stick store response".
 | |
| 
 | |
| payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
 | |
|   This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
 | |
|   (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
 | |
|   context of a response such as in "stick store response".
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.len : integer
 | |
| req_len : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
 | |
|   request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
 | |
|   that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
 | |
|   means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
 | |
|   at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
 | |
|   that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
 | |
|   more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
 | |
|   content inspection.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
 | |
|   This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
 | |
|   in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
 | |
|   the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
 | |
|   with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
 | |
|   any location.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL alternatives :
 | |
|     payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
 | |
|   This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
 | |
|   bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
 | |
|   the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
 | |
|   prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL alternatives :
 | |
|     payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.proto_http : boolean
 | |
| req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
 | |
|   parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
 | |
|   is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
 | |
|   request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
 | |
|   protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
 | |
|   until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
 | |
|   a header.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
|         # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
 | |
|         tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
 | |
|         tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
 | |
|         tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
 | |
| rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
 | |
|   When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
 | |
|   <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
 | |
|   cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
 | |
|   case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
 | |
|   contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
 | |
|   configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
 | |
|   session stickiness to servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
 | |
|   used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
 | |
|   a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
 | |
|   such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
 | |
|   distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
 | |
|   rdp-cookie".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|    listen tse-farm
 | |
|        bind 0.0.0.0:3389
 | |
|        # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
 | |
|        tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
 | |
|        tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
 | |
|        # apply RDP cookie persistence
 | |
|        persist rdp-cookie
 | |
|        # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
 | |
|        # This is only useful makes sense if
 | |
|        # balance rdp-cookie is not used
 | |
|        stick-table type string size 204800
 | |
|        stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
 | |
|        server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
 | |
|        server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
 | |
|   "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
 | |
| rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
 | |
|   corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
 | |
|   is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
 | |
|   used in ACL.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.ssl_alpn : string
 | |
|   Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
 | |
|   Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
 | |
|   ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
 | |
|   request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
 | |
|   this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
 | |
|   in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
 | |
|   client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|      # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
 | |
|      tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
 | |
|      tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
 | |
|      use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
 | |
|      default_backend bk_default
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
 | |
|   Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
 | |
|   Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
 | |
|   message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
 | |
|   certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
 | |
|   this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
 | |
|   contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
 | |
|   lines having the "ssl" option.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.ssl_hello_type : integer
 | |
| req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
 | |
|   in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
 | |
|   SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
 | |
|   contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
 | |
|   SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
 | |
|   option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
 | |
|   that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.ssl_sni : string
 | |
| req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
 | |
|   by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
 | |
|   contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
 | |
|   message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
 | |
|   buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
 | |
|   work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
 | |
|   implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
 | |
|   however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
 | |
|   or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
 | |
|   connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
 | |
|   to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
 | |
|   be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
 | |
|   it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
 | |
|   the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     req_ssl_sni : exact string match
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|      # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
 | |
|      tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
 | |
|      tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
 | |
|      use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
 | |
|      default_backend bk_sorry_page
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.ssl_st_ext : integer
 | |
|   Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
 | |
|   Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
 | |
|   Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
 | |
|   Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
 | |
|   not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
 | |
|   "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
 | |
|   whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
 | |
|   no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
 | |
|   side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.ssl_ver : integer
 | |
| req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
 | |
|   stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
 | |
|   messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
 | |
|   composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
 | |
|   version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
 | |
|   buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
 | |
|   work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
 | |
|   matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
 | |
|   fetch is mostly used in ACL.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     req_ssl_ver : decimal match
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.len : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
 | |
|   response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
 | |
|   that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
 | |
|   means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
 | |
|   at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
 | |
|   that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
 | |
|   more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
 | |
|   content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
 | |
|   This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
 | |
|   in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
 | |
|   the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
 | |
|   with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
 | |
|   any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
 | |
|   This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
 | |
|   bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
 | |
|   the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
 | |
|   if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
 | |
|   expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.ssl_hello_type : integer
 | |
| rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
 | |
|   in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
 | |
|   SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
 | |
|   contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
 | |
|   SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
 | |
|   option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
 | |
|   that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
 | |
| 
 | |
| wait_end : boolean
 | |
|   This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
 | |
|   not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
 | |
|   avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
 | |
|   actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
 | |
|   stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
 | |
|   use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
 | |
|   "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
 | |
|   to be used with TCP request content inspection.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|      # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
 | |
|      tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
 | |
|      tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
 | |
| 
 | |
|      # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
 | |
|      tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
 | |
|      acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
 | |
|      acl badguys  src 10.0.1.0/24
 | |
|      tcp-request content accept if goodguys
 | |
|      tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
 | |
|      tcp-request content reject
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
 | |
| --------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
 | |
| This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
 | |
| data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
 | |
| its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
 | |
| HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
 | |
| content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
 | |
| to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
 | |
| more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
 | |
| response are indexed.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
 | |
|        will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
 | |
|        without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
 | |
|        HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
 | |
|        to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
 | |
|        fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
 | |
|        they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
| base : string
 | |
|   This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
 | |
|   the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
 | |
|   mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
 | |
|   well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
 | |
|   stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
 | |
|   requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
 | |
|   switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
 | |
|   "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     base     : exact string match
 | |
|     base_beg : prefix match
 | |
|     base_dir : subdir match
 | |
|     base_dom : domain match
 | |
|     base_end : suffix match
 | |
|     base_len : length match
 | |
|     base_reg : regex match
 | |
|     base_sub : substring match
 | |
| 
 | |
| base32 : integer
 | |
|   This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
 | |
|   above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
 | |
|   having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
 | |
|   memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
 | |
|   SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
 | |
|   to "base,sdbm(1)".
 | |
| 
 | |
| base32+src : binary
 | |
|   This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
 | |
|   below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
 | |
|   depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
 | |
|   per-URL counters.
 | |
| 
 | |
| baseq : string
 | |
|   This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
 | |
|   the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
 | |
|   instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
 | |
|   statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
 | |
|   This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
 | |
|   header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
 | |
|   The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture.req.method : string
 | |
|   This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
 | |
|   and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
 | |
|   because it's allocated.
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture.req.uri : string
 | |
|   This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
 | |
|   before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
 | |
|   and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
 | |
|   allocated.
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture.req.ver : string
 | |
|   This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
 | |
|   "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
 | |
|   logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
 | |
|   This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
 | |
|   header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
 | |
|   The first entry is an index of 0.
 | |
|   See also: "capture response header"
 | |
| 
 | |
| capture.res.ver : string
 | |
|   This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
 | |
|   "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
 | |
|   persistent flag.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.body : binary
 | |
|   This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
 | |
|   recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
 | |
|   as possible, for the request's body.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.body_param([<name>) : string
 | |
|   This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
 | |
|   can check if the "content-type" contains the value
 | |
|   "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
 | |
|   parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
 | |
|   case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
 | |
|   one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
 | |
|   parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
 | |
|   performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
 | |
|   parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
 | |
|   given.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.body_len : integer
 | |
|   This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
 | |
|   be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
 | |
|   is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
 | |
|   much as possible, for the request's body.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.body_size : integer
 | |
|   This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
 | |
|   will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
 | |
|   available data in case of chunked encoding.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.cook([<name>]) : string
 | |
| cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
 | |
|   This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
 | |
|   header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
 | |
|   specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
 | |
|   matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
 | |
|   ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
 | |
|   name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
 | |
|   well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
 | |
|   presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     cook([<name>])     : exact string match
 | |
|     cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
 | |
|     cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
 | |
|     cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
 | |
|     cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
 | |
|     cook_len([<name>]) : length match
 | |
|     cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
 | |
|     cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
 | |
| cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
 | |
|   <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
 | |
| cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
 | |
|   header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
 | |
|   returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
 | |
|   used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
 | |
| 
 | |
| cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
 | |
|   This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
 | |
|   header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
 | |
|   returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
 | |
|   sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
 | |
|   "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
 | |
|   multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
 | |
|   specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
 | |
|   anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
 | |
|   ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
| hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
 | |
|   This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
 | |
|   used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
 | |
|   In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
 | |
|   Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
 | |
|   unambiguously apply to the request headers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
 | |
|   This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
 | |
|   HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
 | |
|   value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
 | |
|   with headers such as User-Agent.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
 | |
|   found.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
 | |
|   Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
 | |
|   the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
 | |
|   with -1 being the last one.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
 | |
|   header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
 | |
|   not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
 | |
|   headers at commas.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
 | |
|   This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
 | |
|   request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
 | |
|   This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
 | |
|   of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
 | |
|   desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
 | |
|   certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
 | |
|   insensitive (e.g. Connection).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
 | |
|   found.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
 | |
|   Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
 | |
|   the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
 | |
|   with -1 being the last one.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
 | |
|   associated with an IP stick-table.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     hdr([<name>[,<occ>]])     : exact string match
 | |
|     hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
 | |
|     hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
 | |
|     hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
 | |
|     hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
 | |
|     hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
 | |
|     hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
 | |
|     hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
 | |
| hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
 | |
|   header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
 | |
|   <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
 | |
|   part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
 | |
|   then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
 | |
|   header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
 | |
|   which contain more than one of certain headers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
 | |
| hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
 | |
|   This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
 | |
|   converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
 | |
|   with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
 | |
|   of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
 | |
|   described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
 | |
|   be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
 | |
|   which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
 | |
|   cause the address to be ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
 | |
| 
 | |
|   A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
 | |
| hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
 | |
|   converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
 | |
|   checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
 | |
| 
 | |
|   A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.hdrs : string
 | |
|   Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
 | |
|   separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
 | |
|   detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
 | |
|   headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.hdrs_bin : binary
 | |
|   Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
 | |
|   is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
 | |
|   by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
 | |
|   length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
 | |
|   SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
 | |
|   names and values (length of 0 for both).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   int:  refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
 | |
|   str:  <int:length><bytes>
 | |
| 
 | |
| http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
 | |
|   Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
 | |
|   the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
 | |
|   fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
 | |
|   basic auth is supported.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
 | |
|   Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
 | |
|   data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
 | |
|   according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
 | |
|   where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
 | |
|   This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
 | |
|   basic auth is supported.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
 | |
|     Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
 | |
|     valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
 | |
|     groups.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http_auth_pass : string
 | |
|   Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
 | |
|   the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
 | |
|   performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http_auth_type : string
 | |
|   Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
 | |
|   the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
 | |
|   performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http_auth_user : string
 | |
|   Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
 | |
|   client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
 | |
|   this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
 | |
| 
 | |
| http_first_req : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
 | |
|   connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
 | |
|   from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
 | |
|   requests in the logs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| method : integer + string
 | |
|   Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
 | |
|   example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
 | |
|   means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
 | |
|   stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
 | |
|   be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
 | |
|   integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
 | |
|   methods.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     method : case insensitive method match
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|       # only accept GET and HEAD requests
 | |
|       acl valid_method method GET HEAD
 | |
|       http-request deny if ! valid_method
 | |
| 
 | |
| path : string
 | |
|   This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
 | |
|   ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
 | |
|   prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
 | |
|   information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
 | |
|   caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
 | |
|   used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
 | |
|   the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     path     : exact string match
 | |
|     path_beg : prefix match
 | |
|     path_dir : subdir match
 | |
|     path_dom : domain match
 | |
|     path_end : suffix match
 | |
|     path_len : length match
 | |
|     path_reg : regex match
 | |
|     path_sub : substring match
 | |
| 
 | |
| pathq : string
 | |
|   This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
 | |
|   the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
 | |
|   relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
 | |
|   while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
 | |
|   HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
 | |
|   result in both cases.
 | |
| 
 | |
| query : string
 | |
|   This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
 | |
|   question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
 | |
|   a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
 | |
|   This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
 | |
|   using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
 | |
|   which stops before the question mark.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
 | |
|   This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
 | |
|   appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
 | |
|   the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
 | |
|   this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
 | |
| 
 | |
| req.ver : string
 | |
| req_ver : string (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
 | |
|   be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
 | |
|   check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     req_ver : exact string match
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.body : binary
 | |
|   This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
 | |
|   the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
 | |
|   sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.body_len : integer
 | |
|   This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
 | |
|   the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
 | |
|   sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.body_size : integer
 | |
|   This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
 | |
|   will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
 | |
|   available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
 | |
|   no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
 | |
|   useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.cache_hit : boolean
 | |
|   Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
 | |
|   HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.cache_name : string
 | |
|   Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
 | |
|   build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
 | |
|   empty string.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.comp : boolean
 | |
|   Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
 | |
|   HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
 | |
|   information in the logs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.comp_algo : string
 | |
|   Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
 | |
|   was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
 | |
|   some information in the logs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.cook([<name>]) : string
 | |
| scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
 | |
|   This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
 | |
|   header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
 | |
|   specified, the first cookie value is returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     scook([<name>] : exact string match
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
 | |
| scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
 | |
|   <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
 | |
|   mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
 | |
| scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
 | |
|   header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
 | |
|   returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
 | |
|   This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
 | |
|   on the headers within an HTTP response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
 | |
|   defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
 | |
|   This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
 | |
|   acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
 | |
|   header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
 | |
| shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
 | |
|   This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
 | |
|   on the headers within an HTTP response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
 | |
|   this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     shdr([<name>[,<occ>]])     : exact string match
 | |
|     shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
 | |
|     shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
 | |
|     shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
 | |
|     shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
 | |
|     shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
 | |
|     shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
 | |
|     shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
 | |
| shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
 | |
|   acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
 | |
|   delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
 | |
| shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
 | |
|   This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
 | |
|   acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
 | |
|   This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
 | |
|   appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
 | |
|   the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
 | |
|   this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
 | |
| shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
 | |
|   This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
 | |
|   acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.hdrs : string
 | |
|   Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
 | |
|   separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
 | |
|   detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
 | |
|   headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.hdrs_bin : binary
 | |
|   Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
 | |
|   is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
 | |
|   tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
 | |
|   by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
 | |
|   using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
 | |
|   end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
 | |
|   (length of 0 for both).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   int:  refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
 | |
|   str:  <int:length><bytes>
 | |
| 
 | |
| res.ver : string
 | |
| resp_ver : string (deprecated)
 | |
|   Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
 | |
|   can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     resp_ver : exact string match
 | |
| 
 | |
| set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
 | |
|   This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
 | |
|   header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
 | |
|   can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
 | |
|   support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
 | |
|   fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
 | |
| 
 | |
| status : integer
 | |
|   Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
 | |
|   example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
 | |
|   to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
 | |
| 
 | |
| unique-id : string
 | |
|   Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
 | |
|   "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
 | |
|   fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
 | |
|   sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
 | |
|   other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
 | |
|   HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
 | |
| 
 | |
| url : string
 | |
|   This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
 | |
|   with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
 | |
|   multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
 | |
|   "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
 | |
|   is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
 | |
|   not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
 | |
|   also "path" and "base".
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     url     : exact string match
 | |
|     url_beg : prefix match
 | |
|     url_dir : subdir match
 | |
|     url_dom : domain match
 | |
|     url_end : suffix match
 | |
|     url_len : length match
 | |
|     url_reg : regex match
 | |
|     url_sub : substring match
 | |
| 
 | |
| url_ip : ip
 | |
|   This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
 | |
|   presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
 | |
|   monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
 | |
|   order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
 | |
|   entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
 | |
|   restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
 | |
|   with option "http_proxy".
 | |
| 
 | |
| url_port : integer
 | |
|   This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
 | |
|   not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
 | |
|   restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
 | |
|   with option "http_proxy".
 | |
| 
 | |
| urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
 | |
| url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
 | |
|   This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
 | |
|   string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
 | |
|   ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
 | |
|   any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
 | |
|   a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
 | |
|   the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
 | |
|   stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
 | |
|   URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
 | |
|   this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
 | |
|   parameters values if no name is given
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ACL derivatives :
 | |
|     urlp(<name>[,<delim>])     : exact string match
 | |
|     urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
 | |
|     urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
 | |
|     urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
 | |
|     urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
 | |
|     urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
 | |
|     urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
 | |
|     urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|       # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
 | |
|       stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
 | |
|       # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
 | |
|       stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
 | |
| 
 | |
| urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
 | |
|   See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
 | |
|   and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
 | |
|   based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
 | |
| 
 | |
| url32 : integer
 | |
|   This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
 | |
|   Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
 | |
|   the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
 | |
|   activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
 | |
|   is an unsigned integer.
 | |
| 
 | |
| url32+src : binary
 | |
|   This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
 | |
|   resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
 | |
|   the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
 | |
| ---------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
 | |
| used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
 | |
| purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
 | |
| There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
 | |
| or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
 | |
| any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
 | |
| for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx.data : integer
 | |
|   Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
 | |
|   channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx.free : integer
 | |
|   Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
 | |
|   to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx.free_data : integer
 | |
|   Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
 | |
|   a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
 | |
|   end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
 | |
|   depending on the sample direction.
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx.nbblks : integer
 | |
|   Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
 | |
|   channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx.size : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
 | |
|   channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx.used : integer
 | |
|   Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
 | |
|   associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
 | |
|   direction.
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
 | |
|   Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
 | |
|   associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
 | |
|   depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
 | |
|   of the special value :
 | |
|     * head  : The oldest inserted block
 | |
|     * tail  : The newest inserted block
 | |
|     * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
 | |
|   Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
 | |
|   associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
 | |
|   is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
 | |
|   integer or one of the special value :
 | |
|     * head  : The oldest inserted block
 | |
|     * tail  : The newest inserted block
 | |
|     * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
 | |
|   Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
 | |
|   associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
 | |
|   not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
 | |
|   <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     * head  : The oldest inserted block
 | |
|     * tail  : The newest inserted block
 | |
|     * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
 | |
|   Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
 | |
|   message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
 | |
|   it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
 | |
|   direction.  <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     * head  : The oldest inserted block
 | |
|     * tail  : The newest inserted block
 | |
|     * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
 | |
|   Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
 | |
|   message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
 | |
|   it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
 | |
|   direction.  <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     * head  : The oldest inserted block
 | |
|     * tail  : The newest inserted block
 | |
|     * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
 | |
|   Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
 | |
|   HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
 | |
|   or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
 | |
|   direction.  <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     * head  : The oldest inserted block
 | |
|     * tail  : The newest inserted block
 | |
|     * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
 | |
| 
 | |
| internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
 | |
|   Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
 | |
|   channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
 | |
|   it returns false.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 7.4. Pre-defined ACLs
 | |
| ---------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
 | |
| every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
 | |
| order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
 | |
| 
 | |
| ACL name          Equivalent to                Usage
 | |
| ---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
 | |
| FALSE            always_false                       never match
 | |
| HTTP             req.proto_http                     match if request protocol is valid HTTP
 | |
| HTTP_1.0         req.ver 1.0                        match if HTTP request version is 1.0
 | |
| HTTP_1.1         req.ver 1.1                        match if HTTP request version is 1.1
 | |
| HTTP_2.0         req.ver 2.0                        match if HTTP request version is 2.0
 | |
| HTTP_CONTENT     req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0   match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
 | |
| HTTP_URL_ABS     url_reg ^[^/:]*://                 match absolute URL with scheme
 | |
| HTTP_URL_SLASH   url_beg /                          match URL beginning with "/"
 | |
| HTTP_URL_STAR    url     *                          match URL equal to "*"
 | |
| LOCALHOST        src 127.0.0.1/8                    match connection from local host
 | |
| METH_CONNECT     method  CONNECT                    match HTTP CONNECT method
 | |
| METH_DELETE      method  DELETE                     match HTTP DELETE method
 | |
| METH_GET         method  GET HEAD                   match HTTP GET or HEAD method
 | |
| METH_HEAD        method  HEAD                       match HTTP HEAD method
 | |
| METH_OPTIONS     method  OPTIONS                    match HTTP OPTIONS method
 | |
| METH_POST        method  POST                       match HTTP POST method
 | |
| METH_PUT         method  PUT                        match HTTP PUT method
 | |
| METH_TRACE       method  TRACE                      match HTTP TRACE method
 | |
| RDP_COOKIE       req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0            match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
 | |
| REQ_CONTENT      req.len gt 0                       match data in the request buffer
 | |
| TRUE             always_true                        always match
 | |
| WAIT_END         wait_end                           wait for end of content analysis
 | |
| ---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8. Logging
 | |
| ----------
 | |
| 
 | |
| One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
 | |
| provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
 | |
| very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
 | |
| provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
 | |
| state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
 | |
| to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
 | |
| headers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
 | |
| about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
 | |
| send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
 | |
|   - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
 | |
|   - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
 | |
|   - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
 | |
|     at the termination.
 | |
|   - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
 | |
|         http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
 | |
| 
 | |
| The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
 | |
| allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
 | |
| as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
 | |
| while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
 | |
| real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
 | |
| delay.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.1. Log levels
 | |
| ---------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
 | |
| source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
 | |
| HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
 | |
| in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
 | |
| track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
 | |
| syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
 | |
| about log facilities.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.2. Log formats
 | |
| ----------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
 | |
| and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
 | |
| slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
 | |
| options. The supported formats are as follows :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
 | |
|     provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
 | |
|     it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
 | |
|     This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
 | |
|     extents.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
 | |
|     tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
 | |
|     connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
 | |
|     information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
 | |
|     format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
 | |
|     is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
 | |
|     same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
 | |
|     the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
 | |
|     format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
 | |
|     fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
 | |
|     timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
 | |
|     common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
 | |
| specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
 | |
| field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
 | |
| servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
 | |
| always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
 | |
| identifier.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
 | |
|        might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
 | |
|        prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
 | |
|        broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
 | |
|        backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.2.1. Default log format
 | |
| -------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
 | |
| as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
 | |
| format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         listen www
 | |
|             mode http
 | |
|             log global
 | |
|             server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> Feb  6 12:12:09 localhost \
 | |
|           haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
 | |
|           (www/HTTP)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Field   Format                                Extract from the example above
 | |
|       1   process_name '[' pid ']:'                            haproxy[14385]:
 | |
|       2   'Connect from'                                          Connect from
 | |
|       3   source_ip ':' source_port                             10.0.1.2:33312
 | |
|       4   'to'                                                              to
 | |
|       5   destination_ip ':' destination_port                   10.0.3.31:8012
 | |
|       6   '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')'                            (www/HTTP)
 | |
| 
 | |
| Detailed fields description :
 | |
|   - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
 | |
|   - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
 | |
|   - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
 | |
|   - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
 | |
|   - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
 | |
|     and processed the connection.
 | |
|   - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
 | |
| 
 | |
| In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
 | |
| "unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
 | |
| connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
 | |
| will eventually disappear.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.2.2. TCP log format
 | |
| ---------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
 | |
| is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
 | |
| information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
 | |
| counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
 | |
| emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
 | |
| environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
 | |
| the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
 | |
| sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
 | |
| specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
 | |
| not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
 | |
| fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
 | |
| marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         frontend fnt
 | |
|             mode tcp
 | |
|             option tcplog
 | |
|             log global
 | |
|             default_backend bck
 | |
| 
 | |
|         backend bck
 | |
|             server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> Feb  6 12:12:56 localhost \
 | |
|           haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
 | |
|           bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Field   Format                                Extract from the example above
 | |
|       1   process_name '[' pid ']:'                            haproxy[14387]:
 | |
|       2   client_ip ':' client_port                             10.0.1.2:33313
 | |
|       3   '[' accept_date ']'                       [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
 | |
|       4   frontend_name                                                    fnt
 | |
|       5   backend_name '/' server_name                                bck/srv1
 | |
|       6   Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt*                                           0/0/5007
 | |
|       7   bytes_read*                                                      212
 | |
|       8   termination_state                                                 --
 | |
|       9   actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries*    0/0/0/0/3
 | |
|      10   srv_queue '/' backend_queue                                      0/0
 | |
| 
 | |
| Detailed fields description :
 | |
|   - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
 | |
|     connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
 | |
|     instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
 | |
|     when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
 | |
|     and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
 | |
|     and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
 | |
|     logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
 | |
|     If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
 | |
|     replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
 | |
|     stats interface.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
 | |
|     (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
 | |
|     network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
 | |
|     the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
 | |
|     HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
 | |
|     connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
 | |
|     HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
 | |
|     and processed the connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
 | |
|     to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
 | |
|     frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
 | |
|     applications.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
 | |
|     sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
 | |
|     and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
 | |
|     which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
 | |
|     a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
 | |
|     It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
 | |
|     See "Timers" below for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
 | |
|     establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
 | |
|     connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
 | |
|     "Timers" below for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
 | |
|     last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
 | |
|     "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
 | |
|     the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
 | |
|     indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
 | |
|     details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
 | |
|     the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
 | |
|     this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
 | |
|     may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
 | |
|     analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
 | |
|     ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
 | |
|     session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
 | |
|     flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
 | |
|     no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
 | |
|     for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
 | |
|     the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
 | |
|     limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
 | |
|     multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
 | |
|     the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
 | |
|     are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
 | |
|     the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
 | |
|     required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
 | |
|     has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
 | |
|     because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
 | |
|     caused by a denial of service attack.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
 | |
|     backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
 | |
|     concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
 | |
|     connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
 | |
|     additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
 | |
|     Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
 | |
|     congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
 | |
|     denial of service attack.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
 | |
|     the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
 | |
|     configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
 | |
|     to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
 | |
|     lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
 | |
|     there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
 | |
|     time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
 | |
|     that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
 | |
|     be processed than on other servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
 | |
|     when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
 | |
|     server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
 | |
|     Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
 | |
|     HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
 | |
|     preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
 | |
|     prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
 | |
|     redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
 | |
|     server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
 | |
|     connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
 | |
|     sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
 | |
|     of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
 | |
|     should not be attributed to the logged server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
 | |
|     this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
 | |
|     through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
 | |
|     server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
 | |
|     requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
 | |
|     redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
 | |
|     cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
 | |
|     backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
 | |
|     this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
 | |
|     gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
 | |
|     queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
 | |
|     divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
 | |
|     session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
 | |
|     and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
 | |
|     through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
 | |
|     occurs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.2.3. HTTP log format
 | |
| ----------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
 | |
| is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
 | |
| the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
 | |
| are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
 | |
| emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
 | |
| generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
 | |
| "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
 | |
| which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
 | |
| frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
 | |
| is specified in the frontend.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
 | |
| slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
 | |
| with a star ('*') after the field name below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         frontend http-in
 | |
|             mode http
 | |
|             option httplog
 | |
|             log global
 | |
|             default_backend bck
 | |
| 
 | |
|         backend static
 | |
|             server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> Feb  6 12:14:14 localhost \
 | |
|           haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
 | |
|           static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
 | |
|           {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Field   Format                                Extract from the example above
 | |
|       1   process_name '[' pid ']:'                            haproxy[14389]:
 | |
|       2   client_ip ':' client_port                             10.0.1.2:33317
 | |
|       3   '[' request_date ']'                      [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
 | |
|       4   frontend_name                                                http-in
 | |
|       5   backend_name '/' server_name                             static/srv1
 | |
|       6   TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta*                       10/0/30/69/109
 | |
|       7   status_code                                                      200
 | |
|       8   bytes_read*                                                     2750
 | |
|       9   captured_request_cookie                                            -
 | |
|      10   captured_response_cookie                                           -
 | |
|      11   termination_state                                               ----
 | |
|      12   actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries*    1/1/1/1/0
 | |
|      13   srv_queue '/' backend_queue                                      0/0
 | |
|      14   '{' captured_request_headers* '}'                   {haproxy.1wt.eu}
 | |
|      15   '{' captured_response_headers* '}'                                {}
 | |
|      16   '"' http_request '"'                      "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
 | |
| 
 | |
| Detailed fields description :
 | |
|   - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
 | |
|     connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
 | |
|     instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
 | |
|     when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
 | |
|     and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
 | |
|     and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
 | |
|     logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
 | |
|     If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
 | |
|     replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
 | |
|     stats interface.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
 | |
|     was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
 | |
|     and processed the connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
 | |
|     to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
 | |
|     frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
 | |
|     sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
 | |
|     and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
 | |
|     which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
 | |
|     server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
 | |
|     intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
 | |
|     request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
 | |
|     received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
 | |
|     request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
 | |
|     always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
 | |
|     Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
 | |
|     HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
 | |
|     for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
 | |
|     It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
 | |
|     See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
 | |
|     establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
 | |
|     request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
 | |
|     8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
 | |
|     a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
 | |
|     aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
 | |
|     the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
 | |
|     the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
 | |
|     "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
 | |
|     "Timing Events" for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
 | |
|     time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
 | |
|     received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
 | |
|     processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
 | |
|     one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
 | |
|     stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
 | |
|     prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
 | |
|     See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
 | |
|     is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
 | |
|     the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
 | |
|     the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
 | |
|     specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
 | |
|     the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
 | |
|     counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
 | |
|     overflowing.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
 | |
|     the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
 | |
|     length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
 | |
|     configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
 | |
|     set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
 | |
|     ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
 | |
|     between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
 | |
|     the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
 | |
|     that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
 | |
|     and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
 | |
|     frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
 | |
|     not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
 | |
|     session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
 | |
|     crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
 | |
|     consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
 | |
|     ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
 | |
|     session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
 | |
|     logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
 | |
|     two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
 | |
|     session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
 | |
|     below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
 | |
|     the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
 | |
|     limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
 | |
|     when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
 | |
|     limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
 | |
|     of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
 | |
|     system.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
 | |
|     the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
 | |
|     required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
 | |
|     has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
 | |
|     because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
 | |
|     caused by a denial of service attack.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
 | |
|     backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
 | |
|     concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
 | |
|     connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
 | |
|     additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
 | |
|     Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
 | |
|     congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
 | |
|     denial of service attack.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
 | |
|     the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
 | |
|     configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
 | |
|     to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
 | |
|     lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
 | |
|     there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
 | |
|     time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
 | |
|     that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
 | |
|     processed than on other servers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
 | |
|     when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
 | |
|     server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
 | |
|     Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
 | |
|     HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
 | |
|     preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
 | |
|     prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
 | |
|     redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
 | |
|     server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
 | |
|     connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
 | |
|     sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
 | |
|     of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
 | |
|     should not be attributed to the logged server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
 | |
|     this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
 | |
|     through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
 | |
|     server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
 | |
|     requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
 | |
|     redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
 | |
|     cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
 | |
|     backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
 | |
|     this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
 | |
|     gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
 | |
|     queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
 | |
|     divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
 | |
|     session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
 | |
|     and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
 | |
|     through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
 | |
|     occurs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
 | |
|     to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
 | |
|     Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
 | |
|     ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
 | |
|     shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
 | |
|     contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
 | |
|     it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
 | |
|     cookies" below for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
 | |
|     due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
 | |
|     frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
 | |
|     vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
 | |
|     causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
 | |
|     field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
 | |
|     than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
 | |
|     and cookies" below for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
 | |
|     request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
 | |
|     below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
 | |
|     field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
 | |
|     contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
 | |
|     added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
 | |
|     huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
 | |
|     is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.2.4. Custom log format
 | |
| ------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
 | |
| mode. It takes a string as argument.
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
 | |
| Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
 | |
| separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
 | |
| prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
 | |
| variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
 | |
| ("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
 | |
| 
 | |
| If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
 | |
| as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
 | |
| less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
 | |
| the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
 | |
| "log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
 | |
| delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
 | |
| preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
 | |
| '\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
 | |
| https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
 | |
| such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Flags are :
 | |
|   * Q: quote a string
 | |
|   * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
 | |
|   * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
 | |
|        (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
 | |
|     log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
 | |
| 
 | |
|     log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
 | |
| 
 | |
| At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
 | |
|                 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
 | |
| 
 | |
| the default CLF format is defined this way :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
 | |
|                 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
 | |
|                 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
 | |
| 
 | |
| and the default TCP format is defined this way :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
 | |
|                 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
 | |
| 
 | |
| Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
 | |
|   | R | var  | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description)  | type        |
 | |
|   +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
 | |
|   |   | %o   | special variable, apply flags on all next var |             |
 | |
|   +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
 | |
|   |   | %B   | bytes_read           (from server to client)  | numeric     |
 | |
|   | H | %CC  | captured_request_cookie                       | string      |
 | |
|   | H | %CS  | captured_response_cookie                      | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %H   | hostname                                      | string      |
 | |
|   | H | %HM  | HTTP method (ex: POST)                        | string      |
 | |
|   | H | %HP  | HTTP request URI without query string         | string      |
 | |
|   | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string      |
 | |
|   | H | %HQ  | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz)  | string      |
 | |
|   | H | %HU  | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz)           | string      |
 | |
|   | H | %HV  | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0)                   | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %ID  | unique-id                                     | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %ST  | status_code                                   | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %T   | gmt_date_time                                 | date        |
 | |
|   |   | %Ta  | Active time of the request (from TR to end)   | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %Tc  | Tc                                            | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %Td  | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)                 | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %Tl  | local_date_time                               | date        |
 | |
|   |   | %Th  | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto)  | numeric     |
 | |
|   | H | %Ti  | idle time before the HTTP request             | numeric     |
 | |
|   | H | %Tq  | Th + Ti + TR                                  | numeric     |
 | |
|   | H | %TR  | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric     |
 | |
|   | H | %Tr  | Tr (response time)                            | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %Ts  | timestamp                                     | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %Tt  | Tt                                            | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %Tu  | Tu                                            | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %Tw  | Tw                                            | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %U   | bytes_uploaded       (from client to server)  | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %ac  | actconn                                       | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %b   | backend_name                                  | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %bc  | beconn      (backend concurrent connections)  | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %bi  | backend_source_ip       (connecting address)  | IP          |
 | |
|   |   | %bp  | backend_source_port     (connecting address)  | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %bq  | backend_queue                                 | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %ci  | client_ip                 (accepted address)  | IP          |
 | |
|   |   | %cp  | client_port               (accepted address)  | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %f   | frontend_name                                 | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %fc  | feconn     (frontend concurrent connections)  | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %fi  | frontend_ip              (accepting address)  | IP          |
 | |
|   |   | %fp  | frontend_port            (accepting address)  | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %ft  | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL)  | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %lc  | frontend_log_counter                          | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %hr  | captured_request_headers default style        | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style            | string list |
 | |
|   |   | %hs  | captured_response_headers default style       | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style           | string list |
 | |
|   |   | %ms  | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %pid | PID                                           | numeric     |
 | |
|   | H | %r   | http_request                                  | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %rc  | retries                                       | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %rt  | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session)     | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %s   | server_name                                   | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %sc  | srv_conn     (server concurrent connections)  | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %si  | server_IP                   (target address)  | IP          |
 | |
|   |   | %sp  | server_port                 (target address)  | numeric     |
 | |
|   |   | %sq  | srv_queue                                     | numeric     |
 | |
|   | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA)                     | string      |
 | |
|   | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1)                       | string      |
 | |
|   |   | %t   | date_time      (with millisecond resolution)  | date        |
 | |
|   | H | %tr  | date_time of HTTP request                     | date        |
 | |
|   | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request        | date        |
 | |
|   | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request      | date        |
 | |
|   |   | %ts  | termination_state                             | string      |
 | |
|   | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status          | string      |
 | |
|   +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
 | |
| 
 | |
|     R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.2.5. Error log format
 | |
| -----------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
 | |
| protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
 | |
| By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
 | |
| "log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
 | |
| will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
 | |
| logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The format looks like this :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> Dec  3 18:27:14 localhost \
 | |
|           haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
 | |
|           Connection error during SSL handshake
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Field   Format                                Extract from the example above
 | |
|       1   process_name '[' pid ']:'                             haproxy[6103]:
 | |
|       2   client_ip ':' client_port                            127.0.0.1:56059
 | |
|       3   '[' accept_date ']'                       [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
 | |
|       4   frontend_name "/" bind_name ":"                              frt/f1:
 | |
|       5   message                        Connection error during SSL handshake
 | |
| 
 | |
| These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
 | |
| failures.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.3. Advanced logging options
 | |
| -----------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
 | |
| just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
 | |
| options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
 | |
| for more information about their usage.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
 | |
| ------------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
 | |
| HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
 | |
| commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
 | |
| monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
 | |
| ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
 | |
|     desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
 | |
|     setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
 | |
|     port scans, which may or may not be desired.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
 | |
|     a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
 | |
|     this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
 | |
|     only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
 | |
| ----------------------------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
 | |
| what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
 | |
| or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
 | |
| "option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
 | |
| just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
 | |
| log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
 | |
| after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
 | |
| is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
 | |
| with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
 | |
| with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
 | |
| ------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
 | |
| for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
 | |
| "log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
 | |
| retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
 | |
| raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
 | |
| a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
 | |
| file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
 | |
| you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
 | |
| "notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
 | |
| --------------------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
 | |
| multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
 | |
| them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
 | |
| "dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
 | |
| logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
 | |
| error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
 | |
| and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
 | |
| too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
 | |
| useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
 | |
| alternative.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.4. Timing events
 | |
| ------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
 | |
| reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
 | |
| the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
 | |
| frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
 | |
| mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
 | |
| addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
 | |
| 
 | |
| Timings events in HTTP mode:
 | |
| 
 | |
|                  first request               2nd request
 | |
|       |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
 | |
|       t         tr                       t    tr ...
 | |
|    ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
 | |
|       : Th   Ti   TR   Tw   Tc   Tr   Td : Ti   ...
 | |
|       :<---- Tq ---->:                   :
 | |
|       :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
 | |
|       :<--        -----Tu--------------->:
 | |
|                 :<--------- Ta --------->:
 | |
| 
 | |
| Timings events in TCP mode:
 | |
| 
 | |
|            TCP session
 | |
|       |<----------------->|
 | |
|       t                   t
 | |
|    ---|----|----|----|----|---
 | |
|       | Th   Tw   Tc   Td |
 | |
|       |<------ Tt ------->|
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
 | |
|     protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
 | |
|     only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
 | |
|     may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
 | |
|     speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
 | |
|     completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
 | |
|     SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
 | |
|     reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
 | |
|     all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
 | |
|     request will always report zero here.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
 | |
|     counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
 | |
|     request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
 | |
|     to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
 | |
|     multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
 | |
|     after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
 | |
|     server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
 | |
|     pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
 | |
|     value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
 | |
|     elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
 | |
|     the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
 | |
|     indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
 | |
|     the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
 | |
|     since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
 | |
|     request typed by hand during a test.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
 | |
|     emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
 | |
|     exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
 | |
|     returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
 | |
|     HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
 | |
|     it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
 | |
|     reports.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
 | |
|     accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
 | |
|     queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
 | |
|     requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
 | |
|     the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
 | |
|     elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
 | |
|     moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
 | |
|     the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
 | |
|     connection never established.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
 | |
|     the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
 | |
|     the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
 | |
|     processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
 | |
|     It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
 | |
|     instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
 | |
|     apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
 | |
|     too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
 | |
|     untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
 | |
|     header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
 | |
|     stroke before the server managed to process the request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
 | |
|     received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
 | |
|     byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
 | |
|     specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
 | |
|     a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
 | |
|     by subtracting other timers when valid :
 | |
| 
 | |
|         Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
 | |
| 
 | |
|     Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
 | |
|     "Ta" can never be negative.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
 | |
|     and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
 | |
|     option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
 | |
|     is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
 | |
|     transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
 | |
| 
 | |
|         Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
 | |
| 
 | |
|     Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
 | |
|     mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
 | |
|     be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
 | |
|     accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
 | |
|     This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
 | |
|     without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
 | |
|     timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
 | |
|     latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
 | |
|     option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
 | |
|     prefixed with a '+' sign.
 | |
| 
 | |
| These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
 | |
| protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
 | |
| that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
 | |
| due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
 | |
| "Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
 | |
| that a session has been aborted on timeout.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Most common cases :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
 | |
|     the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
 | |
|     happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
 | |
|     may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
 | |
|     cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
 | |
|     ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
 | |
|     The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
 | |
|     processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
 | |
|     order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
 | |
|     new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
 | |
|     modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
 | |
|     waiting for additional requests.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
 | |
|     server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
 | |
|     always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
 | |
|     of ms on remote networks.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
 | |
|     to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
 | |
|     between the proxy and the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
 | |
|     neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
 | |
|     HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
 | |
|     connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
 | |
|     one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
 | |
|     the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
 | |
|     important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
 | |
|     the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
 | |
|     another one is released.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta  The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
 | |
|                    was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
 | |
|                    except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta   The client was not able to send a complete request in time
 | |
|                    or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
 | |
|                    then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta   It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
 | |
|                    servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
 | |
|                    or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
 | |
|                    flags.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta   The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
 | |
|                    actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
 | |
|                    Check the session termination flags, then check the
 | |
|                    "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
 | |
|                    return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
 | |
|                    the client connection was maintained open.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta   The server has accepted the connection but did not return
 | |
|                    a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
 | |
|                    unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
 | |
|                    termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.5. Session state at disconnection
 | |
| -----------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
 | |
| "termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
 | |
| 2-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
 | |
| each of which has a special meaning :
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
 | |
|     session to terminate :
 | |
| 
 | |
|         C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
 | |
|             server explicitly refused it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
 | |
|             connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
 | |
|             because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
 | |
|             error in server response which might have caused information leak
 | |
|             (e.g. cacheable cookie).
 | |
| 
 | |
|         L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
 | |
|             a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
 | |
|             ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
 | |
|             system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
 | |
|             happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
 | |
|             should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
 | |
|             This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
 | |
|             containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
 | |
|             would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
 | |
|             event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
 | |
|             as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
 | |
|             active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
 | |
|             backup connections when going up.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
 | |
|             send or receive data.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
 | |
|             send or receive data.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
 | |
|             with nothing left in the buffers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
 | |
| 
 | |
|         R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
 | |
|             (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
 | |
|             only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
 | |
|             also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
 | |
|             a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
 | |
|             reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
 | |
|             server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
 | |
|             server (HTTP only).
 | |
| 
 | |
|         D : the session was in the DATA phase.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
 | |
|             server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
 | |
|             happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
 | |
|             during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
 | |
|             closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
 | |
|     the client (only in HTTP mode) :
 | |
| 
 | |
|         N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
 | |
|             visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
 | |
|             logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
 | |
|             This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
 | |
|             cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
 | |
|             ignored, or an attack.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
 | |
|             so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
 | |
|             this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
 | |
|             another server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
 | |
|             server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
 | |
|             older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
 | |
|             the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
 | |
|             redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
 | |
|             older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
 | |
|             the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
 | |
|             redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
 | |
|             some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
 | |
|             "use-server" rule).
 | |
| 
 | |
|         - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
 | |
| 
 | |
|   - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
 | |
|     cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
 | |
| 
 | |
|         N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
 | |
|             Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
 | |
|             it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
 | |
|             the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
 | |
|             happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
 | |
|             date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
 | |
|             a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
 | |
|             happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|         - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
 | |
| 
 | |
| The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
 | |
| was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
 | |
| helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
 | |
| starvation, attacks, etc...
 | |
| 
 | |
| The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
 | |
| alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
 | |
| easier finding and understanding.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Flags   Reason
 | |
| 
 | |
|      --   Normal termination.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      CC   The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
 | |
|           server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
 | |
|           dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
 | |
|           waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      CD   The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
 | |
|           caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
 | |
|           client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
 | |
|           by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
 | |
|           keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
 | |
|           by the client.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      cD   The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
 | |
|           "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
 | |
|           the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      CH   The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
 | |
|           It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
 | |
|           clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      cH   The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
 | |
|           POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
 | |
|           for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
 | |
|           also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
 | |
|           the server takes too long to respond.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      CQ   The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
 | |
|           with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
 | |
|           servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
 | |
|           long a time to respond.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      CR   The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
 | |
|           the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
 | |
|           too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
 | |
|           might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
 | |
|           and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
 | |
|           connections without any data transfer.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      cR   The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
 | |
|           request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
 | |
|           client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
 | |
|           packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
 | |
|           enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
 | |
|           request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
 | |
|           some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
 | |
|           in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
 | |
|           in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
 | |
|           connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
 | |
|           Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
 | |
|           the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
 | |
|           and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
 | |
|           been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
 | |
|           around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
 | |
|           http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
 | |
|           zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
 | |
|           the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      CT   The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
 | |
|           check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
 | |
|           wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
 | |
|           might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
 | |
|           closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
 | |
|           resources for just a few attackers.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      LR   The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
 | |
|           it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      SC   The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
 | |
|           the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
 | |
|           in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
 | |
|           stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
 | |
|           or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
 | |
|           the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      sC   The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
 | |
|           complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
 | |
|           503 or 504 here.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      SD   The connection to the server died with an error during the data
 | |
|           transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
 | |
|           the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
 | |
|           exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
 | |
|           or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      sD   The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
 | |
|           "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
 | |
|           by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
 | |
|           load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
 | |
|           between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      SH   The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
 | |
|           it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
 | |
|           this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
 | |
|           control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
 | |
|           small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
 | |
|           Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
 | |
|           between HAProxy and the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      sH   The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
 | |
|           response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
 | |
|           long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
 | |
|           The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
 | |
|           setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
 | |
|           will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
 | |
|           solution is to fix the application.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      sQ   The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
 | |
|           the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
 | |
|           fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
 | |
|           short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
 | |
|           servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
 | |
|           external attacks.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      PC   The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
 | |
|           process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
 | |
|           The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
 | |
|           so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
 | |
|           might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      PD   The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
 | |
|           a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
 | |
|           most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
 | |
|           the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
 | |
|           bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      PH   The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
 | |
|           incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
 | |
|           In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
 | |
|           cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
 | |
|           containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
 | |
|           rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
 | |
|           client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
 | |
|           case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
 | |
|           logs.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      PR   The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
 | |
|           invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
 | |
|           the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
 | |
|           returned an HTTP 403 error.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      PT   The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
 | |
|           connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
 | |
|           to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
 | |
|           reported by the "Tw" timer field.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      RC   A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
 | |
|           preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
 | |
|           logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
 | |
|           only be solved by proper system tuning.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
 | |
| persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
 | |
| important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
 | |
| re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
 | |
| 
 | |
|      --   Persistence cookie is not enabled.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      NN   No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
 | |
|           response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
 | |
|           set on a GET request.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      II   A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
 | |
|           a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
 | |
|           a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
 | |
|           value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      NI   No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
 | |
|           response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
 | |
|           in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      VN   A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
 | |
|           response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
 | |
|           already got a cookie.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      VU   A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
 | |
|           not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
 | |
|           response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
 | |
|           there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
 | |
|           cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      EI   A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
 | |
|           too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
 | |
|           new cookie was inserted in the response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      OI   A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
 | |
|           too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
 | |
|           new cookie was inserted in the response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      DI   The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
 | |
|           selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|      VI   The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
 | |
|           be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
 | |
|           then advertised in the response.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.6. Non-printable characters
 | |
| -----------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
 | |
| consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
 | |
| converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
 | |
| prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
 | |
| being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
 | |
| escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
 | |
| is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
 | |
| '}' when logging headers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
 | |
| issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
 | |
| containing spaces is "User-Agent".
 | |
| 
 | |
| Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
 | |
| the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
 | |
| performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
 | |
| ---------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
 | |
| achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
 | |
| section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
 | |
| cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
 | |
| the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
 | |
| the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
 | |
| locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
 | |
| not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
 | |
| user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
 | |
| a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
 | |
| wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Examples :
 | |
|         # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
 | |
|         capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
 | |
| 
 | |
|         # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
 | |
|         capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.8. Capturing HTTP headers
 | |
| ---------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
 | |
| proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
 | |
| the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
 | |
| server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
 | |
| response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
 | |
| section 4.2 for more details.
 | |
| 
 | |
| It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
 | |
| time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
 | |
| appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
 | |
| are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
 | |
| and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
 | |
| follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
 | |
| request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
 | |
| in the logs.
 | |
| 
 | |
| As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
 | |
| frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
 | |
| an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|         # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
 | |
|         listen proxy-out
 | |
|             mode http
 | |
|             option httplog
 | |
|             option logasap
 | |
|             log global
 | |
|             server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
 | |
| 
 | |
|             # log the name of the virtual server
 | |
|             capture request  header Host len 20
 | |
| 
 | |
|             # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
 | |
|             capture request  header Content-Length len 10
 | |
| 
 | |
|             # log the beginning of the referrer
 | |
|             capture request  header Referer len 20
 | |
| 
 | |
|             # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
 | |
|             capture response header Server len 20
 | |
| 
 | |
|             # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
 | |
|             capture response header Content-Length len 10
 | |
| 
 | |
|             # log the expected cache behavior on the response
 | |
|             capture response header Cache-Control len 8
 | |
| 
 | |
|             # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
 | |
|             capture response header Via len 20
 | |
| 
 | |
|             # log the URL location during a redirection
 | |
|             capture response header Location len 20
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> Aug  9 20:26:09 localhost \
 | |
|           haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
 | |
|           proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
 | |
|           {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
 | |
|           "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> Aug  9 20:30:46 localhost \
 | |
|           haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
 | |
|           proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
 | |
|           {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
 | |
|           "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> Aug  9 20:30:46 localhost \
 | |
|           haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
 | |
|           proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
 | |
|           {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
 | |
|           {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
 | |
|           "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 8.9. Examples of logs
 | |
| ---------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
 | |
| them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
 | |
| reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
 | |
|           px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
 | |
|           "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
 | |
| 
 | |
|     => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
 | |
|        in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
 | |
|           px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
 | |
|           0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
 | |
| 
 | |
|     => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
 | |
|        requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
 | |
|           px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
 | |
|           "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
 | |
| 
 | |
|     => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
 | |
|        the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
 | |
|        14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
 | |
|        accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
 | |
|           px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
 | |
|           "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
 | |
| 
 | |
|     => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
 | |
|        deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
 | |
|        HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
 | |
|        being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
 | |
|        gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
 | |
|        return the 502 and not the server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
 | |
|           px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
 | |
| 
 | |
|     => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
 | |
|        8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
 | |
|        Nothing was sent to any server.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
 | |
|          px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
 | |
| 
 | |
|     => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
 | |
|        time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
 | |
|        headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
 | |
|        send a 408 return code to the client.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
 | |
|           px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
 | |
| 
 | |
|     => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
 | |
|        5 seconds ("c----").
 | |
| 
 | |
|     >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
 | |
|           px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
 | |
|           0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
 | |
| 
 | |
|     => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
 | |
|        connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
 | |
|        (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
 | |
|        seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
 | |
|        connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
 | |
|        the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
 | |
|        connection because of too many already established.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 9. Supported filters
 | |
| --------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
 | |
| accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
 | |
| unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
 | |
| 
 | |
| See also : "filter"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 9.1. Trace
 | |
| ----------
 | |
| 
 | |
| filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments:
 | |
|     <name>               is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
 | |
|                          messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <quiet>              inhibits trace messages.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <random-forwarding>  enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
 | |
|                          default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
 | |
|                          data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
 | |
|                          amount of the parsed data.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <hexdump>             dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
 | |
| 
 | |
| This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
 | |
| callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
 | |
| information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
 | |
| filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
 | |
| tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
 | |
| a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 9.2. HTTP compression
 | |
| ---------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| filter compression
 | |
| 
 | |
| The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
 | |
| keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
 | |
| when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
 | |
| fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
 | |
| done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
 | |
| explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
 | |
| filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
 | |
| listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
 | |
| order.
 | |
| 
 | |
| See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
 | |
|            about the fcgi-app filter.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 9.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
 | |
| --------------------------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <name>      is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
 | |
|                 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
 | |
|                 parsed.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <file>      is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
 | |
|                 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
 | |
|                 part must be placed in its own scope.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
 | |
| external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
 | |
| streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
 | |
| exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
 | |
| also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
 | |
| 
 | |
| SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
 | |
| the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
 | |
| 
 | |
| For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
 | |
| "doc/SPOE.txt".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 9.4. Cache
 | |
| ----------
 | |
| 
 | |
| filter cache <name>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <name>      is name of the cache section this filter will use.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
 | |
| "cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
 | |
| cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
 | |
| other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
 | |
| case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
 | |
| is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
 | |
| filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
 | |
| listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
 | |
| order.
 | |
| 
 | |
| See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
 | |
|            fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 9.5. Fcgi-app
 | |
| -------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| filter fcgi-app <name>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <name>      is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
 | |
| request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
 | |
| reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
 | |
| used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
 | |
| implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
 | |
| used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
 | |
| fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
 | |
| used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
 | |
| order.
 | |
| 
 | |
| See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
 | |
|           about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 9.6. OpenTracing
 | |
| ----------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
 | |
| HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
 | |
| of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
 | |
| Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
 | |
| 
 | |
| This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
 | |
| HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
 | |
| participates in the work of HAProxy.
 | |
| 
 | |
| filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <id>        is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
 | |
|                 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
 | |
|                 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default.  If scope is not
 | |
|                 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
 | |
|                 OpenTracing filters.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     <file>      is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
 | |
|                 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
 | |
|                 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
 | |
|                 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
 | |
|                 filter must have its own scope defined.
 | |
| 
 | |
| More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
 | |
| of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 10. FastCGI applications
 | |
| -------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
 | |
| feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
 | |
| the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
 | |
| FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
 | |
| servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
 | |
| FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
 | |
| backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
| HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
 | |
| application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
 | |
| connection.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 10.1. Setup
 | |
| -----------
 | |
| 
 | |
| 10.1.1. Fcgi-app section
 | |
| --------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| fcgi-app <name>
 | |
|   Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
 | |
|   document root must be defined.
 | |
| 
 | |
| acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
 | |
|   Declare or complete an access list.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
 | |
|   details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
 | |
|   used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
 | |
|   in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
 | |
|   Pre-defined ACLs are available.
 | |
| 
 | |
| docroot <path>
 | |
|    Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
 | |
|    the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
 | |
|    PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
| index <script-name>
 | |
|   Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
 | |
|   slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
 | |
|   is an optional setting.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     index index.php
 | |
| 
 | |
| log-stderr global
 | |
| log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
 | |
|     [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
 | |
|   Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
 | |
|   default STDERR messages are ignored.
 | |
| 
 | |
| pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
|   Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
 | |
|   application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
 | |
|   which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
 | |
|   prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
 | |
|   that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
 | |
|   "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
 | |
|   the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
 | |
| 
 | |
| path-info <regex>
 | |
|   Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
 | |
|   the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
 | |
|   capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
 | |
|   first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
 | |
|   to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
 | |
|   optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
 | |
|   path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
 | |
|   filled.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
 | |
|   the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
 | |
|   to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
 | |
|   limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
 | |
|   of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
 | |
|   returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|      path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
 | |
|      path-info ^(/.+\.php)        # the path-info is ignored
 | |
| 
 | |
| option get-values
 | |
| no option get-values
 | |
|   Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
 | |
|   establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
 | |
| 
 | |
|     * FCGI_MAX_REQS     The maximum number of concurrent requests this
 | |
|                         application will accept.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS   "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
 | |
|                         "1" otherwise.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
 | |
|   the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
 | |
|   option is disabled.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
 | |
|   application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
 | |
|   per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
 | |
|   server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
 | |
|   an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
 | |
|   of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| option keep-conn
 | |
| no option keep-conn
 | |
|   Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
 | |
|   sending a response.
 | |
| 
 | |
|    If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
 | |
|    to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
 | |
| 
 | |
| option max-reqs <reqs>
 | |
|   Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
 | |
|   accept.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
 | |
|   during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
 | |
|   support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
 | |
|   to 1.
 | |
| 
 | |
| option mpxs-conns
 | |
| no option mpxs-conns
 | |
|   Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
 | |
|   during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
 | |
| 
 | |
| set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
 | |
|   Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
 | |
|   value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
 | |
|   "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
 | |
|   condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
 | |
|   parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
 | |
|   ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Example :
 | |
|     # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
 | |
|     set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
 | |
| 
 | |
|     set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 10.1.2. Proxy section
 | |
| ---------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| use-fcgi-app <name>
 | |
|   Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Arguments :
 | |
|     <name>    is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
 | |
|   and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
 | |
|   with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
 | |
|   recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
 | |
|   application may be defined at a time per backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
 | |
|   on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
 | |
|   sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
 | |
|   application are evaluated.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 10.1.3. Example
 | |
| ---------------
 | |
| 
 | |
|   frontend front-http
 | |
|       mode http
 | |
|       bind *:80
 | |
|       bind *:
 | |
| 
 | |
|       use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
 | |
|       default_backend back-static
 | |
| 
 | |
|   backend back-static
 | |
|       mode http
 | |
|       server www A.B.C.D:80
 | |
| 
 | |
|   backend back-dynamic
 | |
|       mode http
 | |
|       use-fcgi-app php-fpm
 | |
|       server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
 | |
| 
 | |
|   fcgi-app php-fpm
 | |
|       log-stderr global
 | |
|       option keep-conn
 | |
| 
 | |
|       docroot /var/www/my-app
 | |
|       index index.php
 | |
|       path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 10.2. Default parameters
 | |
| ------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
 | |
| the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
 | |
| script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
 | |
| applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | AUTH_TYPE         | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy   |
 | |
|   |                   | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the      |
 | |
|   |                   | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported.        |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | CONTENT_LENGTH    | Contains the size of the message-body attached to   |
 | |
|   |                   | the request. It means only requests with a known    |
 | |
|   |                   | size are considered as valid and sent to the        |
 | |
|   |                   | application.                                        |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | CONTENT_TYPE      | Contains the type of the message-body attached to   |
 | |
|   |                   | the request. It may not be set.                     |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | DOCUMENT_ROOT     | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
 | |
|   |                   | which the script should be executed, as defined in  |
 | |
|   |                   | the application's configuration.                    |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy   |
 | |
|   |                   | to communicate with the FastCGI application.        |
 | |
|   |                   | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1".                 |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | PATH_INFO         | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy      |
 | |
|   |                   | following the part that identifies the script       |
 | |
|   |                   | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must   |
 | |
|   |                   | be defined.                                         |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | PATH_TRANSLATED   | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version.  |
 | |
|   |                   | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and        |
 | |
|   |                   | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
 | |
|   |                   | is not set too.                                     |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | QUERY_STRING      | Contains the request's query string. It may not be  |
 | |
|   |                   | set.                                                |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | REMOTE_ADDR       | Contains the network address of the client sending  |
 | |
|   |                   | the request.                                        |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | REMOTE_USER       | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
 | |
|   |                   | client as part of user authentication.              |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | REQUEST_METHOD    | Contains the method which should be used by the     |
 | |
|   |                   | script to process the request.                      |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | REQUEST_URI       | Contains the request's URI.                         |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | SCRIPT_FILENAME   | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
 | |
|   |                   | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | SCRIPT_NAME       | Contains the name of the script. If the directive   |
 | |
|   |                   | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
 | |
|   |                   | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name.    |
 | |
|   |                   | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path.               |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | SERVER_NAME       | Contains the name of the server host to which the   |
 | |
|   |                   | client request is directed. It is the value of the  |
 | |
|   |                   | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the           |
 | |
|   |                   | destination address of the connection on the client |
 | |
|   |                   | side.                                               |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | SERVER_PORT       | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
 | |
|   |                   | on the client side, which is the port the client    |
 | |
|   |                   | connected to.                                       |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | SERVER_PROTOCOL   | Contains the request's protocol.                    |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
|   | HTTPS             | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was   |
 | |
|   |                   | queried through the HTTPS protocol.                 |
 | |
|   |                   |                                                     |
 | |
|   +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 10.3. Limitations
 | |
| ------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
 | |
| way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
 | |
| during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
 | |
| establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
 | |
| application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
 | |
| or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
 | |
| message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
 | |
| these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
 | |
| and HTTP servers under the same backend.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
 | |
| request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
 | |
| requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
 | |
| 
 | |
| About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
 | |
| into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
 | |
| fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
 | |
| "http-request" ones.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
 | |
| FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
 | |
| processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
 | |
| must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
 | |
| here.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 11. Address formats
 | |
| -------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
 | |
| address.
 | |
| 
 | |
| This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
 | |
| The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
 | |
| of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
 | |
| equivalent is '::'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
 | |
| is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
 | |
| family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
 | |
| configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
 | |
| use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
 | |
| 'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
 | |
| 
 | |
| Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
 | |
| socket type and the transport method.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 11.1 Address family prefixes
 | |
| ----------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'fd@<n>'      following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
 | |
|               parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
 | |
|               listening.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
 | |
|                                IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
 | |
|                                on the statement using this address, a port or
 | |
|                                a port range may or must be specified.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
 | |
|                                  an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
 | |
|                                  using this address, a port or a port range
 | |
|                                  may or must be specified.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
 | |
|                                  an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
 | |
|                                  using this address, a port or a port range
 | |
|                                  may or must be specified.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
 | |
|                socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
 | |
|                creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
 | |
|                over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
 | |
|                the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
 | |
|                of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'unix@<path>'  following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
 | |
|                prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
 | |
|                start by slash '/'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 11.2 Socket type prefixes
 | |
| -------------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
 | |
| type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
 | |
| this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
 | |
| This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
 | |
| but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
 | |
| 
 | |
| Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
 | |
| instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
 | |
| 
 | |
| If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
 | |
| they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
 | |
| report this to the maintainers.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
 | |
|                             to "stream"
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'dgram+<family>@<address>'  forces socket type and transport method
 | |
|                             to "datagram".
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| 11.3 Protocol prefixes
 | |
| ----------------------
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
 | |
|                                 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
 | |
|                                 socket type and transport method is forced to
 | |
|                                 "stream". Depending on the statement using
 | |
|                                 this address, a port or a port range can or
 | |
|                                 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
 | |
|                                 of 'stream+ip@'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
 | |
|                                  an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
 | |
|                                  method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
 | |
|                                  statement using this address, a port or port
 | |
|                                  range can or must be specified.
 | |
|                                  It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
 | |
|                                  an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
 | |
|                                  method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
 | |
|                                  statement using this address, a port or port
 | |
|                                  range can or must be specified.
 | |
|                                  It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
 | |
|                                 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
 | |
|                                 socket type and transport method is forced to
 | |
|                                 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
 | |
|                                 this address, a port or a port range can or
 | |
|                                 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
 | |
|                                 of 'dgram+ip@'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
 | |
|                                  an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
 | |
|                                  method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
 | |
|                                  the statement using this address, a port or
 | |
|                                  port range can or must be specified.
 | |
|                                  It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
 | |
|                                  an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
 | |
|                                  method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
 | |
|                                  the statement using this address, a port or
 | |
|                                  port range can or must be specified.
 | |
|                                  It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'uxdg@<path>'    following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
 | |
|                  transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
 | |
|                  an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| 'uxst@<path>'    following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
 | |
|                  transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
 | |
|                  an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
 | |
| 
 | |
| In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
 | |
| QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*
 | |
|  * Local variables:
 | |
|  *  fill-column: 79
 | |
|  * End:
 | |
|  */
 |